* mips-mdebug-tdep.c, mips-mdebug-tdep.h, ocd.c, ocd.h, ppc-bdm.c,
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
... / ...
CommitLineData
1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2@c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
6@c %**start of header
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27@syncodeindex vr cp
28@syncodeindex fn cp
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31@c This is updated by GNU Press.
32@set EDITION Ninth
33
34@c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35@set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40@c manuals to an info tree.
41@dircategory Software development
42@direntry
43* Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44@end direntry
45
46@ifinfo
47This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51@value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
66freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
67published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
68development.''
69@end ifinfo
70
71@titlepage
72@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
73@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
74@sp 1
75@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
76@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
77@page
78@tex
79{\parskip=0pt
80\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
81\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
82\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
83}
84@end tex
85
86@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
87Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
881996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
89Free Software Foundation, Inc.
90@sp 2
91Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9251 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
93Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
94ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
95
96Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
97under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
98any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
99Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
100Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
101and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
102
103(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
104freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
105published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
106development.''
107@end titlepage
108@page
109
110@ifnottex
111@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
118@value{GDBVN}.
119
120Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
121
122@menu
123* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
124* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
125
126* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
127* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
128* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
129* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
130* Stack:: Examining the stack
131* Source:: Examining source files
132* Data:: Examining data
133* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
134* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
135* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
136
137* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
138
139* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
140* Altering:: Altering execution
141* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
142* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
143* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
144* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
145* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
146* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
147* Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
148* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
149* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
151* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
152
153* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154
155* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
156* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
157* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
158* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
159* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
160* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
161* Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
162* Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
163 @value{GDBN}
164* Copying:: GNU General Public License says
165 how you can copy and share GDB
166* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
167* Index:: Index
168@end menu
169
170@end ifnottex
171
172@contents
173
174@node Summary
175@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
176
177The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
178going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
179program was doing at the moment it crashed.
180
181@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
182these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
183
184@itemize @bullet
185@item
186Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
187
188@item
189Make your program stop on specified conditions.
190
191@item
192Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
193
194@item
195Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
196effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
197@end itemize
198
199You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
200For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
201For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
202
203@cindex Modula-2
204Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
205@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
206
207@cindex Pascal
208Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
209nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
210entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
211syntax.
212
213@cindex Fortran
214@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
215it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
216underscore.
217
218@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
219using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
220
221@menu
222* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
223* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
224@end menu
225
226@node Free Software
227@unnumberedsec Free Software
228
229@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
230General Public License
231(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
232program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
233freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
234the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
235Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
236Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
237
238Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
239you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
240from anyone else.
241
242@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
243
244The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
245the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
246include with the free software. Many of our most important
247programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
248texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
249when an important free software package does not come with a free
250manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
251gaps today.
252
253Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
254normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
255authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
256copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
257them from the free software world.
258
259That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
260from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
261manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
262only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
263contract to make it non-free.
264
265Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
266price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
267charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
268Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
269problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
270are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
271modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
272
273The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
274free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
275commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
276accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
277
278Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
279When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
280are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
281provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
282manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
283a changed version of the program is not really available to our
284community.
285
286Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
287acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
288author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
289authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
290to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
291may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
292with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
293are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
294of the manual.
295
296However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
297content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
298media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
299obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
300manual to replace it.
301
302Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
303lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
304free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
305the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
306realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
307the free software community.
308
309If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
310the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
311license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
312don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
313will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
314option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
315what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
316try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
317is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
318
319You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
320manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
321copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
322improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
323at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
324and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
325Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
326have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
327
328The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
329published by other publishers, at
330@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
331
332@node Contributors
333@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
334
335Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
336other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
337development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
338of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
339to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
340file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
341blow-by-blow account.
342
343Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
344
345@quotation
346@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
347or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
348omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
349@end quotation
350
351So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
352particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
353releases:
354Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
355Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
356Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
357Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
358Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
359Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
360John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
361Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
362and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
363
364Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
365Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
366
367Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
368in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
369Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
370demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
371much general update work leading to release 3.0).
372
373@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
374object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
375Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
376
377David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
378the original support for encapsulated COFF.
379
380Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
381
382Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
383Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
384support.
385Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
386Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
387Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
388David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
389Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
390Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
391Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
392Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
393Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
394Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
395Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
396Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
397Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
398Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
399Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
400Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
401
402Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
403
404Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
405libraries.
406
407Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
408about several machine instruction sets.
409
410Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
411remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
412contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
413and RDI targets, respectively.
414
415Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
416command-line editing and command history.
417
418Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
419Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
420
421Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
422He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
423symbols.
424
425Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
426H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
427
428NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
429
430Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
431processors.
432
433Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
434
435Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
436
437Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
438
439Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
440watchpoints.
441
442Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
443
444Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
445
446Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
447nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
448
449The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
450support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
451(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
452compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
453Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
454Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
455provided HP-specific information in this manual.
456
457DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
458Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
459
460Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
461development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
462fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
463Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
464Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
465Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
466Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
467addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
468JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
469Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
470Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
471Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
472Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
473Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
474Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
475
476Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
477Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
478
479Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
480Hat.
481
482Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
483people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
484Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
485Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
486Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
487with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
488
489Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
490unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
491frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
492Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
493libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
494trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
495complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
496Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
497Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
498Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
499Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
500Weigand.
501
502Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
503Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
504who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
505Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
506
507@node Sample Session
508@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
509
510You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
511However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
512debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
513
514@iftex
515In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
516to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
517@end iftex
518
519@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
520@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
521
522One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
523processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
524quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
525definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
526session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
527then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
528same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
529@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
530procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
531
532@smallexample
533$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
534$ @b{./m4}
535@b{define(foo,0000)}
536
537@b{foo}
5380000
539@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
540
541@b{bar}
5420000
543@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
544
545@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
546@b{baz}
547@b{Ctrl-d}
548m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
549@end smallexample
550
551@noindent
552Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
553
554@smallexample
555$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
556@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
557@c FIXME... format to come out better.
558@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
559 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
560 the conditions.
561There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
562 for details.
563
564@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
565(@value{GDBP})
566@end smallexample
567
568@noindent
569@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
570rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
571We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
572that examples fit in this manual.
573
574@smallexample
575(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
576@end smallexample
577
578@noindent
579We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
580Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
581@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
582@code{break} command.
583
584@smallexample
585(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
586Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
587@end smallexample
588
589@noindent
590Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
591control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
592subroutine, the program runs as usual:
593
594@smallexample
595(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
596Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
597@b{define(foo,0000)}
598
599@b{foo}
6000000
601@end smallexample
602
603@noindent
604To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
605suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
606context where it stops.
607
608@smallexample
609@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
610
611Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
612 at builtin.c:879
613879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
614@end smallexample
615
616@noindent
617Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
618the next line of the current function.
619
620@smallexample
621(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
622882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
623 : nil,
624@end smallexample
625
626@noindent
627@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
628by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
629@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
630subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
631
632@smallexample
633(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
634set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
635 at input.c:530
636530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
637@end smallexample
638
639@noindent
640The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
641suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
642shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
643command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
644in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
645stack frame for each active subroutine.
646
647@smallexample
648(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
649#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
650 at input.c:530
651#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
652 at builtin.c:882
653#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
654#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
655 at macro.c:71
656#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
657#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
658@end smallexample
659
660@noindent
661We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
662times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
663falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
664
665@smallexample
666(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6670x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
668(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6690x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
670def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
671(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
672536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
673 : xstrdup(rq);
674(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
676@end smallexample
677
678@noindent
679The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
680@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
681and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
682(@code{print}) to see their values.
683
684@smallexample
685(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
686$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
687(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
688$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
689@end smallexample
690
691@noindent
692@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
693To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
694surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
695
696@smallexample
697(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
698533 xfree(rquote);
699534
700535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
701 : xstrdup (lq);
702536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
703 : xstrdup (rq);
704537
705538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
706539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
707540 @}
708541
709542 void
710@end smallexample
711
712@noindent
713Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
714@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
715
716@smallexample
717(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
718539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
719(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
720540 @}
721(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
722$3 = 9
723(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
724$4 = 7
725@end smallexample
726
727@noindent
728That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
729@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
730@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
731the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
732any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
733assignments.
734
735@smallexample
736(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
737$5 = 7
738(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
739$6 = 9
740@end smallexample
741
742@noindent
743Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
744@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
745executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
746example that caused trouble initially:
747
748@smallexample
749(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
750Continuing.
751
752@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
753
754baz
7550000
756@end smallexample
757
758@noindent
759Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
760problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
761lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
762
763@smallexample
764@b{Ctrl-d}
765Program exited normally.
766@end smallexample
767
768@noindent
769The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
770indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
771session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
772
773@smallexample
774(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
775@end smallexample
776
777@node Invocation
778@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
779
780This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
781The essentials are:
782@itemize @bullet
783@item
784type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
785@item
786type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
787@end itemize
788
789@menu
790* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
791* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
792* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
793* Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
794@end menu
795
796@node Invoking GDB
797@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
798
799Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
800@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
801
802You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
803to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
804
805The command-line options described here are designed
806to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
807options may effectively be unavailable.
808
809The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
810specifying an executable program:
811
812@smallexample
813@value{GDBP} @var{program}
814@end smallexample
815
816@noindent
817You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
818specified:
819
820@smallexample
821@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
822@end smallexample
823
824You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
825to debug a running process:
826
827@smallexample
828@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
829@end smallexample
830
831@noindent
832would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
833named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
834
835Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
836complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
837debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
838``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
839will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
840
841You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
842executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
843option processing.
844@smallexample
845@value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
846@end smallexample
847This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
848@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
849
850You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
851@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
852
853@smallexample
854@value{GDBP} -silent
855@end smallexample
856
857@noindent
858You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
859options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
860
861@noindent
862Type
863
864@smallexample
865@value{GDBP} -help
866@end smallexample
867
868@noindent
869to display all available options and briefly describe their use
870(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
871
872All options and command line arguments you give are processed
873in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
874@samp{-x} option is used.
875
876
877@menu
878* File Options:: Choosing files
879* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
880* Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
881@end menu
882
883@node File Options
884@subsection Choosing Files
885
886When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
887specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
888the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
889@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
890first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
891equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
892second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
893equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
894If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
895first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
896to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
897a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
898prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
899
900If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
901such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
902argument and ignore it.
903
904Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
905following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
906them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
907(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
908than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
909
910@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
911@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
912@c it.
913
914@table @code
915@item -symbols @var{file}
916@itemx -s @var{file}
917@cindex @code{--symbols}
918@cindex @code{-s}
919Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
920
921@item -exec @var{file}
922@itemx -e @var{file}
923@cindex @code{--exec}
924@cindex @code{-e}
925Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
926and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
927
928@item -se @var{file}
929@cindex @code{--se}
930Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
931file.
932
933@item -core @var{file}
934@itemx -c @var{file}
935@cindex @code{--core}
936@cindex @code{-c}
937Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
938
939@item -c @var{number}
940@item -pid @var{number}
941@itemx -p @var{number}
942@cindex @code{--pid}
943@cindex @code{-p}
944Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
945If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
946file named @var{number}.
947
948@item -command @var{file}
949@itemx -x @var{file}
950@cindex @code{--command}
951@cindex @code{-x}
952Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
953Files,, Command files}.
954
955@item -eval-command @var{command}
956@itemx -ex @var{command}
957@cindex @code{--eval-command}
958@cindex @code{-ex}
959Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
960
961This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
962also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
963
964@smallexample
965@value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
966 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
967@end smallexample
968
969@item -directory @var{directory}
970@itemx -d @var{directory}
971@cindex @code{--directory}
972@cindex @code{-d}
973Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
974
975@item -r
976@itemx -readnow
977@cindex @code{--readnow}
978@cindex @code{-r}
979Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
980the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
981This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
982
983@end table
984
985@node Mode Options
986@subsection Choosing Modes
987
988You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
989batch mode or quiet mode.
990
991@table @code
992@item -nx
993@itemx -n
994@cindex @code{--nx}
995@cindex @code{-n}
996Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
997@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
998options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
999Files}.
1000
1001@item -quiet
1002@itemx -silent
1003@itemx -q
1004@cindex @code{--quiet}
1005@cindex @code{--silent}
1006@cindex @code{-q}
1007``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1008messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1009
1010@item -batch
1011@cindex @code{--batch}
1012Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1013command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1014initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1015nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1016in the command files.
1017
1018Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1019example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1020make this more useful, the message
1021
1022@smallexample
1023Program exited normally.
1024@end smallexample
1025
1026@noindent
1027(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1028@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1029mode.
1030
1031@item -batch-silent
1032@cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1033Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1034@value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1035unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1036for an interactive session.
1037
1038This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1039messages, for example.
1040
1041Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1042writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1043
1044@item -return-child-result
1045@cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1046The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1047process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1048
1049@itemize @bullet
1050@item
1051@value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1052internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1053without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1054@item
1055The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1056@item
1057The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1058the exit code will be -1.
1059@end itemize
1060
1061This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1062when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1063interface.
1064
1065@item -nowindows
1066@itemx -nw
1067@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1068@cindex @code{-nw}
1069``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1070(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1071interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1072
1073@item -windows
1074@itemx -w
1075@cindex @code{--windows}
1076@cindex @code{-w}
1077If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1078used if possible.
1079
1080@item -cd @var{directory}
1081@cindex @code{--cd}
1082Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1083instead of the current directory.
1084
1085@item -fullname
1086@itemx -f
1087@cindex @code{--fullname}
1088@cindex @code{-f}
1089@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1090subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1091number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1092displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1093recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1094the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1095and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1096@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1097frame.
1098
1099@item -epoch
1100@cindex @code{--epoch}
1101The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1102@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1103routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1104separate window.
1105
1106@item -annotate @var{level}
1107@cindex @code{--annotate}
1108This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1109effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1110(@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1111information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1112expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1113normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1114@sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1115that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1116
1117The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1118(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1119
1120@item --args
1121@cindex @code{--args}
1122Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1123executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1124This option stops option processing.
1125
1126@item -baud @var{bps}
1127@itemx -b @var{bps}
1128@cindex @code{--baud}
1129@cindex @code{-b}
1130Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1131interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1132
1133@item -l @var{timeout}
1134@cindex @code{-l}
1135Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1136for remote debugging.
1137
1138@item -tty @var{device}
1139@itemx -t @var{device}
1140@cindex @code{--tty}
1141@cindex @code{-t}
1142Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1143@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1144
1145@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1146@item -tui
1147@cindex @code{--tui}
1148Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1149Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1150source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1151(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1152Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1153@samp{gdbtui}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1154Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1155
1156@c @item -xdb
1157@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1158@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1159@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1160@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1161@c systems.
1162
1163@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1164@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1165Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1166program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1167communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1168@xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1169
1170@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1171@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1172The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1173previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1174selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1175@sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1176
1177@item -write
1178@cindex @code{--write}
1179Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1180is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1181(@pxref{Patching}).
1182
1183@item -statistics
1184@cindex @code{--statistics}
1185This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1186memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1187
1188@item -version
1189@cindex @code{--version}
1190This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1191no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1192
1193@end table
1194
1195@node Startup
1196@subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1197@cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1198
1199Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1200
1201@enumerate
1202@item
1203Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1204(@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1205
1206@item
1207@cindex init file
1208Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1209DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1210@code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1211that file.
1212
1213@item
1214Processes command line options and operands.
1215
1216@item
1217Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1218working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1219different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1220init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1221to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1222@value{GDBN}.
1223
1224@item
1225Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1226Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1227
1228@item
1229Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1230@xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1231files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1232@end enumerate
1233
1234Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1235Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1236file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1237complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1238and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1239option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1240
1241@cindex init file name
1242@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1243@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1244The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1245The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1246the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1247ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1248@file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1249the file to the standard name.
1250
1251
1252@node Quitting GDB
1253@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1254@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1255@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1256
1257@table @code
1258@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1259@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1260@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1261@itemx q
1262To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1263@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1264do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1265otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1266error code.
1267@end table
1268
1269@cindex interrupt
1270An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1271terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1272returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1273character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1274until a time when it is safe.
1275
1276If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1277device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1278(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1279
1280@node Shell Commands
1281@section Shell Commands
1282
1283If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1284debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1285just use the @code{shell} command.
1286
1287@table @code
1288@kindex shell
1289@cindex shell escape
1290@item shell @var{command string}
1291Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1292If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1293shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1294(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1295@end table
1296
1297The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1298You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1299@value{GDBN}:
1300
1301@table @code
1302@kindex make
1303@cindex calling make
1304@item make @var{make-args}
1305Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1306arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1307@end table
1308
1309@node Logging Output
1310@section Logging Output
1311@cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1312@cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1313
1314You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1315There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1316
1317@table @code
1318@kindex set logging
1319@item set logging on
1320Enable logging.
1321@item set logging off
1322Disable logging.
1323@cindex logging file name
1324@item set logging file @var{file}
1325Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1326@item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1327By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1328you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1329@item set logging redirect [on|off]
1330By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1331Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1332@kindex show logging
1333@item show logging
1334Show the current values of the logging settings.
1335@end table
1336
1337@node Commands
1338@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1339
1340You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1341name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1342@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1343key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1344show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1345
1346@menu
1347* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1348* Completion:: Command completion
1349* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1350@end menu
1351
1352@node Command Syntax
1353@section Command Syntax
1354
1355A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1356how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1357arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1358command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1359step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1360with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1361
1362@cindex abbreviation
1363@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1364unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1365documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1366abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1367equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1368names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1369arguments to the @code{help} command.
1370
1371@cindex repeating commands
1372@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1373A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1374repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1375will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1376repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1377repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1378@ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1379
1380The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1381@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1382exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1383
1384@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1385output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1386(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1387@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1388repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1389
1390@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1391@cindex comment
1392Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1393nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1394Files,,Command Files}).
1395
1396@cindex repeating command sequences
1397@kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1398The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1399commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1400then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1401for editing.
1402
1403@node Completion
1404@section Command Completion
1405
1406@cindex completion
1407@cindex word completion
1408@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1409only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1410are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1411commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1412
1413Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1414of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1415word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1416enter it). For example, if you type
1417
1418@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1419@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1420@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1421@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1422@smallexample
1423(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1424@end smallexample
1425
1426@noindent
1427@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1428the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1429
1430@smallexample
1431(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1432@end smallexample
1433
1434@noindent
1435You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1436breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1437@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1438were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1439might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1440to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1441
1442If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1443@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1444characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1445@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1446example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1447begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1448just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1449function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1450example:
1451
1452@smallexample
1453(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1454@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1455make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1456make_abs_section make_function_type
1457make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1458make_cleanup make_reference_type
1459make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1460(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1461@end smallexample
1462
1463@noindent
1464After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1465partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1466command.
1467
1468If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1469can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1470means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1471key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1472one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1473
1474@cindex quotes in commands
1475@cindex completion of quoted strings
1476Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1477parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1478its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1479situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1480@value{GDBN} commands.
1481
1482The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1483name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1484overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1485by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1486may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1487that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1488that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1489word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1490@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1491@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1492when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1493
1494@smallexample
1495(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1496bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1497(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1498@end smallexample
1499
1500In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1501quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1502completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1503place:
1504
1505@smallexample
1506(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1507@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1508(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1509@end smallexample
1510
1511@noindent
1512In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1513you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1514completion on an overloaded symbol.
1515
1516For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1517Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1518overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1519see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1520
1521
1522@node Help
1523@section Getting Help
1524@cindex online documentation
1525@kindex help
1526
1527You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1528using the command @code{help}.
1529
1530@table @code
1531@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1532@item help
1533@itemx h
1534You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1535display a short list of named classes of commands:
1536
1537@smallexample
1538(@value{GDBP}) help
1539List of classes of commands:
1540
1541aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1542breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1543data -- Examining data
1544files -- Specifying and examining files
1545internals -- Maintenance commands
1546obscure -- Obscure features
1547running -- Running the program
1548stack -- Examining the stack
1549status -- Status inquiries
1550support -- Support facilities
1551tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1552 stopping the program
1553user-defined -- User-defined commands
1554
1555Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1556commands in that class.
1557Type "help" followed by command name for full
1558documentation.
1559Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1560(@value{GDBP})
1561@end smallexample
1562@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1563
1564@item help @var{class}
1565Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1566list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1567help display for the class @code{status}:
1568
1569@smallexample
1570(@value{GDBP}) help status
1571Status inquiries.
1572
1573List of commands:
1574
1575@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1576@c to fit in smallbook page size.
1577info -- Generic command for showing things
1578 about the program being debugged
1579show -- Generic command for showing things
1580 about the debugger
1581
1582Type "help" followed by command name for full
1583documentation.
1584Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1585(@value{GDBP})
1586@end smallexample
1587
1588@item help @var{command}
1589With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1590short paragraph on how to use that command.
1591
1592@kindex apropos
1593@item apropos @var{args}
1594The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1595commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1596@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1597
1598@smallexample
1599apropos reload
1600@end smallexample
1601
1602@noindent
1603results in:
1604
1605@smallexample
1606@c @group
1607set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1608 multiple times in one run
1609show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1610 multiple times in one run
1611@c @end group
1612@end smallexample
1613
1614@kindex complete
1615@item complete @var{args}
1616The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1617for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1618command you want completed. For example:
1619
1620@smallexample
1621complete i
1622@end smallexample
1623
1624@noindent results in:
1625
1626@smallexample
1627@group
1628if
1629ignore
1630info
1631inspect
1632@end group
1633@end smallexample
1634
1635@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1636@end table
1637
1638In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1639and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1640of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1641manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1642under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1643all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1644
1645@c @group
1646@table @code
1647@kindex info
1648@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1649@item info
1650This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1651program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1652with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1653registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1654You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1655@w{@code{help info}}.
1656
1657@kindex set
1658@item set
1659You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1660@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1661@code{set prompt $}.
1662
1663@kindex show
1664@item show
1665In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1666@value{GDBN} itself.
1667You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1668related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1669system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1670which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1671
1672@kindex info set
1673To display all the settable parameters and their current
1674values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1675@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1676@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1677@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1678@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1679@end table
1680@c @end group
1681
1682Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1683exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1684
1685@table @code
1686@kindex show version
1687@cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1688@item show version
1689Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1690information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1691@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1692version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1693commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1694system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1695variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1696The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1697@value{GDBN}.
1698
1699@kindex show copying
1700@kindex info copying
1701@cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1702@item show copying
1703@itemx info copying
1704Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1705
1706@kindex show warranty
1707@kindex info warranty
1708@item show warranty
1709@itemx info warranty
1710Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1711if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1712
1713@end table
1714
1715@node Running
1716@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1717
1718When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1719debugging information when you compile it.
1720
1721You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1722of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1723your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1724kill a child process.
1725
1726@menu
1727* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1728* Starting:: Starting your program
1729* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1730* Environment:: Your program's environment
1731
1732* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1733* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1734* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1735* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1736
1737* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1738* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1739* Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1740@end menu
1741
1742@node Compilation
1743@section Compiling for Debugging
1744
1745In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1746debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1747is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1748variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1749and addresses in the executable code.
1750
1751To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1752the compiler.
1753
1754Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1755optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1756compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1757together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1758executables containing debugging information.
1759
1760@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1761without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1762recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1763program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1764in pushing your luck.
1765
1766@cindex optimized code, debugging
1767@cindex debugging optimized code
1768When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1769optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1770really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1771exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1772variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1773variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1774
1775Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1776@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1777doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1778please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1779@xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1780
1781Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1782@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1783format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1784
1785@value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1786expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1787about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1788the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1789Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1790provides macro information if you specify the options
1791@option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1792debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1793``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1794ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1795@option{-g} alone.
1796
1797@need 2000
1798@node Starting
1799@section Starting your Program
1800@cindex starting
1801@cindex running
1802
1803@table @code
1804@kindex run
1805@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1806@item run
1807@itemx r
1808Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1809You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1810argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1811@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1812(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1813
1814@end table
1815
1816If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1817supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1818that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1819@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1820
1821The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1822receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1823information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1824can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1825your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1826divided into four categories:
1827
1828@table @asis
1829@item The @emph{arguments.}
1830Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1831@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1832is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1833(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1834the arguments.
1835In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1836@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1837@xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1838
1839@item The @emph{environment.}
1840Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1841use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1842environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1843your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1844
1845@item The @emph{working directory.}
1846Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1847the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1848@xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1849
1850@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1851Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1852standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1853in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1854set a different device for your program.
1855@xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1856
1857@cindex pipes
1858@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1859pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1860program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1861wrong program.
1862@end table
1863
1864When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1865immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1866of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1867stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1868or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1869
1870If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1871time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1872table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1873your current breakpoints.
1874
1875@table @code
1876@kindex start
1877@item start
1878@cindex run to main procedure
1879The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1880With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1881other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1882main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1883execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1884procedure, depending on the language used.
1885
1886The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1887breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1888the @samp{run} command.
1889
1890@cindex elaboration phase
1891Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1892executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1893languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1894constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1895@code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1896before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1897will remain to halt execution.
1898
1899Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1900@samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1901underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1902reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1903@samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1904
1905It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1906these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1907your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1908elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1909elaboration code before running your program.
1910@end table
1911
1912@node Arguments
1913@section Your Program's Arguments
1914
1915@cindex arguments (to your program)
1916The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1917@code{run} command.
1918They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1919performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1920@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1921@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1922the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1923
1924On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1925@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1926calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1927the program, not by the shell.
1928
1929@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1930@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1931
1932@table @code
1933@kindex set args
1934@item set args
1935Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1936@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1937with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1938using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1939it again without arguments.
1940
1941@kindex show args
1942@item show args
1943Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1944@end table
1945
1946@node Environment
1947@section Your Program's Environment
1948
1949@cindex environment (of your program)
1950The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1951their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1952your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1953path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1954the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1955debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1956environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1957
1958@table @code
1959@kindex path
1960@item path @var{directory}
1961Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1962(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1963The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1964You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1965system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1966MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1967is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1968
1969You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1970working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1971use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1972@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1973@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1974@var{directory} to the search path.
1975@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1976@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1977
1978@kindex show paths
1979@item show paths
1980Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1981environment variable).
1982
1983@kindex show environment
1984@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1985Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1986your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1987print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1988your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1989
1990@kindex set environment
1991@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1992Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1993changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1994be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1995any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1996parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1997null value.
1998@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1999@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2000
2001For example, this command:
2002
2003@smallexample
2004set env USER = foo
2005@end smallexample
2006
2007@noindent
2008tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2009@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2010are not actually required.)
2011
2012@kindex unset environment
2013@item unset environment @var{varname}
2014Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2015program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2016@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2017rather than assigning it an empty value.
2018@end table
2019
2020@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2021the shell indicated
2022by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2023@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2024that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2025@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2026your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2027files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2028@file{.profile}.
2029
2030@node Working Directory
2031@section Your Program's Working Directory
2032
2033@cindex working directory (of your program)
2034Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2035working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2036The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2037from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2038working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2039
2040The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2041that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2042Specify Files}.
2043
2044@table @code
2045@kindex cd
2046@cindex change working directory
2047@item cd @var{directory}
2048Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2049
2050@kindex pwd
2051@item pwd
2052Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2053@end table
2054
2055It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2056the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2057during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2058configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2059proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2060current working directory of the debuggee.
2061
2062@node Input/Output
2063@section Your Program's Input and Output
2064
2065@cindex redirection
2066@cindex i/o
2067@cindex terminal
2068By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2069the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2070to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2071modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2072running your program.
2073
2074@table @code
2075@kindex info terminal
2076@item info terminal
2077Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2078program is using.
2079@end table
2080
2081You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2082redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2083
2084@smallexample
2085run > outfile
2086@end smallexample
2087
2088@noindent
2089starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2090
2091@kindex tty
2092@cindex controlling terminal
2093Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2094with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2095argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2096commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2097process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2098
2099@smallexample
2100tty /dev/ttyb
2101@end smallexample
2102
2103@noindent
2104directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2105default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2106that as their controlling terminal.
2107
2108An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2109effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2110terminal.
2111
2112When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2113command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2114for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2115for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2116
2117@cindex inferior tty
2118@cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2119You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2120display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2121program.
2122
2123@table @code
2124@item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2125@kindex set inferior-tty
2126Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2127
2128@item show inferior-tty
2129@kindex show inferior-tty
2130Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2131@end table
2132
2133@node Attach
2134@section Debugging an Already-running Process
2135@kindex attach
2136@cindex attach
2137
2138@table @code
2139@item attach @var{process-id}
2140This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2141outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2142targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2143find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2144or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2145
2146@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2147executing the command.
2148@end table
2149
2150To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2151which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2152programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2153also have permission to send the process a signal.
2154
2155When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2156the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2157the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2158(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2159the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2160Specify Files}.
2161
2162The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2163process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2164with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2165you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2166can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2167process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2168attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2169
2170@table @code
2171@kindex detach
2172@item detach
2173When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2174@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2175the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2176that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2177are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2178@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2179executing the command.
2180@end table
2181
2182If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2183attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2184for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2185control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2186confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2187Messages}).
2188
2189@node Kill Process
2190@section Killing the Child Process
2191
2192@table @code
2193@kindex kill
2194@item kill
2195Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2196@end table
2197
2198This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2199running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2200is running.
2201
2202On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2203while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2204@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2205outside the debugger.
2206
2207The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2208relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2209executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2210next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2211reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2212breakpoint settings).
2213
2214@node Threads
2215@section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2216
2217@cindex threads of execution
2218@cindex multiple threads
2219@cindex switching threads
2220In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2221may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2222of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2223the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2224that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2225modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2226registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2227
2228@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2229programs:
2230
2231@itemize @bullet
2232@item automatic notification of new threads
2233@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2234@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2235@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2236a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2237@item thread-specific breakpoints
2238@end itemize
2239
2240@quotation
2241@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2242@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2243If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2244effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2245from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2246like this:
2247
2248@smallexample
2249(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2250(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2251Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2252see the IDs of currently known threads.
2253@end smallexample
2254@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2255@c doesn't support threads"?
2256@end quotation
2257
2258@cindex focus of debugging
2259@cindex current thread
2260The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2261threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2262control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2263This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2264program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2265
2266@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2267@cindex thread identifier (system)
2268@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2269@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2270@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2271Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2272the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2273form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2274whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2275@sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2276
2277@smallexample
2278[New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2279@end smallexample
2280
2281@noindent
2282when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2283the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2284further qualifier.
2285
2286@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2287@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2288@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2289@c program?
2290@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2291@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2292@c threads ab initio?
2293
2294@cindex thread number
2295@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2296For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2297number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2298
2299@table @code
2300@kindex info threads
2301@item info threads
2302Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2303program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2304
2305@enumerate
2306@item
2307the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2308
2309@item
2310the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2311
2312@item
2313the current stack frame summary for that thread
2314@end enumerate
2315
2316@noindent
2317An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2318indicates the current thread.
2319
2320For example,
2321@end table
2322@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2323
2324@smallexample
2325(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2326 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2327 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2328* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2329 at threadtest.c:68
2330@end smallexample
2331
2332On HP-UX systems:
2333
2334@cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2335@cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2336For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2337number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2338thread in your program.
2339
2340@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2341@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2342@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2343@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2344@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2345Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2346both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2347form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2348whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2349HP-UX, you see
2350
2351@smallexample
2352[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2353@end smallexample
2354
2355@noindent
2356when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2357
2358@table @code
2359@kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2360@item info threads
2361Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2362program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2363
2364@enumerate
2365@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2366
2367@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2368
2369@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2370@end enumerate
2371
2372@noindent
2373An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2374indicates the current thread.
2375
2376For example,
2377@end table
2378@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2379
2380@smallexample
2381(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2382 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2383 at quicksort.c:137
2384 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2385 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2386 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2387 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2388@end smallexample
2389
2390On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2391Solaris-specific command:
2392
2393@table @code
2394@item maint info sol-threads
2395@kindex maint info sol-threads
2396@cindex thread info (Solaris)
2397Display info on Solaris user threads.
2398@end table
2399
2400@table @code
2401@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2402@item thread @var{threadno}
2403Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2404argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2405shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2406@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2407you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2408
2409@smallexample
2410@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2411(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2412[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
24130x34e5 in sigpause ()
2414@end smallexample
2415
2416@noindent
2417As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2418@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2419threads.
2420
2421@kindex thread apply
2422@cindex apply command to several threads
2423@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2424The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2425@var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2426threads that you want affected with the command argument
2427@var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2428shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2429could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2430command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2431@end table
2432
2433@cindex automatic thread selection
2434@cindex switching threads automatically
2435@cindex threads, automatic switching
2436Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2437signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2438signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2439message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2440thread.
2441
2442@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2443more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2444programs with multiple threads.
2445
2446@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2447watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2448
2449@node Processes
2450@section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2451
2452@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2453@cindex multiple processes
2454@cindex processes, multiple
2455On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2456programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2457function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2458parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2459set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2460will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2461will cause it to terminate.
2462
2463However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2464which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2465the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2466only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2467so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2468on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2469get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2470@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2471the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2472the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2473
2474On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2475create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2476Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2477only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2478
2479By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2480the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2481
2482If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2483use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2484
2485@table @code
2486@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2487@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2488Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2489@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2490process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2491
2492@table @code
2493@item parent
2494The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2495unimpeded. This is the default.
2496
2497@item child
2498The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2499unimpeded.
2500
2501@end table
2502
2503@kindex show follow-fork-mode
2504@item show follow-fork-mode
2505Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2506@end table
2507
2508@cindex debugging multiple processes
2509On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2510command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2511
2512@table @code
2513@kindex set detach-on-fork
2514@item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2515Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2516retain debugger control over them both.
2517
2518@table @code
2519@item on
2520The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2521@code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2522independently. This is the default.
2523
2524@item off
2525Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2526One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2527@code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2528is held suspended.
2529
2530@end table
2531
2532@kindex show detach-on-follow
2533@item show detach-on-follow
2534Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2535@end table
2536
2537If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2538@value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2539nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2540@value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2541from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2542
2543@table @code
2544@kindex info forks
2545@item info forks
2546Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2547The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2548position (program counter) of the process.
2549
2550
2551@kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2552@item fork @var{fork-id}
2553Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2554@var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2555as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2556
2557@end table
2558
2559To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2560from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2561run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2562@w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2563
2564@table @code
2565@kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2566@item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2567Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2568@var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2569allowed to run independently.
2570
2571@kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2572@item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2573Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2574and remove it from the fork list.
2575
2576@end table
2577
2578If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2579@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2580breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2581@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2582the child process's @code{main}.
2583
2584When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2585child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2586
2587If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2588call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2589use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2590argument.
2591
2592You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2593a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2594Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2595
2596@node Checkpoint/Restart
2597@section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2598
2599@cindex checkpoint
2600@cindex restart
2601@cindex bookmark
2602@cindex snapshot of a process
2603@cindex rewind program state
2604
2605On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2606@sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2607program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2608later.
2609
2610Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2611happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2612includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2613system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2614moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2615
2616Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2617getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2618a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2619the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2620from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2621start again from there.
2622
2623This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2624steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2625
2626To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2627
2628@table @code
2629@kindex checkpoint
2630@item checkpoint
2631Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2632The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2633is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2634
2635@kindex info checkpoints
2636@item info checkpoints
2637List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2638session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2639listed:
2640
2641@table @code
2642@item Checkpoint ID
2643@item Process ID
2644@item Code Address
2645@item Source line, or label
2646@end table
2647
2648@kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2649@item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2650Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2651@var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2652etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2653was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2654in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2655
2656Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2657are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2658only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2659the debugger.
2660
2661@kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2662@item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2663Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2664
2665@end table
2666
2667Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2668of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2669(OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2670a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2671so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2672opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2673previously read data can be read again.
2674
2675Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2676external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2677from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2678but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2679be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2680been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2681
2682However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2683program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2684again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2685different execution path this time.
2686
2687@cindex checkpoints and process id
2688Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2689different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2690id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2691and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2692If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2693potentially pose a problem.
2694
2695@subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2696
2697On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2698is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2699difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2700absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2701absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2702next.
2703
2704A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2705Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2706and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2707process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2708your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2709
2710@node Stopping
2711@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2712
2713The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2714program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2715trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2716
2717Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2718such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2719@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2720change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2721continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2722ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2723explicitly request this information at any time.
2724
2725@table @code
2726@kindex info program
2727@item info program
2728Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2729running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2730@end table
2731
2732@menu
2733* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2734* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2735* Signals:: Signals
2736* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2737@end menu
2738
2739@node Breakpoints
2740@section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2741
2742@cindex breakpoints
2743A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2744the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2745control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2746breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2747Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2748should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2749program.
2750
2751On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2752the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2753you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2754in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2755(for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2756call).
2757
2758@cindex watchpoints
2759@cindex data breakpoints
2760@cindex memory tracing
2761@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2762@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2763A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2764when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2765of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2766combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2767@dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2768watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2769from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2770enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2771same commands.
2772
2773You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2774whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2775Automatic Display}.
2776
2777@cindex catchpoints
2778@cindex breakpoint on events
2779A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2780when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2781exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2782different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2783Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2784other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2785@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2786
2787@cindex breakpoint numbers
2788@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2789@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2790catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2791starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2792features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2793breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2794@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2795enable it again.
2796
2797@cindex breakpoint ranges
2798@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2799Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2800operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2801@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2802hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2803all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
2804
2805@menu
2806* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2807* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2808* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2809* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2810* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2811* Conditions:: Break conditions
2812* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2813* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2814* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2815* Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2816@end menu
2817
2818@node Set Breaks
2819@subsection Setting Breakpoints
2820
2821@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2822@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2823@c
2824@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2825
2826@kindex break
2827@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2828@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2829@cindex latest breakpoint
2830Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2831@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2832number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2833Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2834convenience variables.
2835
2836You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2837
2838@table @code
2839@item break @var{function}
2840Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2841When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2842C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2843@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2844
2845@item break +@var{offset}
2846@itemx break -@var{offset}
2847Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2848at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2849(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2850
2851@item break @var{linenum}
2852Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2853The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2854The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2855code on that line.
2856
2857@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2858Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2859
2860@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2861Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2862@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2863superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2864functions.
2865
2866@item break *@var{address}
2867Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2868breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2869information or source files.
2870
2871@item break
2872When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2873the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2874(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2875innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2876returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2877@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2878that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2879@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2880the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2881inside loops.
2882
2883@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2884least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2885would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2886breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2887existed when your program stopped.
2888
2889@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2890Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2891@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2892value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2893@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2894above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2895,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2896
2897@kindex tbreak
2898@item tbreak @var{args}
2899Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2900same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2901way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2902program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2903
2904@kindex hbreak
2905@cindex hardware breakpoints
2906@item hbreak @var{args}
2907Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2908@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2909breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2910have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2911debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2912changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2913provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2914will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2915address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2916breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2917example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2918@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2919or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2920(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
2921@xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2922For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2923breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2924hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2925
2926
2927@kindex thbreak
2928@item thbreak @var{args}
2929Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2930are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2931the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2932the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2933first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2934command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2935may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
2936See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
2937
2938@kindex rbreak
2939@cindex regular expression
2940@cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2941@cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2942@item rbreak @var{regex}
2943Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2944@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2945matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2946breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2947the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2948them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2949
2950The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2951like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2952shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2953an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2954@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2955match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2956
2957@cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2958When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2959breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2960classes.
2961
2962@cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2963The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2964@strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2965
2966@smallexample
2967(@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2968@end smallexample
2969
2970@kindex info breakpoints
2971@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2972@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2973@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2974@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2975Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2976not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
2977about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
2978each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
2979
2980@table @emph
2981@item Breakpoint Numbers
2982@item Type
2983Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2984@item Disposition
2985Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2986@item Enabled or Disabled
2987Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2988that are not enabled.
2989@item Address
2990Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. If the
2991breakpoint is pending (see below for details) on a future load of a shared library, the address
2992will be listed as @samp{<PENDING>}.
2993@item What
2994Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2995line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
2996the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
2997the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
2998@end table
2999
3000@noindent
3001If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3002the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3003are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3004specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3005library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3006valid location.
3007
3008@noindent
3009@code{info break} with a breakpoint
3010number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3011convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3012the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3013listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3014
3015@noindent
3016@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3017has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3018@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3019hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3020was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3021will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3022@end table
3023
3024@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3025your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3026the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3027(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3028
3029@cindex pending breakpoints
3030If a specified breakpoint location cannot be found, it may be due to the fact
3031that the location is in a shared library that is yet to be loaded. In such
3032a case, you may want @value{GDBN} to create a special breakpoint (known as
3033a @dfn{pending breakpoint}) that
3034attempts to resolve itself in the future when an appropriate shared library
3035gets loaded.
3036
3037Pending breakpoints are useful to set at the start of your
3038@value{GDBN} session for locations that you know will be dynamically loaded
3039later by the program being debugged. When shared libraries are loaded,
3040a check is made to see if the load resolves any pending breakpoint locations.
3041If a pending breakpoint location gets resolved,
3042a regular breakpoint is created and the original pending breakpoint is removed.
3043
3044@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling pending
3045breakpoint support:
3046
3047@kindex set breakpoint pending
3048@kindex show breakpoint pending
3049@table @code
3050@item set breakpoint pending auto
3051This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3052location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3053
3054@item set breakpoint pending on
3055This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3056result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3057
3058@item set breakpoint pending off
3059This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3060unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3061not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3062
3063@item show breakpoint pending
3064Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3065@end table
3066
3067@cindex operations allowed on pending breakpoints
3068Normal breakpoint operations apply to pending breakpoints as well. You may
3069specify a condition for a pending breakpoint and/or commands to run when the
3070breakpoint is reached. You can also enable or disable
3071the pending breakpoint. When you specify a condition for a pending breakpoint,
3072the parsing of the condition will be deferred until the point where the
3073pending breakpoint location is resolved. Disabling a pending breakpoint
3074tells @value{GDBN} to not attempt to resolve the breakpoint on any subsequent
3075shared library load. When a pending breakpoint is re-enabled,
3076@value{GDBN} checks to see if the location is already resolved.
3077This is done because any number of shared library loads could have
3078occurred since the time the breakpoint was disabled and one or more
3079of these loads could resolve the location.
3080
3081@cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3082For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3083software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3084breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3085breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3086breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3087breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3088breakpoints.
3089
3090You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3091
3092@kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3093@kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3094@table @code
3095@item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3096This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3097will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3098breakpoint must be used.
3099
3100@item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3101This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3102type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3103trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3104@end table
3105
3106
3107@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3108@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3109@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3110special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3111programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3112starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3113You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3114@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3115
3116
3117@node Set Watchpoints
3118@subsection Setting Watchpoints
3119
3120@cindex setting watchpoints
3121You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3122expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3123this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3124The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3125as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3126
3127@itemize @bullet
3128@item
3129A reference to the value of a single variable.
3130
3131@item
3132An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3133@samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3134address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3135
3136@item
3137An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3138expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3139language (@pxref{Languages}).
3140@end itemize
3141
3142@cindex software watchpoints
3143@cindex hardware watchpoints
3144Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3145hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3146program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3147times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3148catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3149culprit.)
3150
3151On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3152x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3153watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3154
3155@table @code
3156@kindex watch
3157@item watch @var{expr}
3158Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3159expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3160changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3161to watch the value of a single variable:
3162
3163@smallexample
3164(@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3165@end smallexample
3166
3167@kindex rwatch
3168@item rwatch @var{expr}
3169Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3170by the program.
3171
3172@kindex awatch
3173@item awatch @var{expr}
3174Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3175or written into by the program.
3176
3177@kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3178@item info watchpoints
3179This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3180it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3181@end table
3182
3183@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3184watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3185value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3186cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3187executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3188@emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3189
3190@cindex use only software watchpoints
3191You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3192@kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3193zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3194the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3195watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3196@code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3197mechanism of watching expression values.)
3198
3199@table @code
3200@item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3201@kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3202Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3203
3204@item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3205@kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3206Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3207@end table
3208
3209For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3210watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3211hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3212
3213When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3214
3215@smallexample
3216Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3217@end smallexample
3218
3219@noindent
3220if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3221
3222Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3223hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3224value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3225every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3226that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3227hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3228will print a message like this:
3229
3230@smallexample
3231Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3232@end smallexample
3233
3234Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3235data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3236watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3237can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3238cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3239double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3240wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3241into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3242
3243If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3244to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3245Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3246time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3247able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3248warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3249
3250@smallexample
3251Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3252@end smallexample
3253
3254@noindent
3255If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3256
3257Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3258exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3259That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3260expression with separately allocated resources.
3261
3262The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3263or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3264data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3265hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3266both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3267watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3268@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3269watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3270@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3271Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3272
3273If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3274any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3275kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3276
3277@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3278(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3279they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3280which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3281being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3282and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3283rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3284way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3285@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3286
3287@quotation
3288@cindex watchpoints and threads
3289@cindex threads and watchpoints
3290@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
3291usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
3292can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
3293you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
3294thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
3295can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
3296@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
3297the expression.
3298
3299@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
3300@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
3301have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3302watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3303single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3304change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3305confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3306software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3307when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3308watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3309@end quotation
3310
3311@xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3312
3313@node Set Catchpoints
3314@subsection Setting Catchpoints
3315@cindex catchpoints, setting
3316@cindex exception handlers
3317@cindex event handling
3318
3319You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3320kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3321shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3322
3323@table @code
3324@kindex catch
3325@item catch @var{event}
3326Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3327@table @code
3328@item throw
3329@cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3330The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3331
3332@item catch
3333The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3334
3335@item exception
3336@cindex Ada exception catching
3337@cindex catch Ada exceptions
3338An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3339at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3340the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3341Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3342
3343@item exception unhandled
3344An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3345
3346@item assert
3347A failed Ada assertion.
3348
3349@item exec
3350@cindex break on fork/exec
3351A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3352
3353@item fork
3354A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3355
3356@item vfork
3357A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3358
3359@item load
3360@itemx load @var{libname}
3361@cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3362The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3363@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3364
3365@item unload
3366@itemx unload @var{libname}
3367The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3368of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3369@end table
3370
3371@item tcatch @var{event}
3372Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3373automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3374
3375@end table
3376
3377Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3378
3379There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3380(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3381
3382@itemize @bullet
3383@item
3384If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3385control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3386raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3387returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3388simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3389that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3390you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3391disabled within interactive calls.
3392
3393@item
3394You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3395
3396@item
3397You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3398@end itemize
3399
3400@cindex raise exceptions
3401Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3402if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3403stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3404can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3405breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3406out where the exception was raised.
3407
3408To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3409knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3410raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3411which has the following ANSI C interface:
3412
3413@smallexample
3414 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3415 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3416 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3417@end smallexample
3418
3419@noindent
3420To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3421unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3422(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3423
3424With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3425that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3426a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3427breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3428raised.
3429
3430
3431@node Delete Breaks
3432@subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3433
3434@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3435@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3436It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3437catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3438to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3439breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3440
3441With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3442where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3443delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3444their breakpoint numbers.
3445
3446It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3447automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3448when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3449
3450@table @code
3451@kindex clear
3452@item clear
3453Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3454selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3455the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3456breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3457
3458@item clear @var{function}
3459@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3460Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3461
3462@item clear @var{linenum}
3463@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3464Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3465@var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3466
3467@cindex delete breakpoints
3468@kindex delete
3469@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3470@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3471Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3472ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3473breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3474confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3475@end table
3476
3477@node Disabling
3478@subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3479
3480@cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3481Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3482prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3483it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3484that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3485
3486You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3487the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3488or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3489@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3490catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3491
3492A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3493states of enablement:
3494
3495@itemize @bullet
3496@item
3497Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3498with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3499@item
3500Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3501@item
3502Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3503disabled.
3504@item
3505Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3506immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3507set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3508@end itemize
3509
3510You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3511watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3512
3513@table @code
3514@kindex disable
3515@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3516@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3517Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3518listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3519options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3520case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3521@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3522
3523@kindex enable
3524@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3525Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3526become effective once again in stopping your program.
3527
3528@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3529Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3530of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3531
3532@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3533Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3534deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3535Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3536@end table
3537
3538@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3539@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3540Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3541,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3542subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3543the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3544breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3545breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3546Stepping}.)
3547
3548@node Conditions
3549@subsection Break Conditions
3550@cindex conditional breakpoints
3551@cindex breakpoint conditions
3552
3553@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3554@c in particular for a watchpoint?
3555The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3556specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3557breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3558programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3559a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3560and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3561
3562This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3563situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3564when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3565by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3566@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3567
3568Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3569since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3570it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3571and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3572one.
3573
3574Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3575your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3576that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3577format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3578unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3579that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3580program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3581breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3582conditions for the
3583purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3584(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3585
3586Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3587@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3588Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3589with the @code{condition} command.
3590
3591You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3592The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3593@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3594catchpoint.
3595
3596@table @code
3597@kindex condition
3598@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3599Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3600watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3601breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3602@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3603@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3604syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3605referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3606symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3607prints an error message:
3608
3609@smallexample
3610No symbol "foo" in current context.
3611@end smallexample
3612
3613@noindent
3614@value{GDBN} does
3615not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3616command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3617@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3618
3619@item condition @var{bnum}
3620Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3621an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3622@end table
3623
3624@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3625A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3626breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3627useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3628count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3629is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3630therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3631ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3632the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3633value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3634your program reaches it.
3635
3636@table @code
3637@kindex ignore
3638@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3639Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3640The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3641execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3642takes no action.
3643
3644To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3645a count of zero.
3646
3647When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3648breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3649@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3650Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3651
3652If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3653condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3654@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3655
3656You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3657as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3658is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3659Variables}.
3660@end table
3661
3662Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3663
3664
3665@node Break Commands
3666@subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3667
3668@cindex breakpoint commands
3669You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3670commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3671example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3672enable other breakpoints.
3673
3674@table @code
3675@kindex commands
3676@kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3677@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3678@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3679@itemx end
3680Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3681themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3682@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3683
3684To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3685follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3686
3687With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3688breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3689recently encountered).
3690@end table
3691
3692Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3693disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3694
3695You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3696use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3697that resumes execution.
3698
3699Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3700execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3701(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3702another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3703ambiguities about which list to execute.
3704
3705@kindex silent
3706If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3707usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3708be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3709then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3710see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3711meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3712
3713The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3714print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3715breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
3716
3717For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3718value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3719
3720@smallexample
3721break foo if x>0
3722commands
3723silent
3724printf "x is %d\n",x
3725cont
3726end
3727@end smallexample
3728
3729One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3730you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3731of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3732erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3733to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3734so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3735command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3736
3737@smallexample
3738break 403
3739commands
3740silent
3741set x = y + 4
3742cont
3743end
3744@end smallexample
3745
3746@node Breakpoint Menus
3747@subsection Breakpoint Menus
3748@cindex overloading
3749@cindex symbol overloading
3750
3751Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3752single function name
3753to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3754This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3755@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3756a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3757something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3758particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3759you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3760waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3761options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3762sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3763@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3764breakpoints.
3765
3766For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3767breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3768We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3769
3770@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3771@smallexample
3772@group
3773(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3774[0] cancel
3775[1] all
3776[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3777[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3778[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3779[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3780[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3781[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3782> 2 4 6
3783Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3784Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3785Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3786Multiple breakpoints were set.
3787Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3788 breakpoints.
3789(@value{GDBP})
3790@end group
3791@end smallexample
3792
3793@c @ifclear BARETARGET
3794@node Error in Breakpoints
3795@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3796@c
3797@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3798@c
3799Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3800any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3801attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3802@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3803
3804@smallexample
3805Cannot insert breakpoints.
3806The same program may be running in another process.
3807@end smallexample
3808
3809When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3810
3811@enumerate
3812@item
3813Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3814
3815@item
3816Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3817name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3818that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3819Then start your program again.
3820
3821@item
3822Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3823linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3824to nonsharable executables.
3825@end enumerate
3826@c @end ifclear
3827
3828A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3829hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3830
3831@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3832@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3833@smallexample
3834Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3835You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3836@end smallexample
3837
3838@noindent
3839This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3840only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3841watchpoints it needs to insert.
3842
3843When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3844hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3845
3846@node Breakpoint-related Warnings
3847@subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3848@cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3849
3850Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3851which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3852@value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3853with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3854
3855One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3856a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3857bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3858constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3859bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3860honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3861first in the bundle.
3862
3863It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3864instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3865a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3866another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3867breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3868printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3869is hit.
3870
3871A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3872that's been subject to address adjustment:
3873
3874@smallexample
3875warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3876@end smallexample
3877
3878Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3879internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3880verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3881desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3882other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3883E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3884instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3885cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3886
3887@value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3888adjusted breakpoints:
3889
3890@smallexample
3891warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3892to 0x00010410.
3893@end smallexample
3894
3895When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3896action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3897frequently than expected.
3898
3899@node Continuing and Stepping
3900@section Continuing and Stepping
3901
3902@cindex stepping
3903@cindex continuing
3904@cindex resuming execution
3905@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3906completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3907one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3908line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3909particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3910your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3911it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3912@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3913
3914@table @code
3915@kindex continue
3916@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3917@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3918@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3919@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3920@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3921Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3922any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3923@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3924ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3925@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3926
3927The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3928stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3929@code{continue} is ignored.
3930
3931The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3932debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3933purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3934@code{continue}.
3935@end table
3936
3937To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3938(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
3939calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3940Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3941
3942A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3943(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
3944beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3945is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3946and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3947interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3948
3949@table @code
3950@kindex step
3951@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3952@item step
3953Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3954line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3955abbreviated @code{s}.
3956
3957@quotation
3958@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3959@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3960@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3961@c distinction here.
3962@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3963within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3964execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3965debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3966is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3967without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3968below.
3969@end quotation
3970
3971The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3972line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3973@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3974to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3975the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3976called within the line.
3977
3978Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3979number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3980@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3981on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3982was any debugging information about the routine.
3983
3984@item step @var{count}
3985Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3986breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3987@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3988
3989@kindex next
3990@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3991@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3992Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3993This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3994the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3995control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3996that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3997is abbreviated @code{n}.
3998
3999An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4000
4001
4002@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4003@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4004@c
4005@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4006@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4007@c function are executed without stopping.
4008
4009The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4010source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4011@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4012
4013@kindex set step-mode
4014@item set step-mode
4015@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4016@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4017@itemx set step-mode on
4018The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4019stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4020information rather than stepping over it.
4021
4022This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4023machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4024want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4025
4026@item set step-mode off
4027Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4028debug information. This is the default.
4029
4030@item show step-mode
4031Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4032source line debug information.
4033
4034@kindex finish
4035@item finish
4036Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4037returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4038
4039Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4040,Returning from a Function}).
4041
4042@kindex until
4043@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4044@cindex run until specified location
4045@item until
4046@itemx u
4047Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4048current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4049stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4050command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4051automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4052than the address of the jump.
4053
4054This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4055though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4056exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4057simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4058through the next iteration.
4059
4060@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4061stack frame.
4062
4063@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4064of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4065example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4066(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4067@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4068
4069@smallexample
4070(@value{GDBP}) f
4071#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4072206 expand_input();
4073(@value{GDBP}) until
4074195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4075@end smallexample
4076
4077This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4078generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4079start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4080written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4081to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4082expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4083statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4084
4085@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4086instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4087argument.
4088
4089@item until @var{location}
4090@itemx u @var{location}
4091Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4092reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4093the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4094,Setting Breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
4095hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4096location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4097implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4098invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4099line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4100line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4101invocations have returned.
4102
4103@smallexample
410494 int factorial (int value)
410595 @{
410696 if (value > 1) @{
410797 value *= factorial (value - 1);
410898 @}
410999 return (value);
4110100 @}
4111@end smallexample
4112
4113
4114@kindex advance @var{location}
4115@itemx advance @var{location}
4116Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4117required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
4118command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4119frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4120not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4121have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4122
4123
4124@kindex stepi
4125@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4126@item stepi
4127@itemx stepi @var{arg}
4128@itemx si
4129Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4130
4131It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4132instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4133instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4134Display,, Automatic Display}.
4135
4136An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4137
4138@need 750
4139@kindex nexti
4140@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4141@item nexti
4142@itemx nexti @var{arg}
4143@itemx ni
4144Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4145proceed until the function returns.
4146
4147An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4148@end table
4149
4150@node Signals
4151@section Signals
4152@cindex signals
4153
4154A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4155operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4156kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4157signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4158@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4159memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4160the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4161requested an alarm).
4162
4163@cindex fatal signals
4164Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4165functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4166errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4167program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4168@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4169fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4170
4171@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4172program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4173signal.
4174
4175@cindex handling signals
4176Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4177@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4178(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4179but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4180You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4181
4182@table @code
4183@kindex info signals
4184@kindex info handle
4185@item info signals
4186@itemx info handle
4187Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4188handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4189the defined types of signals.
4190
4191@item info signals @var{sig}
4192Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4193
4194@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4195
4196@kindex handle
4197@item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4198Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4199can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4200@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4201@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4202known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4203say what change to make.
4204@end table
4205
4206@c @group
4207The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4208Their full names are:
4209
4210@table @code
4211@item nostop
4212@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4213still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4214
4215@item stop
4216@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4217the @code{print} keyword as well.
4218
4219@item print
4220@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4221
4222@item noprint
4223@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4224implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4225
4226@item pass
4227@itemx noignore
4228@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4229can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4230and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4231
4232@item nopass
4233@itemx ignore
4234@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4235@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4236@end table
4237@c @end group
4238
4239When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4240program until you
4241continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4242effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4243after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4244command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4245program sees that signal when you continue.
4246
4247The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4248non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4249@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4250erroneous signals.
4251
4252You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4253seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4254or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4255due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4256values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4257execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4258a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4259you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4260Program a Signal}.
4261
4262@node Thread Stops
4263@section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4264
4265When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4266Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4267breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4268
4269@table @code
4270@cindex breakpoints and threads
4271@cindex thread breakpoints
4272@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4273@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4274@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4275@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4276writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4277
4278Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4279to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4280particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4281numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4282column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4283
4284If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4285breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4286program.
4287
4288You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4289well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4290breakpoint condition, like this:
4291
4292@smallexample
4293(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4294@end smallexample
4295
4296@end table
4297
4298@cindex stopped threads
4299@cindex threads, stopped
4300Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4301@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4302allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4303switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4304underfoot.
4305
4306@cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4307@cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4308@cindex premature return from system calls
4309There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4310breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4311system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4312consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4313that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4314stop execution.
4315
4316To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4317each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4318style anyways.
4319
4320For example, do not write code like this:
4321
4322@smallexample
4323 sleep (10);
4324@end smallexample
4325
4326The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4327at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4328
4329Instead, write this:
4330
4331@smallexample
4332 int unslept = 10;
4333 while (unslept > 0)
4334 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4335@end smallexample
4336
4337A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4338conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4339multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4340@value{GDBN}.
4341
4342Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4343monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4344When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4345prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4346
4347@cindex continuing threads
4348@cindex threads, continuing
4349Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4350executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4351like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4352
4353In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4354Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4355system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4356execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4357single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4358statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4359stops.
4360
4361You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4362continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4363thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4364first thread completes whatever you requested.
4365
4366On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4367thread to run.
4368
4369@table @code
4370@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4371@cindex scheduler locking mode
4372@cindex lock scheduler
4373Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4374locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4375current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4376mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4377``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4378stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4379when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4380function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4381like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4382thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4383@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4384
4385@item show scheduler-locking
4386Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4387@end table
4388
4389
4390@node Stack
4391@chapter Examining the Stack
4392
4393When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4394stopped and how it got there.
4395
4396@cindex call stack
4397Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4398is generated.
4399That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4400the arguments of the call,
4401and the local variables of the function being called.
4402The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4403The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4404stack}.
4405
4406When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4407stack allow you to see all of this information.
4408
4409@cindex selected frame
4410One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4411@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4412particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4413your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4414special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4415interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4416
4417When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4418currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4419@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
4420
4421@menu
4422* Frames:: Stack frames
4423* Backtrace:: Backtraces
4424* Selection:: Selecting a frame
4425* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4426
4427@end menu
4428
4429@node Frames
4430@section Stack Frames
4431
4432@cindex frame, definition
4433@cindex stack frame
4434The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4435frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4436with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4437to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4438which the function is executing.
4439
4440@cindex initial frame
4441@cindex outermost frame
4442@cindex innermost frame
4443When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4444function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4445@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4446made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4447is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4448the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4449actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4450recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4451
4452@cindex frame pointer
4453Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4454stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4455kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4456address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4457in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4458(@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4459
4460@cindex frame number
4461@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4462zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4463and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4464they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4465frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4466
4467@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4468@c underflow problems.
4469@cindex frameless execution
4470Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4471without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
4472@smallexample
4473@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4474@end smallexample
4475generates functions without a frame.)
4476This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4477the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4478with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4479has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4480it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4481correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4482no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4483
4484@table @code
4485@kindex frame@r{, command}
4486@cindex current stack frame
4487@item frame @var{args}
4488The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4489and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4490address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4491@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4492
4493@kindex select-frame
4494@cindex selecting frame silently
4495@item select-frame
4496The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4497to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4498@code{frame}.
4499@end table
4500
4501@node Backtrace
4502@section Backtraces
4503
4504@cindex traceback
4505@cindex call stack traces
4506A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4507line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4508frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4509stack.
4510
4511@table @code
4512@kindex backtrace
4513@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4514@item backtrace
4515@itemx bt
4516Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4517frames in the stack.
4518
4519You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4520character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4521
4522@item backtrace @var{n}
4523@itemx bt @var{n}
4524Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4525
4526@item backtrace -@var{n}
4527@itemx bt -@var{n}
4528Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4529
4530@item backtrace full
4531@itemx bt full
4532@itemx bt full @var{n}
4533@itemx bt full -@var{n}
4534Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4535number of frames to print, as described above.
4536@end table
4537
4538@kindex where
4539@kindex info stack
4540The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4541are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4542
4543@cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4544In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4545backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4546several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4547(@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4548apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4549the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4550multi-threaded program.
4551
4552Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4553The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4554print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4555line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4556counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4557line number.
4558
4559Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4560@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4561
4562@smallexample
4563@group
4564#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4565 at builtin.c:993
4566#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4567#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4568 at macro.c:71
4569(More stack frames follow...)
4570@end group
4571@end smallexample
4572
4573@noindent
4574The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4575value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4576code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4577
4578@cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4579@cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4580If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4581optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4582never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4583passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4584in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4585arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4586such a backtrace might look like:
4587
4588@smallexample
4589@group
4590#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4591 at builtin.c:993
4592#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4593#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4594 at macro.c:71
4595(More stack frames follow...)
4596@end group
4597@end smallexample
4598
4599@noindent
4600The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4601shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4602
4603If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4604either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4605you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4606
4607@cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4608@cindex program entry point
4609@cindex startup code, and backtrace
4610Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4611libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4612@code{main}@footnote{
4613Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4614environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4615entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4616When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4617it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4618system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4619
4620If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4621in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4622
4623@table @code
4624@item set backtrace past-main
4625@itemx set backtrace past-main on
4626@kindex set backtrace
4627Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4628
4629@item set backtrace past-main off
4630Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4631default.
4632
4633@item show backtrace past-main
4634@kindex show backtrace
4635Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4636
4637@item set backtrace past-entry
4638@itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4639Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4640This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4641and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4642
4643@item set backtrace past-entry off
4644Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
4645application. This is the default.
4646
4647@item show backtrace past-entry
4648Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4649
4650@item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4651@itemx set backtrace limit 0
4652@cindex backtrace limit
4653Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4654unlimited.
4655
4656@item show backtrace limit
4657Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4658@end table
4659
4660@node Selection
4661@section Selecting a Frame
4662
4663Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4664whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4665selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4666of the stack frame just selected.
4667
4668@table @code
4669@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4670@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4671@item frame @var{n}
4672@itemx f @var{n}
4673Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4674(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4675innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4676@code{main}.
4677
4678@item frame @var{addr}
4679@itemx f @var{addr}
4680Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4681chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4682impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4683addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4684switches between them.
4685
4686On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4687select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4688
4689On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4690pointer and a program counter.
4691
4692On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4693pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4694
4695@kindex up
4696@item up @var{n}
4697Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4698advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4699that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4700
4701@kindex down
4702@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4703@item down @var{n}
4704Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4705advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4706that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4707abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4708@end table
4709
4710All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4711frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4712arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4713frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4714
4715@need 1000
4716For example:
4717
4718@smallexample
4719@group
4720(@value{GDBP}) up
4721#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4722 at env.c:10
472310 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4724@end group
4725@end smallexample
4726
4727After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4728prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4729You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4730editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4731@xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
4732for details.
4733
4734@table @code
4735@kindex down-silently
4736@kindex up-silently
4737@item up-silently @var{n}
4738@itemx down-silently @var{n}
4739These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4740respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4741causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4742in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4743distracting.
4744@end table
4745
4746@node Frame Info
4747@section Information About a Frame
4748
4749There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4750stack frame.
4751
4752@table @code
4753@item frame
4754@itemx f
4755When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4756frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4757selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4758argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4759@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4760
4761@kindex info frame
4762@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4763@item info frame
4764@itemx info f
4765This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4766including:
4767
4768@itemize @bullet
4769@item
4770the address of the frame
4771@item
4772the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4773@item
4774the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4775@item
4776the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4777@item
4778the address of the frame's arguments
4779@item
4780the address of the frame's local variables
4781@item
4782the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4783@item
4784which registers were saved in the frame
4785@end itemize
4786
4787@noindent The verbose description is useful when
4788something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4789the usual conventions.
4790
4791@item info frame @var{addr}
4792@itemx info f @var{addr}
4793Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4794selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4795command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4796architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4797@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
4798
4799@kindex info args
4800@item info args
4801Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4802
4803@item info locals
4804@kindex info locals
4805Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4806line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4807accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4808
4809@kindex info catch
4810@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4811@cindex exception handlers, how to list
4812@item info catch
4813Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4814current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4815exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4816@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4817@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
4818
4819@end table
4820
4821
4822@node Source
4823@chapter Examining Source Files
4824
4825@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4826information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4827used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4828the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4829(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4830execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4831source files by explicit command.
4832
4833If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4834prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4835@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4836
4837@menu
4838* List:: Printing source lines
4839* Edit:: Editing source files
4840* Search:: Searching source files
4841* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4842* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4843@end menu
4844
4845@node List
4846@section Printing Source Lines
4847
4848@kindex list
4849@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4850To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4851(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4852There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4853
4854Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4855
4856@table @code
4857@item list @var{linenum}
4858Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4859current source file.
4860
4861@item list @var{function}
4862Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4863@var{function}.
4864
4865@item list
4866Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4867@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4868printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4869as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4870Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4871
4872@item list -
4873Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4874@end table
4875
4876@cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4877By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4878the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4879
4880@table @code
4881@kindex set listsize
4882@item set listsize @var{count}
4883Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4884the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4885
4886@kindex show listsize
4887@item show listsize
4888Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4889@end table
4890
4891Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4892so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4893than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4894argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4895each repetition moves up in the source file.
4896
4897@cindex linespec
4898In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4899@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4900of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4901Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4902
4903@table @code
4904@item list @var{linespec}
4905Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4906
4907@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4908Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4909linespecs.
4910
4911@item list ,@var{last}
4912Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4913
4914@item list @var{first},
4915Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4916
4917@item list +
4918Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4919
4920@item list -
4921Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4922
4923@item list
4924As described in the preceding table.
4925@end table
4926
4927Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4928kinds of linespec.
4929
4930@table @code
4931@item @var{number}
4932Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4933When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4934the same source file as the first linespec.
4935
4936@item +@var{offset}
4937Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4938When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4939two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4940first linespec.
4941
4942@item -@var{offset}
4943Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4944
4945@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4946Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4947
4948@item @var{function}
4949Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4950For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4951
4952@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4953Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4954function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4955file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4956identically named functions in different source files.
4957
4958@item *@var{address}
4959Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4960@var{address} may be any expression.
4961@end table
4962
4963@node Edit
4964@section Editing Source Files
4965@cindex editing source files
4966
4967@kindex edit
4968@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4969To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4970The editing program of your choice
4971is invoked with the current line set to
4972the active line in the program.
4973Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4974want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4975
4976Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4977
4978@table @code
4979@item edit
4980Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4981
4982@item edit @var{number}
4983Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4984
4985@item edit @var{function}
4986Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4987
4988@item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4989Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4990
4991@item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4992Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4993function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4994file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4995identically named functions in different source files.
4996
4997@item edit *@var{address}
4998Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4999@var{address} may be any expression.
5000@end table
5001
5002@subsection Choosing your Editor
5003You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5004@footnote{
5005The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5006following command-line syntax:
5007@smallexample
5008ex +@var{number} file
5009@end smallexample
5010The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5011the file where to start editing.}.
5012By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5013by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5014@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5015@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5016@smallexample
5017EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5018export EDITOR
5019gdb @dots{}
5020@end smallexample
5021or in the @code{csh} shell,
5022@smallexample
5023setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5024gdb @dots{}
5025@end smallexample
5026
5027@node Search
5028@section Searching Source Files
5029@cindex searching source files
5030
5031There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5032regular expression.
5033
5034@table @code
5035@kindex search
5036@kindex forward-search
5037@item forward-search @var{regexp}
5038@itemx search @var{regexp}
5039The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5040starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5041@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5042synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5043@code{fo}.
5044
5045@kindex reverse-search
5046@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5047The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5048with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5049for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5050this command as @code{rev}.
5051@end table
5052
5053@node Source Path
5054@section Specifying Source Directories
5055
5056@cindex source path
5057@cindex directories for source files
5058Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5059files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5060the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5061session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5062this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5063it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5064in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5065
5066For example, suppose an executable references the file
5067@file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5068@file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5069fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5070fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5071message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5072source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5073Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5074the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5075@file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5076@file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5077
5078Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5079names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5080instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5081is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5082@file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5083that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5084
5085Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5086source files.
5087
5088Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5089any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5090each line is in the file.
5091
5092@kindex directory
5093@kindex dir
5094When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5095and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5096To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5097
5098The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5099script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5100
5101In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5102that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5103rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5104debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5105directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5106two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5107the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5108In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5109@var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5110of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5111source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5112name to look up the sources.
5113
5114Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5115moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5116@value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5117@file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5118@file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5119of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5120substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5121(@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5122
5123To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5124@var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5125For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5126@file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5127not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5128is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5129not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5130
5131In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5132command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5133the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5134subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5135subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5136preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5137allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5138command.
5139
5140@code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5141The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5142longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5143the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5144for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5145located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5146method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5147
5148@table @code
5149@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5150@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5151Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5152directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5153(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5154part of absolute file names) or
5155whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5156path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5157
5158@kindex cdir
5159@kindex cwd
5160@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5161@vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5162@cindex compilation directory
5163@cindex current directory
5164@cindex working directory
5165@cindex directory, current
5166@cindex directory, compilation
5167You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5168directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5169working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5170tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5171session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5172directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5173
5174@item directory
5175Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5176
5177@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5178@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5179
5180@item show directories
5181@kindex show directories
5182Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5183
5184@anchor{set substitute-path}
5185@item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5186@kindex set substitute-path
5187Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5188current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5189@var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5190
5191For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5192@file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5193
5194@smallexample
5195(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5196@end smallexample
5197
5198@noindent
5199will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5200@samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5201@file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5202
5203In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5204the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5205defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5206the substitution.
5207
5208For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5209
5210@smallexample
5211(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5212(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5213@end smallexample
5214
5215@noindent
5216@value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5217@file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5218use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5219@file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5220
5221
5222@item unset substitute-path [path]
5223@kindex unset substitute-path
5224If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5225for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5226A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5227
5228If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5229
5230@item show substitute-path [path]
5231@kindex show substitute-path
5232If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5233which would rewrite that path, if any.
5234
5235If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5236rules.
5237
5238@end table
5239
5240If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5241interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5242versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5243
5244@enumerate
5245@item
5246Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5247
5248@item
5249Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5250directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5251directories in one command.
5252@end enumerate
5253
5254@node Machine Code
5255@section Source and Machine Code
5256@cindex source line and its code address
5257
5258You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5259addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5260a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5261mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5262line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5263well as hex.
5264
5265@table @code
5266@kindex info line
5267@item info line @var{linespec}
5268Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5269source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5270the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
5271Source Lines}).
5272@end table
5273
5274For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5275the object code for the first line of function
5276@code{m4_changequote}:
5277
5278@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5279@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5280@smallexample
5281(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5282Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5283@end smallexample
5284
5285@noindent
5286@cindex code address and its source line
5287We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5288@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5289@smallexample
5290(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5291Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5292@end smallexample
5293
5294@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5295@cindex @code{x} command, default address
5296@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5297After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5298is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5299sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5300,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5301convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5302Variables}).
5303
5304@table @code
5305@kindex disassemble
5306@cindex assembly instructions
5307@cindex instructions, assembly
5308@cindex machine instructions
5309@cindex listing machine instructions
5310@item disassemble
5311This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5312instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5313program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5314command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5315surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5316(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5317@end table
5318
5319The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5320HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5321
5322@smallexample
5323(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5324Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
53250x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
53260x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
53270x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
53280x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
53290x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
53300x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
53310x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
53320x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5333End of assembler dump.
5334@end smallexample
5335
5336Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5337mnemonics or other syntax.
5338
5339For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5340instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5341libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5342location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5343might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5344
5345@table @code
5346@kindex set disassembly-flavor
5347@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5348@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5349@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5350Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5351program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5352
5353Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5354can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5355The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5356assemblers for x86-based targets.
5357
5358@kindex show disassembly-flavor
5359@item show disassembly-flavor
5360Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5361@end table
5362
5363
5364@node Data
5365@chapter Examining Data
5366
5367@cindex printing data
5368@cindex examining data
5369@kindex print
5370@kindex inspect
5371@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5372@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5373@c different window or something like that.
5374The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5375command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5376evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5377program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5378Different Languages}).
5379
5380@table @code
5381@item print @var{expr}
5382@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5383@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5384value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5385you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5386@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5387Formats}.
5388
5389@item print
5390@itemx print /@var{f}
5391@cindex reprint the last value
5392If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5393@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
5394conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5395@end table
5396
5397A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5398It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5399specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5400
5401If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5402fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5403command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5404Table}.
5405
5406@menu
5407* Expressions:: Expressions
5408* Variables:: Program variables
5409* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5410* Output Formats:: Output formats
5411* Memory:: Examining memory
5412* Auto Display:: Automatic display
5413* Print Settings:: Print settings
5414* Value History:: Value history
5415* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5416* Registers:: Registers
5417* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5418* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5419* OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5420* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5421* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5422* Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5423* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5424 character set than GDB does
5425* Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5426@end menu
5427
5428@node Expressions
5429@section Expressions
5430
5431@cindex expressions
5432@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5433compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5434by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5435@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5436casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5437you compiled your program to include this information; see
5438@ref{Compilation}.
5439
5440@cindex arrays in expressions
5441@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5442the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5443you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5444memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5445
5446Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5447this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5448Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5449languages.
5450
5451In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5452expressions regardless of your programming language.
5453
5454@cindex casts, in expressions
5455Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5456useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5457at that address in memory.
5458@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5459
5460@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5461to programming languages:
5462
5463@table @code
5464@item @@
5465@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5466@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
5467
5468@item ::
5469@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5470function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
5471
5472@cindex @{@var{type}@}
5473@cindex type casting memory
5474@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5475@cindex casts, to view memory
5476@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5477Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5478memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5479pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5480a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5481normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5482@end table
5483
5484@node Variables
5485@section Program Variables
5486
5487The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5488in your program.
5489
5490Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5491(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
5492
5493@itemize @bullet
5494@item
5495global (or file-static)
5496@end itemize
5497
5498@noindent or
5499
5500@itemize @bullet
5501@item
5502visible according to the scope rules of the
5503programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5504@end itemize
5505
5506@noindent This means that in the function
5507
5508@smallexample
5509foo (a)
5510 int a;
5511@{
5512 bar (a);
5513 @{
5514 int b = test ();
5515 bar (b);
5516 @}
5517@}
5518@end smallexample
5519
5520@noindent
5521you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5522executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5523examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5524the block where @code{b} is declared.
5525
5526@cindex variable name conflict
5527There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5528scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5529in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5530function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5531happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5532you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5533using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5534
5535@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5536@ifnotinfo
5537@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5538@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5539@end ifnotinfo
5540@smallexample
5541@var{file}::@var{variable}
5542@var{function}::@var{variable}
5543@end smallexample
5544
5545@noindent
5546Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5547static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5548make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5549to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5550
5551@smallexample
5552(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5553@end smallexample
5554
5555@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5556This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5557use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5558scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5559@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5560@c conflict?? --mew
5561
5562@cindex wrong values
5563@cindex variable values, wrong
5564@cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5565@cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5566@quotation
5567@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5568wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5569scope, and just before exit.
5570@end quotation
5571You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5572This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5573set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5574stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5575values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5576also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5577after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5578variable definitions may be gone.
5579
5580This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5581To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5582when compiling.
5583
5584@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5585Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5586unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5587opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5588offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5589might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5590happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5591
5592@smallexample
5593No symbol "foo" in current context.
5594@end smallexample
5595
5596To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5597different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5598formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5599usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5600produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5601COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5602an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5603for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
5604Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
5605@xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
5606that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5607
5608If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5609@value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5610by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5611type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5612
5613Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
5614signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
5615printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
5616@code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
5617defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
5618For program code
5619
5620@smallexample
5621char var0[] = "A";
5622signed char var1[] = "A";
5623@end smallexample
5624
5625You get during debugging
5626@smallexample
5627(gdb) print var0
5628$1 = "A"
5629(gdb) print var1
5630$2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
5631@end smallexample
5632
5633@node Arrays
5634@section Artificial Arrays
5635
5636@cindex artificial array
5637@cindex arrays
5638@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5639It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5640same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5641dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5642program.
5643
5644You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5645@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5646operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5647and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5648of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5649the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5650argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5651following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5652example. If a program says
5653
5654@smallexample
5655int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5656@end smallexample
5657
5658@noindent
5659you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5660
5661@smallexample
5662p *array@@len
5663@end smallexample
5664
5665The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5666with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5667subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5668Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5669(@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
5670
5671Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5672This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5673The value need not be in memory:
5674@smallexample
5675(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5676$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5677@end smallexample
5678
5679As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5680@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5681the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5682@smallexample
5683(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5684$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5685@end smallexample
5686
5687Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5688moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5689actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5690of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5691to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5692Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5693interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5694instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5695structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5696in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5697
5698@smallexample
5699set $i = 0
5700p dtab[$i++]->fv
5701@key{RET}
5702@key{RET}
5703@dots{}
5704@end smallexample
5705
5706@node Output Formats
5707@section Output Formats
5708
5709@cindex formatted output
5710@cindex output formats
5711By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5712this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5713in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5714at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5715these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5716
5717The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5718already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5719@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5720letters supported are:
5721
5722@table @code
5723@item x
5724Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5725hexadecimal.
5726
5727@item d
5728Print as integer in signed decimal.
5729
5730@item u
5731Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5732
5733@item o
5734Print as integer in octal.
5735
5736@item t
5737Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5738@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5739used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5740see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
5741
5742@item a
5743@cindex unknown address, locating
5744@cindex locate address
5745Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5746the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5747where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5748
5749@smallexample
5750(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5751$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5752@end smallexample
5753
5754@noindent
5755The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5756@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5757
5758@item c
5759Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5760prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5761character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5762for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5763
5764@item f
5765Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5766using typical floating point syntax.
5767@end table
5768
5769For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5770
5771@smallexample
5772p/x $pc
5773@end smallexample
5774
5775@noindent
5776Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5777names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5778
5779To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5780you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5781expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5782
5783@node Memory
5784@section Examining Memory
5785
5786You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5787any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5788
5789@cindex examining memory
5790@table @code
5791@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5792@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5793@itemx x @var{addr}
5794@itemx x
5795Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5796@end table
5797
5798@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5799much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5800expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5801If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5802Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5803
5804@table @r
5805@item @var{n}, the repeat count
5806The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5807how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5808@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5809@c 4.1.2.
5810
5811@item @var{f}, the display format
5812The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5813(@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5814@samp{f}), and in addition @samp{s} (for null-terminated strings) and
5815@samp{i} (for machine instructions). The default is @samp{x}
5816(hexadecimal) initially. The default changes each time you use either
5817@code{x} or @code{print}.
5818
5819@item @var{u}, the unit size
5820The unit size is any of
5821
5822@table @code
5823@item b
5824Bytes.
5825@item h
5826Halfwords (two bytes).
5827@item w
5828Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5829@item g
5830Giant words (eight bytes).
5831@end table
5832
5833Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5834default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5835@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5836
5837@item @var{addr}, starting display address
5838@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5839memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5840it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5841@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5842@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5843other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5844the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5845starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5846a value from memory).
5847@end table
5848
5849For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5850(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5851starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5852words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5853@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5854
5855Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5856letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5857unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5858specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5859(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5860
5861Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5862and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5863@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5864including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
5865alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
5866Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
5867
5868All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5869easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5870you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5871instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5872with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5873the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5874for successive uses of @code{x}.
5875
5876@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5877The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5878in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5879would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5880subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5881@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5882examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5883@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5884the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5885
5886If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5887are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5888address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5889
5890@cindex remote memory comparison
5891@cindex verify remote memory image
5892When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5893(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5894remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5895the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5896situations.
5897
5898@table @code
5899@kindex compare-sections
5900@item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5901Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5902executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5903the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5904arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5905availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5906remote request.
5907@end table
5908
5909@node Auto Display
5910@section Automatic Display
5911@cindex automatic display
5912@cindex display of expressions
5913
5914If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5915(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5916display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5917Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5918to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5919The automatic display looks like this:
5920
5921@smallexample
59222: foo = 38
59233: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5924@end smallexample
5925
5926@noindent
5927This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5928displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5929specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5930whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5931format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5932or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5933supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5934
5935@table @code
5936@kindex display
5937@item display @var{expr}
5938Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5939each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5940
5941@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5942
5943@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5944For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5945count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5946arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5947@xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
5948
5949@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5950For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5951number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5952be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5953doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
5954@end table
5955
5956For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5957instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5958is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5959
5960@table @code
5961@kindex delete display
5962@kindex undisplay
5963@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5964@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5965Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5966
5967@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5968(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5969
5970@kindex disable display
5971@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5972Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5973item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5974enabled again later.
5975
5976@kindex enable display
5977@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5978Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5979again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5980
5981@item display
5982Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5983done when your program stops.
5984
5985@kindex info display
5986@item info display
5987Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5988automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5989values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5990It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5991because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5992@end table
5993
5994@cindex display disabled out of scope
5995If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5996sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5997expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5998variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5999@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6000@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6001continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6002there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6003automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6004is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6005
6006@node Print Settings
6007@section Print Settings
6008
6009@cindex format options
6010@cindex print settings
6011@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6012and symbols are printed.
6013
6014@noindent
6015These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6016
6017@table @code
6018@kindex set print
6019@item set print address
6020@itemx set print address on
6021@cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6022@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6023traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6024even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6025is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6026@code{set print address on}:
6027
6028@smallexample
6029@group
6030(@value{GDBP}) f
6031#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6032 at input.c:530
6033530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6034@end group
6035@end smallexample
6036
6037@item set print address off
6038Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6039this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6040
6041@smallexample
6042@group
6043(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6044(@value{GDBP}) f
6045#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6046530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6047@end group
6048@end smallexample
6049
6050You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6051dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6052@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6053all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6054
6055@kindex show print
6056@item show print address
6057Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6058@end table
6059
6060When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6061closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6062identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6063source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6064@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6065you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6066it prints a symbolic address:
6067
6068@table @code
6069@item set print symbol-filename on
6070@cindex source file and line of a symbol
6071@cindex symbol, source file and line
6072Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6073symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6074
6075@item set print symbol-filename off
6076Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6077default.
6078
6079@item show print symbol-filename
6080Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6081line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6082@end table
6083
6084Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6085numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6086number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6087
6088Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6089printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6090
6091@table @code
6092@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6093@cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6094Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6095offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6096@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6097to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6098
6099@item show print max-symbolic-offset
6100Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6101symbolic address.
6102@end table
6103
6104@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6105@cindex pointer, finding referent
6106If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6107@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6108and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6109@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6110For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6111at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6112
6113@smallexample
6114(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6115(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6116$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6117@end smallexample
6118
6119@quotation
6120@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6121does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6122the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6123@end quotation
6124
6125Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6126
6127@table @code
6128@item set print array
6129@itemx set print array on
6130@cindex pretty print arrays
6131Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6132but uses more space. The default is off.
6133
6134@item set print array off
6135Return to compressed format for arrays.
6136
6137@item show print array
6138Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6139arrays.
6140
6141@cindex print array indexes
6142@item set print array-indexes
6143@itemx set print array-indexes on
6144Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6145convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6146index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6147
6148@item set print array-indexes off
6149Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6150
6151@item show print array-indexes
6152Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6153arrays.
6154
6155@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6156@cindex number of array elements to print
6157@cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6158Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6159If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6160printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6161This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6162When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6163Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6164
6165@item show print elements
6166Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6167If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6168
6169@item set print repeats
6170@cindex repeated array elements
6171Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6172elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6173array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6174@code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6175identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6176themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6177be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6178
6179@item show print repeats
6180Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6181elements.
6182
6183@item set print null-stop
6184@cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6185Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6186@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6187contain only short strings.
6188The default is off.
6189
6190@item show print null-stop
6191Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6192@sc{null} character.
6193
6194@item set print pretty on
6195@cindex print structures in indented form
6196@cindex indentation in structure display
6197Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6198per line, like this:
6199
6200@smallexample
6201@group
6202$1 = @{
6203 next = 0x0,
6204 flags = @{
6205 sweet = 1,
6206 sour = 1
6207 @},
6208 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6209@}
6210@end group
6211@end smallexample
6212
6213@item set print pretty off
6214Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6215
6216@smallexample
6217@group
6218$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6219meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6220@end group
6221@end smallexample
6222
6223@noindent
6224This is the default format.
6225
6226@item show print pretty
6227Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6228
6229@item set print sevenbit-strings on
6230@cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6231@cindex octal escapes in strings
6232Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6233@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6234character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6235best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6236high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6237
6238@item set print sevenbit-strings off
6239Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6240international character sets, and is the default.
6241
6242@item show print sevenbit-strings
6243Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6244
6245@item set print union on
6246@cindex unions in structures, printing
6247Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6248and other unions. This is the default setting.
6249
6250@item set print union off
6251Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6252structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6253instead.
6254
6255@item show print union
6256Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6257structures and other unions.
6258
6259For example, given the declarations
6260
6261@smallexample
6262typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6263typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6264typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6265 Bug_forms;
6266
6267struct thing @{
6268 Species it;
6269 union @{
6270 Tree_forms tree;
6271 Bug_forms bug;
6272 @} form;
6273@};
6274
6275struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6276@end smallexample
6277
6278@noindent
6279with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6280
6281@smallexample
6282$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6283@end smallexample
6284
6285@noindent
6286and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6287
6288@smallexample
6289$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6290@end smallexample
6291
6292@noindent
6293@code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6294and in Pascal.
6295@end table
6296
6297@need 1000
6298@noindent
6299These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6300
6301@table @code
6302@cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6303@item set print demangle
6304@itemx set print demangle on
6305Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6306(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6307linkage. The default is on.
6308
6309@item show print demangle
6310Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6311
6312@item set print asm-demangle
6313@itemx set print asm-demangle on
6314Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6315in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6316The default is off.
6317
6318@item show print asm-demangle
6319Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6320or demangled form.
6321
6322@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6323@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6324@kindex set demangle-style
6325@item set demangle-style @var{style}
6326Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6327represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6328
6329@table @code
6330@item auto
6331Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6332
6333@item gnu
6334Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6335This is the default.
6336
6337@item hp
6338Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6339
6340@item lucid
6341Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6342
6343@item arm
6344Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6345@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6346debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6347require further enhancement to permit that.
6348
6349@end table
6350If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6351
6352@item show demangle-style
6353Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6354
6355@item set print object
6356@itemx set print object on
6357@cindex derived type of an object, printing
6358@cindex display derived types
6359When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6360(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6361the virtual function table.
6362
6363@item set print object off
6364Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6365virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6366
6367@item show print object
6368Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6369
6370@item set print static-members
6371@itemx set print static-members on
6372@cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6373Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6374
6375@item set print static-members off
6376Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6377
6378@item show print static-members
6379Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6380
6381@item set print pascal_static-members
6382@itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6383@cindex static members of Pascal objects
6384@cindex Pascal objects, static members display
6385Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6386
6387@item set print pascal_static-members off
6388Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6389
6390@item show print pascal_static-members
6391Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6392
6393@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6394@item set print vtbl
6395@itemx set print vtbl on
6396@cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6397@cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6398@cindex VTBL display
6399Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6400(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6401ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6402
6403@item set print vtbl off
6404Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6405
6406@item show print vtbl
6407Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6408@end table
6409
6410@node Value History
6411@section Value History
6412
6413@cindex value history
6414@cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6415Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6416@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6417Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6418(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6419When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6420since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6421symbol table.
6422
6423@cindex @code{$}
6424@cindex @code{$$}
6425@cindex history number
6426The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6427refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6428@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6429printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6430history number.
6431
6432To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6433history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6434remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6435the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6436@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6437is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6438@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6439
6440For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6441want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6442
6443@smallexample
6444p *$
6445@end smallexample
6446
6447If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6448to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6449
6450@smallexample
6451p *$.next
6452@end smallexample
6453
6454@noindent
6455You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6456command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6457
6458Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6459@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6460
6461@smallexample
6462print x
6463set x=5
6464@end smallexample
6465
6466@noindent
6467then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6468remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6469
6470@table @code
6471@kindex show values
6472@item show values
6473Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6474This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6475values} does not change the history.
6476
6477@item show values @var{n}
6478Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6479
6480@item show values +
6481Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6482values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6483@end table
6484
6485Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6486same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6487
6488@node Convenience Vars
6489@section Convenience Variables
6490
6491@cindex convenience variables
6492@cindex user-defined variables
6493@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6494@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6495exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6496setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6497of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6498
6499Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6500@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6501the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6502(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6503by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
6504
6505You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6506expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6507For example:
6508
6509@smallexample
6510set $foo = *object_ptr
6511@end smallexample
6512
6513@noindent
6514would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6515@code{object_ptr}.
6516
6517Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6518value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6519value with another assignment at any time.
6520
6521Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6522variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6523that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6524variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6525
6526@table @code
6527@kindex show convenience
6528@cindex show all user variables
6529@item show convenience
6530Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6531Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6532
6533@kindex init-if-undefined
6534@cindex convenience variables, initializing
6535@item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6536Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6537for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6538to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6539convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6540override default values used in a command script.
6541
6542If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6543any side-effects do not occur.
6544@end table
6545
6546One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6547incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6548a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6549
6550@smallexample
6551set $i = 0
6552print bar[$i++]->contents
6553@end smallexample
6554
6555@noindent
6556Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6557
6558Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6559values likely to be useful.
6560
6561@table @code
6562@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6563@item $_
6564The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6565the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
6566commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6567set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6568and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6569except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6570to the type of @code{$__}.
6571
6572@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6573@item $__
6574The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6575to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6576to match the format in which the data was printed.
6577
6578@item $_exitcode
6579@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6580The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6581the program being debugged terminates.
6582@end table
6583
6584On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6585begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6586name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6587
6588@node Registers
6589@section Registers
6590
6591@cindex registers
6592You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6593with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6594for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6595your machine.
6596
6597@table @code
6598@kindex info registers
6599@item info registers
6600Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6601and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6602
6603@kindex info all-registers
6604@cindex floating point registers
6605@item info all-registers
6606Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6607and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6608
6609@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6610Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6611As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6612the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6613the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6614@end table
6615
6616@cindex stack pointer register
6617@cindex program counter register
6618@cindex process status register
6619@cindex frame pointer register
6620@cindex standard registers
6621@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6622expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6623architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6624@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6625the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6626pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6627register that contains the processor status. For example,
6628you could print the program counter in hex with
6629
6630@smallexample
6631p/x $pc
6632@end smallexample
6633
6634@noindent
6635or print the instruction to be executed next with
6636
6637@smallexample
6638x/i $pc
6639@end smallexample
6640
6641@noindent
6642or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6643one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6644memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6645stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6646stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6647regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6648see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
6649
6650@smallexample
6651set $sp += 4
6652@end smallexample
6653
6654Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6655your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6656so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6657shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6658registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6659can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6660is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6661
6662@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6663integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6664special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6665registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6666to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6667(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6668@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6669
6670Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6671means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6672the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6673sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6674coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6675programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6676cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6677that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6678prints the data in both formats.
6679
6680@cindex SSE registers (x86)
6681@cindex MMX registers (x86)
6682Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6683in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6684have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6685together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6686registers in @code{struct} notation:
6687
6688@smallexample
6689(@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6690$1 = @{
6691 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6692 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6693 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6694 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6695 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6696 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6697 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6698@}
6699@end smallexample
6700
6701@noindent
6702To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6703view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6704value to a @code{struct} member:
6705
6706@smallexample
6707 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6708@end smallexample
6709
6710Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6711(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
6712value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6713were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6714true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6715frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6716
6717However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6718code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6719@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6720frame makes no difference.
6721
6722@node Floating Point Hardware
6723@section Floating Point Hardware
6724@cindex floating point
6725
6726Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6727you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6728
6729@table @code
6730@kindex info float
6731@item info float
6732Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6733point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6734floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6735the ARM and x86 machines.
6736@end table
6737
6738@node Vector Unit
6739@section Vector Unit
6740@cindex vector unit
6741
6742Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6743more information about the status of the vector unit.
6744
6745@table @code
6746@kindex info vector
6747@item info vector
6748Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6749layout vary depending on the hardware.
6750@end table
6751
6752@node OS Information
6753@section Operating System Auxiliary Information
6754@cindex OS information
6755
6756@value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6757you debug your program.
6758
6759@cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6760@cindex @code{struct user} contents
6761When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6762machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6763system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6764called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6765command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6766structure.
6767
6768@table @code
6769@item info udot
6770@kindex info udot
6771Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6772kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6773contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6774the @code{examine} command.
6775@end table
6776
6777@cindex auxiliary vector
6778@cindex vector, auxiliary
6779Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6780startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6781specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6782binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6783hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6784identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6785Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6786@value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6787targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6788support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
6789@ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
6790
6791@table @code
6792@kindex info auxv
6793@item info auxv
6794Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6795live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6796numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6797tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6798pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6799most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6800an unrecognized tag.
6801@end table
6802
6803
6804@node Memory Region Attributes
6805@section Memory Region Attributes
6806@cindex memory region attributes
6807
6808@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6809required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
6810attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
6811accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
6812target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
6813fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
6814user can override the fetched regions.
6815
6816Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6817memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6818accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6819been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6820all memory.
6821
6822When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6823to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6824
6825@table @code
6826@kindex mem
6827@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6828Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6829attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6830monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6831case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
6832(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6833
6834@item mem auto
6835Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
6836regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
6837
6838@kindex delete mem
6839@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6840Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6841monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6842
6843@kindex disable mem
6844@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6845Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6846A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6847It may be enabled again later.
6848
6849@kindex enable mem
6850@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6851Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6852
6853@kindex info mem
6854@item info mem
6855Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6856for each region:
6857
6858@table @emph
6859@item Memory Region Number
6860@item Enabled or Disabled.
6861Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6862Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6863
6864@item Lo Address
6865The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6866
6867@item Hi Address
6868The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6869
6870@item Attributes
6871The list of attributes set for this memory region.
6872@end table
6873@end table
6874
6875
6876@subsection Attributes
6877
6878@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
6879The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
6880write accesses to a memory region.
6881
6882While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
6883memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
6884etc.@: from accessing memory.
6885
6886@table @code
6887@item ro
6888Memory is read only.
6889@item wo
6890Memory is write only.
6891@item rw
6892Memory is read/write. This is the default.
6893@end table
6894
6895@subsubsection Memory Access Size
6896The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
6897accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
6898require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
6899specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
6900
6901@table @code
6902@item 8
6903Use 8 bit memory accesses.
6904@item 16
6905Use 16 bit memory accesses.
6906@item 32
6907Use 32 bit memory accesses.
6908@item 64
6909Use 64 bit memory accesses.
6910@end table
6911
6912@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
6913@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6914@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
6915@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
6916@c
6917@c @table @code
6918@c @item hwbreak
6919@c Always use hardware breakpoints
6920@c @item swbreak (default)
6921@c @end table
6922
6923@subsubsection Data Cache
6924The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
6925memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
6926protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
6927does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
6928registers.
6929
6930@table @code
6931@item cache
6932Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6933@item nocache
6934Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
6935@end table
6936
6937@subsection Memory Access Checking
6938@value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
6939not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
6940regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
6941better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
6942
6943@table @code
6944@kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
6945@item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
6946If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
6947explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
6948to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
6949memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
6950treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
6951The default value is @code{off}.
6952@kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
6953@item show mem inaccessible-by-default
6954Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
6955@end table
6956
6957
6958@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
6959@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6960@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
6961@c
6962@c @table @code
6963@c @item verify
6964@c @item noverify (default)
6965@c @end table
6966
6967@node Dump/Restore Files
6968@section Copy Between Memory and a File
6969@cindex dump/restore files
6970@cindex append data to a file
6971@cindex dump data to a file
6972@cindex restore data from a file
6973
6974You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
6975@code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
6976@code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
6977@code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
6978memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
6979Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
6980files.
6981
6982@table @code
6983
6984@kindex dump
6985@item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6986@itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6987Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6988or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
6989
6990The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
6991@table @code
6992@item binary
6993Raw binary form.
6994@item ihex
6995Intel hex format.
6996@item srec
6997Motorola S-record format.
6998@item tekhex
6999Tektronix Hex format.
7000@end table
7001
7002@value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7003@sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7004@var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7005form.
7006
7007@kindex append
7008@item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7009@itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7010Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7011or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7012(@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7013
7014@kindex restore
7015@item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7016Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7017@code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7018file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7019must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7020
7021If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7022contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7023they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7024a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7025from that location.
7026
7027If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7028file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7029These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7030the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7031
7032@end table
7033
7034@node Core File Generation
7035@section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7036@cindex dump core from inferior
7037
7038A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7039image of a running process and its process status (register values
7040etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7041crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7042automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7043the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7044the post-mortem debugging mode.
7045
7046Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7047are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7048@value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7049
7050@table @code
7051@kindex gcore
7052@kindex generate-core-file
7053@item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7054@itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7055Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7056@var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7057specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7058@var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7059
7060Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7061this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7062@end table
7063
7064@node Character Sets
7065@section Character Sets
7066@cindex character sets
7067@cindex charset
7068@cindex translating between character sets
7069@cindex host character set
7070@cindex target character set
7071
7072If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7073represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7074@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7075you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7076character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7077@dfn{target character set}.
7078
7079For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7080uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7081remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7082running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7083then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7084@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7085target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7086@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7087character and string literals in expressions.
7088
7089@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7090the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7091target-charset} command, described below.
7092
7093Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7094support:
7095
7096@table @code
7097@item set target-charset @var{charset}
7098@kindex set target-charset
7099Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7100character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7101@code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7102list the target character sets it supports.
7103@end table
7104
7105@table @code
7106@item set host-charset @var{charset}
7107@kindex set host-charset
7108Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7109
7110By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7111system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7112@code{set host-charset} command.
7113
7114@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7115set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7116indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7117@code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7118list the host character sets it supports.
7119
7120@item set charset @var{charset}
7121@kindex set charset
7122Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7123above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7124@value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7125for both host and target.
7126
7127
7128@item show charset
7129@kindex show charset
7130Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7131
7132@itemx show host-charset
7133@kindex show host-charset
7134Show the name of the current host charset.
7135
7136@itemx show target-charset
7137@kindex show target-charset
7138Show the name of the current target charset.
7139
7140@end table
7141
7142@value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7143sets:
7144
7145@table @code
7146
7147@item ASCII
7148@cindex ASCII character set
7149Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7150character set.
7151
7152@item ISO-8859-1
7153@cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7154@cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7155The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7156characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7157this as its host character set.
7158
7159@item EBCDIC-US
7160@itemx IBM1047
7161@cindex EBCDIC character set
7162@cindex IBM1047 character set
7163Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7164mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7165@value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7166
7167@end table
7168
7169Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7170@value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7171encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7172
7173Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7174Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7175@file{charset-test.c}:
7176
7177@smallexample
7178#include <stdio.h>
7179
7180char ascii_hello[]
7181 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7182 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7183char ibm1047_hello[]
7184 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7185 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7186
7187main ()
7188@{
7189 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7190@}
7191@end smallexample
7192
7193In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7194containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7195encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7196
7197We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7198
7199@smallexample
7200$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7201$ gdb -nw charset-test
7202GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7203Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7204@dots{}
7205(@value{GDBP})
7206@end smallexample
7207
7208We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7209@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7210strings:
7211
7212@smallexample
7213(@value{GDBP}) show charset
7214The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7215(@value{GDBP})
7216@end smallexample
7217
7218For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7219initial character set:
7220@smallexample
7221(@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7222(@value{GDBP}) show charset
7223The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7224(@value{GDBP})
7225@end smallexample
7226
7227Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7228host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7229characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7230them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7231@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7232
7233@smallexample
7234(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7235$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7236(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7237$2 = 72 'H'
7238(@value{GDBP})
7239@end smallexample
7240
7241@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7242literals you use in expressions:
7243
7244@smallexample
7245(@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7246$3 = 43 '+'
7247(@value{GDBP})
7248@end smallexample
7249
7250The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7251character.
7252
7253@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7254target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7255character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7256
7257@smallexample
7258(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7259$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7260(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7261$5 = 200 '\310'
7262(@value{GDBP})
7263@end smallexample
7264
7265If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7266@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7267
7268@smallexample
7269(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7270ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7271(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7272@end smallexample
7273
7274We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7275program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7276@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7277target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7278@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7279
7280@smallexample
7281(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7282(@value{GDBP}) show charset
7283The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7284The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7285(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7286$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7287(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7288$7 = 72 '\110'
7289(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7290$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7291(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7292$9 = 200 'H'
7293(@value{GDBP})
7294@end smallexample
7295
7296As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7297string literals you use in expressions:
7298
7299@smallexample
7300(@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7301$10 = 78 '+'
7302(@value{GDBP})
7303@end smallexample
7304
7305The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7306character.
7307
7308@node Caching Remote Data
7309@section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7310@cindex caching data of remote targets
7311
7312@value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7313remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
7314performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7315bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7316@value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7317registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7318volatile registers are in use.
7319
7320@table @code
7321@kindex set remotecache
7322@item set remotecache on
7323@itemx set remotecache off
7324Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7325caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7326
7327@kindex show remotecache
7328@item show remotecache
7329Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7330
7331@kindex info dcache
7332@item info dcache
7333Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7334information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7335each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7336state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7337the data cache operation.
7338@end table
7339
7340
7341@node Macros
7342@chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7343
7344Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7345``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7346@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7347the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7348where it was defined.
7349
7350You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7351with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7352include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7353with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7354
7355A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7356and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7357points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7358no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7359uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7360@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7361see @ref{List}.
7362
7363At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7364token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7365variable-arity macros.
7366
7367Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7368macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7369the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7370
7371@table @code
7372
7373@kindex macro expand
7374@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7375@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7376@cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7377@item macro expand @var{expression}
7378@itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7379Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7380@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7381not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7382it can be any string of tokens.
7383
7384@kindex macro exp1
7385@item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7386@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7387@cindex expand macro once
7388@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7389expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7390@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7391left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7392particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7393expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7394parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7395can be any string of tokens.
7396
7397@kindex info macro
7398@cindex macro definition, showing
7399@cindex definition, showing a macro's
7400@item info macro @var{macro}
7401Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7402source location where that definition was established.
7403
7404@kindex macro define
7405@cindex user-defined macros
7406@cindex defining macros interactively
7407@cindex macros, user-defined
7408@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7409@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7410@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7411preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7412by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7413command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7414second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7415given in @var{arglist}.
7416
7417A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7418evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7419undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7420definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7421well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7422
7423@kindex macro undef
7424@item macro undef @var{macro}
7425@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7426definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7427definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7428above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7429debugged.
7430
7431@kindex macro list
7432@item macro list
7433@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7434defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7435@end table
7436
7437@cindex macros, example of debugging with
7438Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7439show our source files:
7440
7441@smallexample
7442$ cat sample.c
7443#include <stdio.h>
7444#include "sample.h"
7445
7446#define M 42
7447#define ADD(x) (M + x)
7448
7449main ()
7450@{
7451#define N 28
7452 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7453#undef N
7454 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7455#define N 1729
7456 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7457@}
7458$ cat sample.h
7459#define Q <
7460$
7461@end smallexample
7462
7463Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7464We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7465compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7466information.
7467
7468@smallexample
7469$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7470$
7471@end smallexample
7472
7473Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7474
7475@smallexample
7476$ gdb -nw sample
7477GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7478Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7479GDB is free software, @dots{}
7480(@value{GDBP})
7481@end smallexample
7482
7483We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7484program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7485to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7486
7487@smallexample
7488(@value{GDBP}) list main
74893
74904 #define M 42
74915 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
74926
74937 main ()
74948 @{
74959 #define N 28
749610 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
749711 #undef N
749812 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7499(@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7500Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7501#define ADD(x) (M + x)
7502(@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7503Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7504 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7505#define Q <
7506(@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7507expands to: (42 + 1)
7508(@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7509expands to: once (M + 1)
7510(@value{GDBP})
7511@end smallexample
7512
7513In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7514the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7515@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7516which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7517
7518Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
7519force at the source line of the current stack frame:
7520
7521@smallexample
7522(@value{GDBP}) break main
7523Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7524(@value{GDBP}) run
7525Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7526
7527Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
752810 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7529(@value{GDBP})
7530@end smallexample
7531
7532At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7533
7534@smallexample
7535(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7536Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7537#define N 28
7538(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7539expands to: 28 < 42
7540(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7541$1 = 1
7542(@value{GDBP})
7543@end smallexample
7544
7545As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7546give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7547thereof) in force at each point:
7548
7549@smallexample
7550(@value{GDBP}) next
7551Hello, world!
755212 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7553(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7554The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7555at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7556(@value{GDBP}) next
7557We're so creative.
755814 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7559(@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7560Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7561#define N 1729
7562(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7563expands to: 1729 < 42
7564(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7565$2 = 0
7566(@value{GDBP})
7567@end smallexample
7568
7569
7570@node Tracepoints
7571@chapter Tracepoints
7572@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7573@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7574
7575@cindex tracepoints
7576In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7577the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7578anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7579depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7580might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7581fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7582to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7583
7584Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7585specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7586arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7587Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7588those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7589expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7590for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7591a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7592in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7593values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7594unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7595
7596The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7597targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7598how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7599remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7600support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7601packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7602Packets}.
7603
7604This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7605
7606@menu
7607* Set Tracepoints::
7608* Analyze Collected Data::
7609* Tracepoint Variables::
7610@end menu
7611
7612@node Set Tracepoints
7613@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7614
7615Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7616tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7617tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7618breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7619one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7620tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7621work on.
7622
7623For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7624of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7625it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7626local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7627commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7628tracepoint was hit.
7629
7630This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7631conditions and actions.
7632
7633@menu
7634* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7635* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7636* Tracepoint Passcounts::
7637* Tracepoint Actions::
7638* Listing Tracepoints::
7639* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
7640@end menu
7641
7642@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7643@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7644
7645@table @code
7646@cindex set tracepoint
7647@kindex trace
7648@item trace
7649The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7650Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7651the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7652defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7653debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7654program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7655doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7656cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7657running.
7658
7659Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7660
7661@smallexample
7662(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7663
7664(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7665
7666(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7667
7668(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7669
7670(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7671@end smallexample
7672
7673@noindent
7674You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7675
7676@vindex $tpnum
7677@cindex last tracepoint number
7678@cindex recent tracepoint number
7679@cindex tracepoint number
7680The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7681of the most recently set tracepoint.
7682
7683@kindex delete tracepoint
7684@cindex tracepoint deletion
7685@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7686Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7687default is to delete all tracepoints.
7688
7689Examples:
7690
7691@smallexample
7692(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7693
7694(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7695@end smallexample
7696
7697@noindent
7698You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7699@end table
7700
7701@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7702@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7703
7704@table @code
7705@kindex disable tracepoint
7706@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7707Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7708@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7709the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7710a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7711
7712@kindex enable tracepoint
7713@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7714Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7715tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7716run.
7717@end table
7718
7719@node Tracepoint Passcounts
7720@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7721
7722@table @code
7723@kindex passcount
7724@cindex tracepoint pass count
7725@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7726Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7727automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7728@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7729the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7730@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7731passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7732given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7733user.
7734
7735Examples:
7736
7737@smallexample
7738(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7739@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7740
7741(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7742@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7743(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7744(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7745(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7746(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7747(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7748(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7749@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7750@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7751@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7752@end smallexample
7753@end table
7754
7755@node Tracepoint Actions
7756@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7757
7758@table @code
7759@kindex actions
7760@cindex tracepoint actions
7761@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7762This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7763tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7764specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7765recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7766@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7767actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7768terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7769far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7770@code{while-stepping}.
7771
7772@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7773To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7774and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7775
7776@smallexample
7777(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7778
7779(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7780
7781(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7782@end smallexample
7783
7784In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7785commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7786hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7787following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7788followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7789@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7790@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7791@code{end} command.
7792
7793@smallexample
7794(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7795(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7796Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7797> collect bar,baz
7798> collect $regs
7799> while-stepping 12
7800 > collect $fp, $sp
7801 > end
7802end
7803@end smallexample
7804
7805@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7806@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7807Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7808This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7809In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7810special arguments are supported:
7811
7812@table @code
7813@item $regs
7814collect all registers
7815
7816@item $args
7817collect all function arguments
7818
7819@item $locals
7820collect all local variables.
7821@end table
7822
7823You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7824with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7825arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7826
7827The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7828particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7829
7830@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7831@item while-stepping @var{n}
7832Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7833new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7834followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7835its own @code{end} command):
7836
7837@smallexample
7838> while-stepping 12
7839 > collect $regs, myglobal
7840 > end
7841>
7842@end smallexample
7843
7844@noindent
7845You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7846@code{stepping}.
7847@end table
7848
7849@node Listing Tracepoints
7850@subsection Listing Tracepoints
7851
7852@table @code
7853@kindex info tracepoints
7854@kindex info tp
7855@cindex information about tracepoints
7856@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7857Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7858a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7859defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7860shown:
7861
7862@itemize @bullet
7863@item
7864its number
7865@item
7866whether it is enabled or disabled
7867@item
7868its address
7869@item
7870its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
7871@item
7872its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
7873@item
7874where in the source files is the tracepoint set
7875@item
7876its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
7877@end itemize
7878
7879@smallexample
7880(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
7881Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
78821 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
78832 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
78843 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
7885(@value{GDBP})
7886@end smallexample
7887
7888@noindent
7889This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
7890@end table
7891
7892@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
7893@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
7894
7895@table @code
7896@kindex tstart
7897@cindex start a new trace experiment
7898@cindex collected data discarded
7899@item tstart
7900This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
7901begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
7902the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
7903experiment.
7904
7905@kindex tstop
7906@cindex stop a running trace experiment
7907@item tstop
7908This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
7909stops collecting data.
7910
7911@strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
7912automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
7913(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
7914
7915@kindex tstatus
7916@cindex status of trace data collection
7917@cindex trace experiment, status of
7918@item tstatus
7919This command displays the status of the current trace data
7920collection.
7921@end table
7922
7923Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
7924
7925@smallexample
7926(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
7927(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7928Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
7929> collect $regs,$locals,$args
7930> while-stepping 11
7931 > collect $regs
7932 > end
7933> end
7934(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7935 [time passes @dots{}]
7936(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
7937@end smallexample
7938
7939
7940@node Analyze Collected Data
7941@section Using the Collected Data
7942
7943After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
7944for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
7945collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
7946snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
7947consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
7948examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
7949specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
7950snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
7951registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
7952rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
7953debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
7954(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
7955behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
7956when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
7957the buffer will fail.
7958
7959@menu
7960* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
7961* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
7962* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
7963@end menu
7964
7965@node tfind
7966@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
7967
7968@kindex tfind
7969@cindex select trace snapshot
7970@cindex find trace snapshot
7971The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
7972@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
7973counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
7974snapshot is selected.
7975
7976Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
7977
7978@table @code
7979@item tfind start
7980Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
7981@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
7982
7983@item tfind none
7984Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
7985
7986@item tfind end
7987Same as @samp{tfind none}.
7988
7989@item tfind
7990No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
7991
7992@item tfind -
7993Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
7994retracing earlier steps.
7995
7996@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
7997Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
7998proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
7999argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8000for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8001
8002@item tfind pc @var{addr}
8003Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8004program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8005snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8006snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8007
8008@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8009Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8010addresses.
8011
8012@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8013Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8014@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8015
8016@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8017Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8018the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8019that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8020trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8021next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8022@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8023stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8024@end table
8025
8026The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8027designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8028instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8029snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8030trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8031simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8032snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8033@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8034The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8035for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8036no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8037(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8038no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8039tracepoint as the current one.
8040
8041In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8042these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8043scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8044you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8045registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8046
8047@smallexample
8048(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8049(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8050> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8051 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8052> tfind
8053> end
8054
8055Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8056Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8057Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8058Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8059Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8060Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8061Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8062Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8063Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8064Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8065Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8066@end smallexample
8067
8068Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8069the buffer:
8070
8071@smallexample
8072(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8073(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8074> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8075> tfind line
8076> end
8077
8078Frame 0, X = 1
8079Frame 7, X = 2
8080Frame 13, X = 255
8081@end smallexample
8082
8083@node tdump
8084@subsection @code{tdump}
8085@kindex tdump
8086@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8087@cindex tracepoint data, display
8088
8089This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8090the current trace snapshot.
8091
8092@smallexample
8093(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8094(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8095Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8096> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8097> end
8098
8099(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8100
8101(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8102#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8103at gdb_test.c:444
8104444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8105
8106(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8107Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8108d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8109d1 0x18 24
8110d2 0x80 128
8111d3 0x33 51
8112d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8113d5 0x22 34
8114d6 0xe0 224
8115d7 0x380035 3670069
8116a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8117a1 0x3000668 50333288
8118a2 0x100 256
8119a3 0x322000 3284992
8120a4 0x3000698 50333336
8121a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8122fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8123sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8124ps 0x0 0
8125pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8126fpcontrol 0x0 0
8127fpstatus 0x0 0
8128fpiaddr 0x0 0
8129p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8130p1 = (void *) 0x11
8131p2 = (void *) 0x22
8132p3 = (void *) 0x33
8133p4 = (void *) 0x44
8134p5 = (void *) 0x55
8135p6 = (void *) 0x66
8136gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8137
8138(@value{GDBP})
8139@end smallexample
8140
8141@node save-tracepoints
8142@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8143@kindex save-tracepoints
8144@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8145
8146This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8147their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8148suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8149tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8150Files}).
8151
8152@node Tracepoint Variables
8153@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8154@cindex tracepoint variables
8155@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8156
8157@table @code
8158@vindex $trace_frame
8159@item (int) $trace_frame
8160The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8161snapshot is selected.
8162
8163@vindex $tracepoint
8164@item (int) $tracepoint
8165The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8166
8167@vindex $trace_line
8168@item (int) $trace_line
8169The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8170
8171@vindex $trace_file
8172@item (char []) $trace_file
8173The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8174
8175@vindex $trace_func
8176@item (char []) $trace_func
8177The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8178@end table
8179
8180Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8181use @code{output} instead.
8182
8183Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8184stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8185data.
8186
8187@smallexample
8188(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8189
8190(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8191> output $trace_file
8192> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8193> tfind
8194> end
8195@end smallexample
8196
8197@node Overlays
8198@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8199@cindex overlays
8200
8201If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8202memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8203problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8204use overlays.
8205
8206@menu
8207* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8208* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8209* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8210 mapped by asking the inferior.
8211* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8212@end menu
8213
8214@node How Overlays Work
8215@section How Overlays Work
8216@cindex mapped overlays
8217@cindex unmapped overlays
8218@cindex load address, overlay's
8219@cindex mapped address
8220@cindex overlay area
8221
8222Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8223kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8224other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8225management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8226adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8227
8228One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8229independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8230@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8231their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8232instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8233largest overlay as well.
8234
8235Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8236overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8237for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8238there.
8239
8240@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8241@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8242@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8243
8244@smallexample
8245@group
8246 Data Instruction Larger
8247Address Space Address Space Address Space
8248+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8249| | | | | |
8250+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8251| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8252| variables | | program | | +-----------+
8253| and heap | | | | | |
8254+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8255| | +-----------+ | | | load address
8256+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8257 | | | | | |
8258 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8259 address | | | | | |
8260 | overlay | <-' | | |
8261 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8262 | | <---. | | load address
8263 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8264 | | | |
8265 +-----------+ | |
8266 +-----------+
8267 | |
8268 +-----------+
8269
8270 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8271@end group
8272@end smallexample
8273
8274The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8275and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8276its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8277Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8278may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8279data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8280program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8281program and the overlay area.
8282
8283An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8284@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8285instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8286in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8287is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8288the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8289called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8290
8291Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8292program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8293global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8294
8295@itemize @bullet
8296
8297@item
8298Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8299must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8300return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8301overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8302
8303@item
8304If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8305will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8306your program's performance.
8307
8308@item
8309The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8310overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8311mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8312and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8313You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8314addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8315ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8316
8317@item
8318The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8319to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8320instruction and data spaces.
8321
8322@end itemize
8323
8324The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8325improved in many ways:
8326
8327@itemize @bullet
8328
8329@item
8330If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8331hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8332contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8333This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8334area in the usual way.
8335
8336@item
8337If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8338overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8339
8340@item
8341You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8342general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8343code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8344return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8345the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8346must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8347different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8348
8349@end itemize
8350
8351
8352@node Overlay Commands
8353@section Overlay Commands
8354
8355To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8356correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8357virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8358mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8359@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8360variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8361
8362@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8363you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8364
8365@table @code
8366@item overlay off
8367@kindex overlay
8368Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8369disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8370always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8371overlay support is disabled.
8372
8373@item overlay manual
8374@cindex manual overlay debugging
8375Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8376relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8377using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8378commands described below.
8379
8380@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8381@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8382@cindex map an overlay
8383Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8384be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8385overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8386functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8387that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8388@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8389
8390@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8391@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8392@cindex unmap an overlay
8393Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8394must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8395When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8396overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8397
8398@item overlay auto
8399Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8400consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8401to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8402Overlay Debugging}.
8403
8404@item overlay load-target
8405@itemx overlay load
8406@cindex reloading the overlay table
8407Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8408re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8409stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8410overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8411useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8412
8413@item overlay list-overlays
8414@itemx overlay list
8415@cindex listing mapped overlays
8416Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8417addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8418
8419@end table
8420
8421Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8422of the function the address falls in:
8423
8424@smallexample
8425(@value{GDBP}) print main
8426$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8427@end smallexample
8428@noindent
8429When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8430unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8431asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8432unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8433
8434@smallexample
8435(@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8436No sections are mapped.
8437(@value{GDBP}) print foo
8438$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8439@end smallexample
8440@noindent
8441When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8442name normally:
8443
8444@smallexample
8445(@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8446Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8447 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8448(@value{GDBP}) print foo
8449$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8450@end smallexample
8451
8452When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8453address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8454overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8455@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8456code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8457
8458@itemize @bullet
8459@item
8460@cindex breakpoints in overlays
8461@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8462You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8463@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8464@item
8465@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8466unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8467overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8468you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8469breakpoints properly.
8470@end itemize
8471
8472
8473@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8474@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8475@cindex automatic overlay debugging
8476
8477@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8478are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8479inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8480@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8481looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8482current state of the overlays.
8483
8484Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8485@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8486
8487@table @asis
8488
8489@item @code{_ovly_table}:
8490This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8491
8492@smallexample
8493struct
8494@{
8495 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8496 unsigned long vma;
8497
8498 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8499 unsigned long size;
8500
8501 /* The overlay's load address. */
8502 unsigned long lma;
8503
8504 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8505 zero otherwise. */
8506 unsigned long mapped;
8507@}
8508@end smallexample
8509
8510@item @code{_novlys}:
8511This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8512number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8513
8514@end table
8515
8516To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8517looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8518@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8519executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8520the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8521currently mapped.
8522
8523In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8524@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8525will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8526calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8527will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8528are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8529in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8530overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8531are not being executed.
8532
8533@node Overlay Sample Program
8534@section Overlay Sample Program
8535@cindex overlay example program
8536
8537When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8538at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8539addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8540Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8541since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8542architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8543portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8544
8545However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8546program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8547suite. The program consists of the following files from
8548@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8549
8550@table @file
8551@item overlays.c
8552The main program file.
8553@item ovlymgr.c
8554A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8555@item foo.c
8556@itemx bar.c
8557@itemx baz.c
8558@itemx grbx.c
8559Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8560@item d10v.ld
8561@itemx m32r.ld
8562Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8563and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8564@end table
8565
8566You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8567cross-compiler like this:
8568
8569@smallexample
8570$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8571$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8572$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8573$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8574$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8575$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8576$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8577 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8578@end smallexample
8579
8580The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8581you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8582target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8583
8584
8585@node Languages
8586@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8587@cindex languages
8588
8589Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8590rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8591dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8592Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8593represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8594@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8595
8596@cindex working language
8597Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8598allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8599native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8600consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8601language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8602language}.
8603
8604@menu
8605* Setting:: Switching between source languages
8606* Show:: Displaying the language
8607* Checks:: Type and range checks
8608* Supported Languages:: Supported languages
8609* Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
8610@end menu
8611
8612@node Setting
8613@section Switching Between Source Languages
8614
8615There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8616set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8617@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8618defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8619used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8620are printed, etc.
8621
8622In addition to the working language, every source file that
8623@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8624file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8625source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8626language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8627controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8628show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8629set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8630set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8631Displaying the Language}.
8632
8633This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8634as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8635another language. In that case, make the
8636program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8637@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8638program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8639
8640@menu
8641* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8642* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8643* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8644@end menu
8645
8646@node Filenames
8647@subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
8648
8649If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8650@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8651
8652@table @file
8653@item .ada
8654@itemx .ads
8655@itemx .adb
8656@itemx .a
8657Ada source file.
8658
8659@item .c
8660C source file
8661
8662@item .C
8663@itemx .cc
8664@itemx .cp
8665@itemx .cpp
8666@itemx .cxx
8667@itemx .c++
8668C@t{++} source file
8669
8670@item .m
8671Objective-C source file
8672
8673@item .f
8674@itemx .F
8675Fortran source file
8676
8677@item .mod
8678Modula-2 source file
8679
8680@item .s
8681@itemx .S
8682Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8683@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8684@end table
8685
8686In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8687extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
8688
8689@node Manually
8690@subsection Setting the Working Language
8691
8692If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8693expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8694your program.
8695
8696@kindex set language
8697If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8698command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8699a language, such as
8700@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8701For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8702
8703Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8704language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8705to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8706source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8707languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8708source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8709command such as:
8710
8711@smallexample
8712print a = b + c
8713@end smallexample
8714
8715@noindent
8716might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8717@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8718printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8719@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8720
8721@node Automatically
8722@subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
8723
8724To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8725@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8726then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8727frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8728working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8729frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8730or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8731does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8732not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8733
8734This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8735entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8736written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8737a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8738case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8739
8740@node Show
8741@section Displaying the Language
8742
8743The following commands help you find out which language is the
8744working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8745
8746@table @code
8747@item show language
8748@kindex show language
8749Display the current working language. This is the
8750language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8751build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8752
8753@item info frame
8754@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8755Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8756working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8757@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
8758information listed here.
8759
8760@item info source
8761@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8762Display the source language of this source file.
8763@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8764information listed here.
8765@end table
8766
8767In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8768not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8769with a language explicitly:
8770
8771@table @code
8772@item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8773@kindex set extension-language
8774Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8775assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8776
8777@item info extensions
8778@kindex info extensions
8779List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8780@end table
8781
8782@node Checks
8783@section Type and Range Checking
8784
8785@quotation
8786@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8787checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8788section documents the intended facilities.
8789@end quotation
8790@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8791
8792Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8793errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8794checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8795sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8796these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8797by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8798errors when your program is running.
8799
8800@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8801Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8802it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8803evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8804working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8805automatically based on your program's source language.
8806@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
8807settings of supported languages.
8808
8809@menu
8810* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8811* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8812@end menu
8813
8814@cindex type checking
8815@cindex checks, type
8816@node Type Checking
8817@subsection An Overview of Type Checking
8818
8819Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8820arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8821otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8822errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8823
8824@smallexample
88251 + 2 @result{} 3
8826@exdent but
8827@error{} 1 + 2.3
8828@end smallexample
8829
8830The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8831type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8832
8833For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8834@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8835to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8836or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8837but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8838these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8839also issues a warning.
8840
8841Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8842related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8843For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8844a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8845with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8846the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8847
8848Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8849instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8850operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8851represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8852operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
8853details on specific languages.
8854
8855@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8856
8857@kindex set check type
8858@kindex show check type
8859@table @code
8860@item set check type auto
8861Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8862@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
8863each language.
8864
8865@item set check type on
8866@itemx set check type off
8867Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8868current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
8869match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
8870evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
8871message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
8872
8873@item set check type warn
8874Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
8875evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
8876be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
8877numbers and structures.
8878
8879@item show type
8880Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
8881is setting it automatically.
8882@end table
8883
8884@cindex range checking
8885@cindex checks, range
8886@node Range Checking
8887@subsection An Overview of Range Checking
8888
8889In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
8890bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
8891checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
8892computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
8893not exceed the bounds of the array.
8894
8895For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
8896@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
8897always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
8898warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
8899
8900A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
8901array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
8902of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
8903error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
8904result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
8905the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
8906
8907@smallexample
8908@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
8909@end smallexample
8910
8911This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
8912specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
8913Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
8914
8915@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
8916
8917@kindex set check range
8918@kindex show check range
8919@table @code
8920@item set check range auto
8921Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
8922@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
8923each language.
8924
8925@item set check range on
8926@itemx set check range off
8927Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8928current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
8929match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
8930then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
8931
8932@item set check range warn
8933Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
8934but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
8935expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
8936memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
8937systems).
8938
8939@item show range
8940Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
8941being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
8942@end table
8943
8944@node Supported Languages
8945@section Supported Languages
8946
8947@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
8948assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
8949@c This is false ...
8950Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
8951language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
8952and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
8953,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
8954language.
8955
8956The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
8957supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
8958tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
8959@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
8960formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
8961books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
8962language reference or tutorial.
8963
8964@menu
8965* C:: C and C@t{++}
8966* Objective-C:: Objective-C
8967* Fortran:: Fortran
8968* Pascal:: Pascal
8969* Modula-2:: Modula-2
8970* Ada:: Ada
8971@end menu
8972
8973@node C
8974@subsection C and C@t{++}
8975
8976@cindex C and C@t{++}
8977@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
8978
8979Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
8980to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
8981together.
8982
8983@cindex C@t{++}
8984@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
8985@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
8986The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
8987compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
8988effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
8989C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
8990compiler (@code{aCC}).
8991
8992For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
8993format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
8994format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
8995command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
8996@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
8997gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
8998
8999@menu
9000* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9001* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9002* C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9003* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9004* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9005* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9006* Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9007@end menu
9008
9009@node C Operators
9010@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9011
9012@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9013
9014Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9015@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9016often defined on groups of types.
9017
9018For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9019
9020@itemize @bullet
9021
9022@item
9023@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9024specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9025
9026@item
9027@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9028@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9029
9030@item
9031@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9032
9033@item
9034@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9035
9036@end itemize
9037
9038@noindent
9039The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9040in order of increasing precedence:
9041
9042@table @code
9043@item ,
9044The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9045are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9046expression being the last expression evaluated.
9047
9048@item =
9049Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9050assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9051
9052@item @var{op}=
9053Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9054and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9055@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9056@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9057@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9058
9059@item ?:
9060The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9061of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9062integral type.
9063
9064@item ||
9065Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9066
9067@item &&
9068Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9069
9070@item |
9071Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9072
9073@item ^
9074Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9075
9076@item &
9077Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9078
9079@item ==@r{, }!=
9080Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9081expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9082
9083@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9084Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9085Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9086and non-zero for true.
9087
9088@item <<@r{, }>>
9089left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9090
9091@item @@
9092The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9093
9094@item +@r{, }-
9095Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9096pointer types.
9097
9098@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9099Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9100defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9101integral types.
9102
9103@item ++@r{, }--
9104Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9105operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9106when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9107operation takes place.
9108
9109@item *
9110Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9111@code{++}.
9112
9113@item &
9114Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9115
9116For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9117allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9118(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
9119where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9120stored.
9121
9122@item -
9123Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9124precedence as @code{++}.
9125
9126@item !
9127Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9128@code{++}.
9129
9130@item ~
9131Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9132@code{++}.
9133
9134
9135@item .@r{, }->
9136Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9137@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9138pointer based on the stored type information.
9139Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9140
9141@item .*@r{, }->*
9142Dereferences of pointers to members.
9143
9144@item []
9145Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9146@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9147
9148@item ()
9149Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9150
9151@item ::
9152C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9153and @code{class} types.
9154
9155@item ::
9156Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9157(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9158above.
9159@end table
9160
9161If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9162attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9163predefined meaning.
9164
9165@node C Constants
9166@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
9167
9168@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9169
9170@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9171following ways:
9172
9173@itemize @bullet
9174@item
9175Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9176specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9177by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9178@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9179@code{long} value.
9180
9181@item
9182Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9183point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9184exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9185@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9186sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9187A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9188@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9189the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9190a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9191constant.
9192
9193@item
9194Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9195integral equivalents.
9196
9197@item
9198Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9199(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9200(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9201be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9202the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9203of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9204@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9205@samp{\n} for newline.
9206
9207@item
9208String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9209double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9210above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9211a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9212characters.
9213
9214@item
9215Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9216to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9217
9218@item
9219Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9220and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9221integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9222and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9223@end itemize
9224
9225@node C Plus Plus Expressions
9226@subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
9227
9228@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9229@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9230
9231@cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9232@cindex C@t{++} compilers
9233@cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9234@cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9235@quotation
9236@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9237proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9238works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9239@value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9240@option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9241stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9242stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9243specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9244are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9245C@t{++} code.
9246@end quotation
9247
9248@enumerate
9249
9250@cindex member functions
9251@item
9252Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9253
9254@smallexample
9255count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9256@end smallexample
9257
9258@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9259@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9260@item
9261While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9262expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9263that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9264pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9265
9266@cindex call overloaded functions
9267@cindex overloaded functions, calling
9268@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9269@item
9270You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9271call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9272perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9273calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9274in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9275default arguments.
9276
9277It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9278promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9279class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9280functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9281number of function arguments.
9282
9283Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9284@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
9285,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
9286
9287You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9288explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9289@smallexample
9290p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9291@end smallexample
9292
9293The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9294see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
9295
9296@cindex reference declarations
9297@item
9298@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9299them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9300dereferenced.
9301
9302In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9303reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9304avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9305The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9306you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9307
9308@item
9309@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9310expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9311one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9312necessary, for example in an expression like
9313@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9314resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9315debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
9316@end enumerate
9317
9318In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9319calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9320objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9321invoking user-defined operators.
9322
9323@node C Defaults
9324@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
9325
9326@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9327
9328If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9329both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9330C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9331selects the working language.
9332
9333If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9334recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9335@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9336these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9337@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
9338for further details.
9339
9340@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9341@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9342@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9343
9344@node C Checks
9345@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
9346
9347@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9348
9349By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9350is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9351considers two variables type equivalent if:
9352
9353@itemize @bullet
9354@item
9355The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9356enumerated tag.
9357
9358@item
9359The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9360declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9361
9362@ignore
9363@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9364@c FIXME--beers?
9365@item
9366The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9367declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9368compilers.)
9369@end ignore
9370@end itemize
9371
9372Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9373indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9374that is not itself an array.
9375
9376@node Debugging C
9377@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9378
9379The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9380the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9381inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9382appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9383
9384The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9385with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9386,Expressions}.
9387
9388@node Debugging C Plus Plus
9389@subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
9390
9391@cindex commands for C@t{++}
9392
9393Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9394designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9395
9396@table @code
9397@cindex break in overloaded functions
9398@item @r{breakpoint menus}
9399When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9400@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9401you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint Menus}.
9402
9403@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9404@item rbreak @var{regex}
9405Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9406breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9407classes.
9408@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
9409
9410@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9411@item catch throw
9412@itemx catch catch
9413Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9414Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
9415
9416@cindex inheritance
9417@item ptype @var{typename}
9418Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9419@var{typename}.
9420@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9421
9422@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9423@item set print demangle
9424@itemx show print demangle
9425@itemx set print asm-demangle
9426@itemx show print asm-demangle
9427Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9428displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9429@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9430
9431@item set print object
9432@itemx show print object
9433Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9434@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9435
9436@item set print vtbl
9437@itemx show print vtbl
9438Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9439@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
9440(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9441ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9442
9443@kindex set overload-resolution
9444@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9445@item set overload-resolution on
9446Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9447is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9448and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9449using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
9450Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
9451If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
9452
9453@item set overload-resolution off
9454Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9455overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9456chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9457symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9458overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9459searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9460argument types.
9461
9462@kindex show overload-resolution
9463@item show overload-resolution
9464Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9465
9466@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9467You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9468the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9469@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9470also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9471available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9472@xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
9473@end table
9474
9475@node Objective-C
9476@subsection Objective-C
9477
9478@cindex Objective-C
9479This section provides information about some commands and command
9480options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9481@ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9482few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9483
9484@menu
9485* Method Names in Commands::
9486* The Print Command with Objective-C::
9487@end menu
9488
9489@node Method Names in Commands
9490@subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9491
9492The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9493names as line specifications:
9494
9495@kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9496@kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9497@kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9498@kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9499@kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9500@itemize
9501@item @code{clear}
9502@item @code{break}
9503@item @code{info line}
9504@item @code{jump}
9505@item @code{list}
9506@end itemize
9507
9508A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9509
9510@smallexample
9511-[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9512@end smallexample
9513
9514where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9515plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9516name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9517brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9518source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9519instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9520debugged, enter:
9521
9522@smallexample
9523break -[Fruit create]
9524@end smallexample
9525
9526To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9527enter:
9528
9529@smallexample
9530list +[NSText initialize]
9531@end smallexample
9532
9533In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9534required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9535sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9536is also possible to specify just a method name:
9537
9538@smallexample
9539break create
9540@end smallexample
9541
9542You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9543your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9544you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9545method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9546none apply.
9547
9548As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9549@code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9550
9551@smallexample
9552clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9553@end smallexample
9554
9555@node The Print Command with Objective-C
9556@subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9557@cindex Objective-C, print objects
9558@kindex print-object
9559@kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9560
9561The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9562
9563@smallexample
9564print -[@var{object} hash]
9565@end smallexample
9566
9567@cindex print an Objective-C object description
9568@cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9569@noindent
9570will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9571and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9572@code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9573the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9574with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9575function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9576
9577@node Fortran
9578@subsection Fortran
9579@cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9580
9581@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9582currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9583
9584@cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9585Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9586among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9587functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9588will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9589underscore.
9590
9591@menu
9592* Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9593* Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9594* Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9595@end menu
9596
9597@node Fortran Operators
9598@subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
9599
9600@cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9601
9602Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9603@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9604arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9605
9606@table @code
9607@item **
9608The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9609of the second one.
9610
9611@item :
9612The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9613represent a section of array.
9614@end table
9615
9616@node Fortran Defaults
9617@subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9618
9619@cindex Fortran Defaults
9620
9621Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9622default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9623change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9624@ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9625
9626@node Special Fortran Commands
9627@subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
9628
9629@cindex Special Fortran commands
9630
9631@value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
9632such as displaying common blocks.
9633
9634@table @code
9635@cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9636@kindex info common
9637@item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9638This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9639block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9640all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
9641printed.
9642@end table
9643
9644@node Pascal
9645@subsection Pascal
9646
9647@cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9648Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9649nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9650entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9651syntax.
9652
9653The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9654controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9655@xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9656
9657@node Modula-2
9658@subsection Modula-2
9659
9660@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9661
9662The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9663output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9664developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9665attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9666to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9667table.
9668
9669@cindex expressions in Modula-2
9670@menu
9671* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9672* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9673* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9674* M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9675* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9676* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9677* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9678* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9679* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9680@end menu
9681
9682@node M2 Operators
9683@subsubsection Operators
9684@cindex Modula-2 operators
9685
9686Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9687@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9688often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9689following definitions hold:
9690
9691@itemize @bullet
9692
9693@item
9694@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9695their subranges.
9696
9697@item
9698@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9699
9700@item
9701@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9702
9703@item
9704@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9705@var{type}}.
9706
9707@item
9708@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9709
9710@item
9711@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9712
9713@item
9714@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9715@end itemize
9716
9717@noindent
9718The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9719increasing precedence:
9720
9721@table @code
9722@item ,
9723Function argument or array index separator.
9724
9725@item :=
9726Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9727@var{value}.
9728
9729@item <@r{, }>
9730Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9731types.
9732
9733@item <=@r{, }>=
9734Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9735on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9736set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9737
9738@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9739Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9740Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9741available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9742comment character.
9743
9744@item IN
9745Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9746Same precedence as @code{<}.
9747
9748@item OR
9749Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9750
9751@item AND@r{, }&
9752Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9753
9754@item @@
9755The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9756
9757@item +@r{, }-
9758Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9759and difference on set types.
9760
9761@item *
9762Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9763on set types.
9764
9765@item /
9766Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9767types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9768
9769@item DIV@r{, }MOD
9770Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9771precedence as @code{*}.
9772
9773@item -
9774Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9775
9776@item ^
9777Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9778
9779@item NOT
9780Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9781@code{^}.
9782
9783@item .
9784@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9785precedence as @code{^}.
9786
9787@item []
9788Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9789
9790@item ()
9791Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9792as @code{^}.
9793
9794@item ::@r{, }.
9795@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9796@end table
9797
9798@quotation
9799@emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9800treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9801@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9802@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9803@end quotation
9804
9805
9806@node Built-In Func/Proc
9807@subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
9808@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9809
9810Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9811In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9812
9813@table @var
9814
9815@item a
9816represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9817
9818@item c
9819represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9820
9821@item i
9822represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9823
9824@item m
9825represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9826same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9827be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9828
9829@item n
9830represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9831
9832@item r
9833represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9834
9835@item t
9836represents a type.
9837
9838@item v
9839represents a variable.
9840
9841@item x
9842represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9843explanation of the function for details.
9844@end table
9845
9846All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
9847
9848@table @code
9849@item ABS(@var{n})
9850Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
9851
9852@item CAP(@var{c})
9853If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
9854equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
9855
9856@item CHR(@var{i})
9857Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9858
9859@item DEC(@var{v})
9860Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9861
9862@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
9863Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9864new value.
9865
9866@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9867Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
9868set.
9869
9870@item FLOAT(@var{i})
9871Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
9872
9873@item HIGH(@var{a})
9874Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
9875
9876@item INC(@var{v})
9877Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9878
9879@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
9880Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9881new value.
9882
9883@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9884Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
9885there. Returns the new set.
9886
9887@item MAX(@var{t})
9888Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
9889
9890@item MIN(@var{t})
9891Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
9892
9893@item ODD(@var{i})
9894Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
9895
9896@item ORD(@var{x})
9897Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
9898value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
9899@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
9900integral, character and enumerated types.
9901
9902@item SIZE(@var{x})
9903Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
9904
9905@item TRUNC(@var{r})
9906Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
9907
9908@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
9909Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9910@end table
9911
9912@quotation
9913@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
9914@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
9915an error.
9916@end quotation
9917
9918@cindex Modula-2 constants
9919@node M2 Constants
9920@subsubsection Constants
9921
9922@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
9923ways:
9924
9925@itemize @bullet
9926
9927@item
9928Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
9929expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
9930rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
9931trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
9932
9933@item
9934Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
9935decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
9936then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
9937@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
9938digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
9939digits.
9940
9941@item
9942Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
9943like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
9944also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
9945followed by a @samp{C}.
9946
9947@item
9948String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
9949pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
9950Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
9951Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
9952sequences.
9953
9954@item
9955Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
9956
9957@item
9958Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
9959@code{FALSE}.
9960
9961@item
9962Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
9963
9964@item
9965Set constants are not yet supported.
9966@end itemize
9967
9968@node M2 Types
9969@subsubsection Modula-2 Types
9970@cindex Modula-2 types
9971
9972Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
9973syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
9974types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
9975print the contents of variables declared using these type.
9976This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
9977sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
9978
9979The first example contains the following section of code:
9980
9981@smallexample
9982VAR
9983 s: SET OF CHAR ;
9984 r: [20..40] ;
9985@end smallexample
9986
9987@noindent
9988and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
9989@code{r} and @code{s}.
9990
9991@smallexample
9992(@value{GDBP}) print s
9993@{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
9994(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9995SET OF CHAR
9996(@value{GDBP}) print r
999721
9998(@value{GDBP}) ptype r
9999[20..40]
10000@end smallexample
10001
10002@noindent
10003Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10004
10005@smallexample
10006VAR
10007 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
10008@end smallexample
10009
10010@noindent
10011then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
10012
10013@smallexample
10014(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10015type = SET ['A'..'Z']
10016@end smallexample
10017
10018@noindent
10019Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
10020expressions using the debugger.
10021
10022The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
10023and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10024
10025@smallexample
10026VAR
10027 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10028@end smallexample
10029
10030@smallexample
10031(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10032ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10033@end smallexample
10034
10035Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10036is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10037arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10038above. Unbounded arrays are also not yet recognized in @value{GDBN}.
10039
10040Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10041
10042@smallexample
10043TYPE
10044 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10045 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10046VAR
10047 s: t ;
10048BEGIN
10049 s := blue ;
10050@end smallexample
10051
10052@noindent
10053The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10054and value of a variable.
10055
10056@smallexample
10057(@value{GDBP}) print s
10058$1 = blue
10059(@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10060type = [blue..yellow]
10061@end smallexample
10062
10063@noindent
10064In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10065displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10066their @code{C} counterparts.
10067
10068@smallexample
10069VAR
10070 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10071BEGIN
10072 s[1] := 1 ;
10073@end smallexample
10074
10075@smallexample
10076(@value{GDBP}) print s
10077$1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10078(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10079type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10080@end smallexample
10081
10082The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10083pointer types as shown in this example:
10084
10085@smallexample
10086VAR
10087 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10088BEGIN
10089 NEW(s) ;
10090 s^[1] := 1 ;
10091@end smallexample
10092
10093@noindent
10094and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10095
10096@smallexample
10097(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10098type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10099@end smallexample
10100
10101@value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10102Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10103types:
10104
10105@smallexample
10106TYPE
10107 foo = RECORD
10108 f1: CARDINAL ;
10109 f2: CHAR ;
10110 f3: myarray ;
10111 END ;
10112
10113 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10114 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10115VAR
10116 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10117@end smallexample
10118
10119@noindent
10120and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10121below.
10122
10123@smallexample
10124(@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10125type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10126 f1 : CARDINAL;
10127 f2 : CHAR;
10128 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10129END
10130@end smallexample
10131
10132@node M2 Defaults
10133@subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
10134@cindex Modula-2 defaults
10135
10136If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10137both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10138Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10139selected the working language.
10140
10141If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10142code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10143working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
10144Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
10145
10146@node Deviations
10147@subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
10148@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10149
10150A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10151This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10152
10153@itemize @bullet
10154@item
10155Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10156integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10157debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10158pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10159through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10160returned a pointer.)
10161
10162@item
10163C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10164non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10165escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10166printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10167
10168@item
10169The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10170argument.
10171
10172@item
10173All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10174@end itemize
10175
10176@node M2 Checks
10177@subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
10178@cindex Modula-2 checks
10179
10180@quotation
10181@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10182range checking.
10183@end quotation
10184@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10185
10186@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10187
10188@itemize @bullet
10189@item
10190They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10191@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10192
10193@item
10194They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10195@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10196@end itemize
10197
10198As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10199whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10200
10201Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10202index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10203
10204@node M2 Scope
10205@subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10206@cindex scope
10207@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10208@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10209@ifinfo
10210@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10211@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10212@end ifinfo
10213@iftex
10214@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10215@end iftex
10216
10217There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10218(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10219similar syntax:
10220
10221@smallexample
10222
10223@var{module} . @var{id}
10224@var{scope} :: @var{id}
10225@end smallexample
10226
10227@noindent
10228where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10229@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10230identifier within your program, except another module.
10231
10232Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10233specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10234found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10235enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10236
10237Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10238the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10239definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10240an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10241module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10242@var{module}.
10243
10244@node GDB/M2
10245@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10246
10247Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10248Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10249specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10250@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10251apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10252analogue in Modula-2.
10253
10254The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10255with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10256intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10257created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10258address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10259@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10260
10261@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10262In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10263interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10264
10265@node Ada
10266@subsection Ada
10267@cindex Ada
10268
10269The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10270output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10271Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10272attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10273to be difficult.
10274
10275
10276@cindex expressions in Ada
10277@menu
10278* Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10279 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10280 in @value{GDBN}.
10281* Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10282* Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10283* Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10284* Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10285@end menu
10286
10287@node Ada Mode Intro
10288@subsubsection Introduction
10289@cindex Ada mode, general
10290
10291The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10292syntax, with some extensions.
10293The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10294
10295@itemize @bullet
10296@item
10297That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10298arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10299leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10300program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10301
10302@item
10303That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10304are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10305
10306@item
10307That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10308@end itemize
10309
10310Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10311implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10312packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10313their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10314@value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10315
10316The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10317As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10318was translated from an Ada source file.
10319
10320While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10321mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10322(@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10323middle (to allow based literals).
10324
10325The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10326the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10327actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10328the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10329procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10330functions to procedures elsewhere.
10331
10332@node Omissions from Ada
10333@subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10334@cindex Ada, omissions from
10335
10336Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10337
10338@itemize @bullet
10339@item
10340Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10341
10342@itemize @minus
10343@item
10344@t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10345 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10346
10347@item
10348@t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10349
10350@item
10351@t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10352
10353@item
10354@t{'Tag}.
10355
10356@item
10357@t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10358operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10359
10360@item
10361@t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10362@t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10363
10364@item
10365@t{'Address}.
10366@end itemize
10367
10368@item
10369The names in
10370@code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10371concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10372not currently available.
10373
10374@item
10375Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10376equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10377for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10378They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10379types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10380(in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10381zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10382indeterminate values.
10383
10384@item
10385The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10386@code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10387are not implemented.
10388
10389@item
10390@cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10391@cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10392@cindex aggregates (Ada)
10393There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10394permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10395
10396@smallexample
10397set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10398set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10399set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10400set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10401set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10402set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10403@end smallexample
10404
10405Changing a
10406discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10407undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10408However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10409them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10410aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10411declared to have a type such as:
10412
10413@smallexample
10414type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10415 Id : Integer;
10416 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10417end record;
10418@end smallexample
10419
10420you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10421assignments:
10422
10423@smallexample
10424set A_Rec.Len := 4
10425set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10426@end smallexample
10427
10428As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10429rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10430components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10431component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10432original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10433indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10434redundant component associations, although which component values are
10435assigned in such cases is not defined.
10436
10437@item
10438Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10439
10440@item
10441The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10442than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
10443which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
10444looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
10445function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
10446the proper resolution.
10447
10448@item
10449The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10450
10451@item
10452Entry calls are not implemented.
10453
10454@item
10455Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10456formats are not supported.
10457
10458@item
10459It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10460@end itemize
10461
10462@node Additions to Ada
10463@subsubsection Additions to Ada
10464@cindex Ada, deviations from
10465
10466As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10467extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10468
10469@itemize @bullet
10470@item
10471If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
10472a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
10473then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
10474@var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
10475Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
10476in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
10477Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
10478which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10479
10480@item
10481@code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
10482appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
10483you must typically surround it in single quotes.
10484
10485@item
10486The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10487@var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10488
10489@item
10490A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10491(@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10492@end itemize
10493
10494In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
10495additions specific to Ada:
10496
10497@itemize @bullet
10498@item
10499The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10500its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10501
10502@smallexample
10503set x := y + 3
10504print A(tmp := y + 1)
10505@end smallexample
10506
10507@item
10508The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10509the value of its right-hand operand.
10510This allows, for example,
10511complex conditional breaks:
10512
10513@smallexample
10514break f
10515condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10516@end smallexample
10517
10518@item
10519Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10520characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10521which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10522@samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10523(single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10524sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10525in strings. For example,
10526@smallexample
10527 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10528@end smallexample
10529@noindent
10530contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
10531after each period.
10532
10533@item
10534The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10535@t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10536to write
10537
10538@smallexample
10539print 'max(x, y)
10540@end smallexample
10541
10542@item
10543When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10544array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10545For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
10546of 3 might print as
10547
10548@smallexample
10549(3 => 10, 17, 1)
10550@end smallexample
10551
10552@noindent
10553That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10554clause.
10555
10556@item
10557You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10558multi-character subsequence of
10559their names (an exact match gets preference).
10560For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10561in place of @t{a'length}.
10562
10563@item
10564@cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10565Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10566to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10567some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10568For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10569enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10570For example,
10571@smallexample
10572@value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10573@end smallexample
10574
10575@item
10576Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10577access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10578specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10579selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10580object.
10581
10582@end itemize
10583
10584@node Stopping Before Main Program
10585@subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10586
10587@cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10588It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10589before reaching the main procedure.
10590As defined in the Ada Reference
10591Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10592@code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10593elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10594@code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10595
10596@node Ada Glitches
10597@subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10598@cindex Ada, problems
10599
10600Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10601we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10602@value{GDBN},
10603some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10604and the GNU Ada compiler.
10605
10606@itemize @bullet
10607@item
10608Currently, the debugger
10609has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10610pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10611Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10612to get it printed properly.
10613
10614@item
10615Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10616storage are invisible to the debugger.
10617
10618@item
10619Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10620argument lists are treated as positional).
10621
10622@item
10623Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10624
10625@item
10626Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10627floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10628the host machine.
10629
10630@item
10631The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10632
10633@item
10634The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10635the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10636this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10637look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10638symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10639defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10640local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10641GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10642you can usually resolve the confusion
10643by qualifying the problematic names with package
10644@code{Standard} explicitly.
10645@end itemize
10646
10647@node Unsupported Languages
10648@section Unsupported Languages
10649
10650@cindex unsupported languages
10651@cindex minimal language
10652In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10653@value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10654It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10655of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10656This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10657an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10658
10659If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10660select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10661language.
10662
10663@node Symbols
10664@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10665
10666The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10667symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10668program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10669does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10670program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10671(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
10672file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
10673
10674@cindex symbol names
10675@cindex names of symbols
10676@cindex quoting names
10677Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10678characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10679most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10680source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
10681are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10682ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10683@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10684@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10685
10686@smallexample
10687p 'foo.c'::x
10688@end smallexample
10689
10690@noindent
10691looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10692
10693@table @code
10694@cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10695@cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10696@kindex set case-sensitive
10697@item set case-sensitive on
10698@itemx set case-sensitive off
10699@itemx set case-sensitive auto
10700Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10701with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10702Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10703case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10704case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10705you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10706suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10707matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10708case-insensitive matches.
10709
10710@kindex show case-sensitive
10711@item show case-sensitive
10712This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10713lookups.
10714
10715@kindex info address
10716@cindex address of a symbol
10717@item info address @var{symbol}
10718Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10719variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10720local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10721is always stored.
10722
10723Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10724at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10725the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10726
10727@kindex info symbol
10728@cindex symbol from address
10729@cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10730@item info symbol @var{addr}
10731Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10732If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10733nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10734
10735@smallexample
10736(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10737_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10738@end smallexample
10739
10740@noindent
10741This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10742it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10743
10744@kindex whatis
10745@item whatis [@var{arg}]
10746Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10747a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10748last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10749not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10750assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10751@var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10752for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10753@samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10754@samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10755@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10756
10757@kindex ptype
10758@item ptype [@var{arg}]
10759@code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10760detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10761@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10762
10763For example, for this variable declaration:
10764
10765@smallexample
10766struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10767@end smallexample
10768
10769@noindent
10770the two commands give this output:
10771
10772@smallexample
10773@group
10774(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10775type = struct complex
10776(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10777type = struct complex @{
10778 double real;
10779 double imag;
10780@}
10781@end group
10782@end smallexample
10783
10784@noindent
10785As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10786the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10787
10788@cindex incomplete type
10789Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10790of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10791program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10792the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10793given these declarations:
10794
10795@smallexample
10796 struct foo;
10797 struct foo *fooptr;
10798@end smallexample
10799
10800@noindent
10801but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10802
10803@smallexample
10804 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
10805 $1 = <incomplete type>
10806@end smallexample
10807
10808@noindent
10809``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10810completely specified.
10811
10812@kindex info types
10813@item info types @var{regexp}
10814@itemx info types
10815Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10816expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10817no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10818complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10819types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10820@samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10821name is @code{value}.
10822
10823This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10824@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10825lists all source files where a type is defined.
10826
10827@kindex info scope
10828@cindex local variables
10829@item info scope @var{location}
10830List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10831accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10832an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10833to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10834
10835@smallexample
10836(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10837Scope for command_line_handler:
10838Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10839Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10840Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10841Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
10842Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
10843Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
10844Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
10845@end smallexample
10846
10847@noindent
10848This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
10849during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
10850collect}.
10851
10852@kindex info source
10853@item info source
10854Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
10855the function containing the current point of execution:
10856@itemize @bullet
10857@item
10858the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
10859@item
10860the directory it was compiled in,
10861@item
10862its length, in lines,
10863@item
10864which programming language it is written in,
10865@item
10866whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
10867if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
10868@item
10869whether the debugging information includes information about
10870preprocessor macros.
10871@end itemize
10872
10873
10874@kindex info sources
10875@item info sources
10876Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
10877debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
10878have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
10879
10880@kindex info functions
10881@item info functions
10882Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
10883
10884@item info functions @var{regexp}
10885Print the names and data types of all defined functions
10886whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
10887Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
10888include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
10889start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
10890that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
10891@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
10892
10893@kindex info variables
10894@item info variables
10895Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
10896outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
10897
10898@item info variables @var{regexp}
10899Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
10900variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
10901@var{regexp}.
10902
10903@kindex info classes
10904@cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
10905@item info classes
10906@itemx info classes @var{regexp}
10907Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
10908(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10909expression.
10910
10911@kindex info selectors
10912@item info selectors
10913@itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
10914Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
10915(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10916expression.
10917
10918@ignore
10919This was never implemented.
10920@kindex info methods
10921@item info methods
10922@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
10923The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
10924methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
10925specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
10926C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
10927from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
10928@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
10929which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
10930@end ignore
10931
10932@cindex reloading symbols
10933Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
10934be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
10935in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
10936running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
10937@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
10938
10939@table @code
10940@kindex set symbol-reloading
10941@item set symbol-reloading on
10942Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
10943object file with a particular name is seen again.
10944
10945@item set symbol-reloading off
10946Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
10947same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
10948running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
10949should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
10950may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
10951several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
10952name.
10953
10954@kindex show symbol-reloading
10955@item show symbol-reloading
10956Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
10957@end table
10958
10959@cindex opaque data types
10960@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
10961@item set opaque-type-resolution on
10962Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
10963declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
10964@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
10965source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
10966another source file. The default is on.
10967
10968A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
10969the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
10970
10971@item set opaque-type-resolution off
10972Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
10973is printed as follows:
10974@smallexample
10975@{<no data fields>@}
10976@end smallexample
10977
10978@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
10979@item show opaque-type-resolution
10980Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
10981
10982@kindex maint print symbols
10983@cindex symbol dump
10984@kindex maint print psymbols
10985@cindex partial symbol dump
10986@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
10987@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
10988@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
10989Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
10990These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
10991symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
10992symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
10993collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
10994only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
10995command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
10996use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
10997symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
10998files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
10999@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
11000required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
11001@xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
11002@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
11003
11004@kindex maint info symtabs
11005@kindex maint info psymtabs
11006@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
11007@cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11008@cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11009@cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
11010@item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11011@itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
11012
11013List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
11014structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
11015given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
11016copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
11017structure in more detail. For example:
11018
11019@smallexample
11020(@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
11021@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11022 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11023 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11024 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
11025 readin no
11026 fullname (null)
11027 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11028 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11029 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11030 dependencies (none)
11031 @}
11032@}
11033(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11034(@value{GDBP})
11035@end smallexample
11036@noindent
11037We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11038the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11039and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11040If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11041read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11042
11043@smallexample
11044(@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11045Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11046line 1574.
11047(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11048@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11049 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11050 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11051 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11052 dirname (null)
11053 fullname (null)
11054 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11055 debugformat DWARF 2
11056 @}
11057@}
11058(@value{GDBP})
11059@end smallexample
11060@end table
11061
11062
11063@node Altering
11064@chapter Altering Execution
11065
11066Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11067find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11068correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11069experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11070program.
11071
11072For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11073locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11074address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11075
11076@menu
11077* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11078* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11079* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11080* Returning:: Returning from a function
11081* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11082* Patching:: Patching your program
11083@end menu
11084
11085@node Assignment
11086@section Assignment to Variables
11087
11088@cindex assignment
11089@cindex setting variables
11090To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11091@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11092
11093@smallexample
11094print x=4
11095@end smallexample
11096
11097@noindent
11098stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11099value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11100@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11101information on operators in supported languages.
11102
11103@kindex set variable
11104@cindex variables, setting
11105If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11106@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11107really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11108not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11109,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11110
11111If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11112appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11113variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11114to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11115program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11116a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11117command @code{set width}:
11118
11119@smallexample
11120(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11121type = double
11122(@value{GDBP}) p width
11123$4 = 13
11124(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11125Invalid syntax in expression.
11126@end smallexample
11127
11128@noindent
11129The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11130order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11131
11132@smallexample
11133(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11134@end smallexample
11135
11136Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11137with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11138@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11139your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11140to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11141the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11142
11143@smallexample
11144@group
11145(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11146type = double
11147(@value{GDBP}) p g
11148$1 = 1
11149(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11150(@value{GDBP}) p g
11151$2 = 1
11152(@value{GDBP}) r
11153The program being debugged has been started already.
11154Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11155Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11156"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11157 Invalid bfd target.
11158(@value{GDBP}) show g
11159The current BFD target is "=4".
11160@end group
11161@end smallexample
11162
11163@noindent
11164The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11165@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11166@code{g}, use
11167
11168@smallexample
11169(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11170@end smallexample
11171
11172@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11173freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11174and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11175same length or shorter.
11176@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11177@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11178
11179To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11180construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11181(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11182to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11183and representation in memory), and
11184
11185@smallexample
11186set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11187@end smallexample
11188
11189@noindent
11190stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11191
11192@node Jumping
11193@section Continuing at a Different Address
11194
11195Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11196it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11197an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11198
11199@table @code
11200@kindex jump
11201@item jump @var{linespec}
11202Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
11203immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
11204Source Lines}, for a description of the different forms of
11205@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
11206in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
11207Breakpoints}.
11208
11209The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11210the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11211register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11212a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11213be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11214of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11215confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11216executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11217well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11218
11219@item jump *@var{address}
11220Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
11221@end table
11222
11223@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11224On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11225command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11226difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11227changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11228example,
11229
11230@smallexample
11231set $pc = 0x485
11232@end smallexample
11233
11234@noindent
11235makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11236address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11237@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
11238
11239The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11240up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11241that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11242detail.
11243
11244@c @group
11245@node Signaling
11246@section Giving your Program a Signal
11247@cindex deliver a signal to a program
11248
11249@table @code
11250@kindex signal
11251@item signal @var{signal}
11252Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11253signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11254signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11255SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11256
11257Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11258giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11259a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11260@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11261signal.
11262
11263@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11264after executing the command.
11265@end table
11266@c @end group
11267
11268Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11269@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11270causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11271the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11272passes the signal directly to your program.
11273
11274
11275@node Returning
11276@section Returning from a Function
11277
11278@table @code
11279@cindex returning from a function
11280@kindex return
11281@item return
11282@itemx return @var{expression}
11283You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11284command. If you give an
11285@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11286value.
11287@end table
11288
11289When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11290(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11291discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11292be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11293
11294This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11295Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11296innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11297specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11298of functions.
11299
11300The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11301program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11302returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11303and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
11304selected stack frame returns naturally.
11305
11306@node Calling
11307@section Calling Program Functions
11308
11309@table @code
11310@cindex calling functions
11311@cindex inferior functions, calling
11312@item print @var{expr}
11313Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
11314@var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11315debugged.
11316
11317@kindex call
11318@item call @var{expr}
11319Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11320returned values.
11321
11322You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11323execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11324(a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11325with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11326print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11327value history.
11328@end table
11329
11330It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11331@code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11332the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11333in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11334
11335@table @code
11336@item set unwindonsignal
11337@kindex set unwindonsignal
11338@cindex unwind stack in called functions
11339@cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11340Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11341that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11342@value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11343the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11344default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11345received.
11346
11347@item show unwindonsignal
11348@kindex show unwindonsignal
11349Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11350@value{GDBN}.
11351@end table
11352
11353@cindex weak alias functions
11354Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11355for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11356the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11357which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11358As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11359even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11360function instead.
11361
11362@node Patching
11363@section Patching Programs
11364
11365@cindex patching binaries
11366@cindex writing into executables
11367@cindex writing into corefiles
11368
11369By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11370executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11371alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11372patching your program's binary.
11373
11374If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11375explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11376want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11377repairs.
11378
11379@table @code
11380@kindex set write
11381@item set write on
11382@itemx set write off
11383If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11384core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11385off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11386
11387If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11388@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11389write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11390
11391@item show write
11392@kindex show write
11393Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11394as well as reading.
11395@end table
11396
11397@node GDB Files
11398@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11399
11400@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11401both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11402program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11403@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11404
11405@menu
11406* Files:: Commands to specify files
11407* Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11408* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11409@end menu
11410
11411@node Files
11412@section Commands to Specify Files
11413
11414@cindex symbol table
11415@cindex core dump file
11416
11417You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11418way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11419@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11420Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11421
11422Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11423@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11424specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11425via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
11426Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
11427new files are useful.
11428
11429@table @code
11430@cindex executable file
11431@kindex file
11432@item file @var{filename}
11433Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11434symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11435executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11436directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11437@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11438directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11439to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11440and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11441
11442@cindex unlinked object files
11443@cindex patching object files
11444You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11445the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11446file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11447if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11448@kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11449that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11450case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11451the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11452
11453@item file
11454@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11455has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11456
11457@kindex exec-file
11458@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11459Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11460in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11461if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11462discard information on the executable file.
11463
11464@kindex symbol-file
11465@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11466Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11467searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11468table and program to run from the same file.
11469
11470@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11471program's symbol table.
11472
11473The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11474some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11475contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11476which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11477@value{GDBN}.
11478
11479@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11480executing it once.
11481
11482When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11483understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11484generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11485other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11486Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11487using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11488optimized code.
11489
11490For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11491using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11492symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11493quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11494details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11495
11496The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11497start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11498occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11499file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11500pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11501Warnings and Messages}.)
11502
11503We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11504symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11505symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11506still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11507in stabs format.
11508
11509@kindex readnow
11510@cindex reading symbols immediately
11511@cindex symbols, reading immediately
11512@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11513@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11514You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11515tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11516load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11517entire symbol table available.
11518
11519@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11520@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11521@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11522@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11523@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11524@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11525@c files.
11526
11527@kindex core-file
11528@item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11529@itemx core
11530Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11531of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11532address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11533executable file itself for other parts.
11534
11535@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11536to be used.
11537
11538Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11539under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11540wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11541the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11542(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
11543
11544@kindex add-symbol-file
11545@cindex dynamic linking
11546@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11547@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11548@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11549The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11550information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11551when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11552into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11553address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11554this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11555of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11556section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11557@var{address} as an expression.
11558
11559The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11560originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11561@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11562thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11563instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11564
11565@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11566@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11567@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11568@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11569@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11570Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11571executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11572relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11573information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11574
11575@itemize @bullet
11576@item
11577the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11578that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11579@item
11580every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11581been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11582@item
11583you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11584provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11585@end itemize
11586
11587@noindent
11588Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11589relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11590typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11591important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11592procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11593assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11594general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11595relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11596as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11597way.
11598
11599@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11600
11601@kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11602@cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11603@cindex load symbols from memory
11604@item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11605Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11606object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11607For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11608process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11609some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11610evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11611For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11612@code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11613
11614@kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11615@kindex assf
11616@item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11617@itemx assf @var{library-file}
11618The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11619in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11620alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11621@value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11622@value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11623@code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11624library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11625@code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11626
11627@kindex section
11628@item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11629The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11630@var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11631exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11632@code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11633itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11634@code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11635their addresses.
11636
11637@kindex info files
11638@kindex info target
11639@item info files
11640@itemx info target
11641@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11642current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11643including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11644use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11645command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11646current ones.
11647
11648@kindex maint info sections
11649@item maint info sections
11650Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11651is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11652displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11653offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11654@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11655may be arbitrarily combined):
11656
11657@table @code
11658@item ALLOBJ
11659Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11660@item @var{sections}
11661Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11662@item @var{section-flags}
11663Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11664The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11665@table @code
11666@item ALLOC
11667Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11668Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11669@item LOAD
11670Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11671Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11672@item RELOC
11673Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11674@item READONLY
11675Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11676@item CODE
11677Section contains executable code only.
11678@item DATA
11679Section contains data only (no executable code).
11680@item ROM
11681Section will reside in ROM.
11682@item CONSTRUCTOR
11683Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11684@item HAS_CONTENTS
11685Section is not empty.
11686@item NEVER_LOAD
11687An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11688@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11689A notification to the linker that the section contains
11690COFF shared library information.
11691@item IS_COMMON
11692Section contains common symbols.
11693@end table
11694@end table
11695@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11696@cindex read-only sections
11697@item set trust-readonly-sections on
11698Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11699really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11700In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11701out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11702For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11703enhancement to debugging performance.
11704
11705The default is off.
11706
11707@item set trust-readonly-sections off
11708Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11709the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11710and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11711
11712@item show trust-readonly-sections
11713Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11714@end table
11715
11716All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11717as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11718name and remembers it that way.
11719
11720@cindex shared libraries
11721@value{GDBN} supports GNU/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11722and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11723
11724@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11725when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11726(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11727references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11728debugging a core file).
11729
11730On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11731automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11732
11733@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11734@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11735@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11736
11737There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11738symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11739particularly large or there are many of them.
11740
11741To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11742commands:
11743
11744@table @code
11745@kindex set auto-solib-add
11746@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11747If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11748will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11749attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11750informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11751is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11752@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11753
11754@cindex memory used for symbol tables
11755If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11756takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11757memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11758symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11759auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11760library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11761@var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
11762the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11763
11764@kindex show auto-solib-add
11765@item show auto-solib-add
11766Display the current autoloading mode.
11767@end table
11768
11769@cindex load shared library
11770To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11771command:
11772
11773@table @code
11774@kindex info sharedlibrary
11775@kindex info share
11776@item info share
11777@itemx info sharedlibrary
11778Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11779
11780@kindex sharedlibrary
11781@kindex share
11782@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11783@itemx share @var{regex}
11784Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11785Unix regular expression.
11786As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11787required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11788@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11789loaded.
11790
11791@item nosharedlibrary
11792@kindex nosharedlibrary
11793@cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11794Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11795that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11796libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11797discarded.
11798@end table
11799
11800Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11801when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11802stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11803
11804@table @code
11805@item set stop-on-solib-events
11806@kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11807This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11808when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11809The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11810shared library.
11811
11812@item show stop-on-solib-events
11813@kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11814Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11815library events happen.
11816@end table
11817
11818Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11819configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11820host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11821copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11822not.
11823
11824@cindex where to look for shared libraries
11825For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11826libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11827may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11828to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11829
11830@table @code
11831@cindex prefix for shared library file names
11832@cindex system root, alternate
11833@kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11834@kindex set sysroot
11835@item set sysroot @var{path}
11836Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
11837absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
11838runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
11839target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
11840libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
11841the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
11842under @var{path}.
11843
11844The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
11845sysroot}.
11846
11847@cindex default system root
11848@cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
11849You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
11850@samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
11851@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
11852@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
11853automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
11854location.
11855
11856@kindex show sysroot
11857@item show sysroot
11858Display the current shared library prefix.
11859
11860@kindex set solib-search-path
11861@item set solib-search-path @var{path}
11862If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
11863directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
11864is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
11865path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
11866use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
11867@samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
11868finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
11869it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
11870of shared library symbols.
11871
11872@kindex show solib-search-path
11873@item show solib-search-path
11874Display the current shared library search path.
11875@end table
11876
11877
11878@node Separate Debug Files
11879@section Debugging Information in Separate Files
11880@cindex separate debugging information files
11881@cindex debugging information in separate files
11882@cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
11883@cindex debugging information directory, global
11884@cindex global debugging information directory
11885
11886@value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
11887file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
11888@value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
11889Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
11890than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
11891information for their executables in separate files, which users can
11892install only when they need to debug a problem.
11893
11894If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
11895separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
11896the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
11897components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
11898debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
11899containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
11900debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
11901will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
11902places:
11903
11904@itemize @bullet
11905@item
11906the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
11907for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
11908@item
11909a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
11910file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
11911@item
11912a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
11913executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
11914@file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
11915@var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
11916@var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
11917@end itemize
11918@noindent
11919@value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
11920information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
11921reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
11922
11923So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
11924which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
11925debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
11926for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
11927@file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
11928@file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
11929
11930You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
11931name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
11932
11933@table @code
11934
11935@kindex set debug-file-directory
11936@item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
11937Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11938information files to @var{directory}.
11939
11940@kindex show debug-file-directory
11941@item show debug-file-directory
11942Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11943information files.
11944
11945@end table
11946
11947@cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
11948@cindex debug links
11949A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
11950@code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
11951
11952@itemize
11953@item
11954A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
11955a zero byte,
11956@item
11957zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
11958boundary within the section, and
11959@item
11960a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
11961executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
11962information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
11963zero as the @var{crc} argument.
11964@end itemize
11965
11966Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
11967contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
11968described above.
11969
11970The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
11971executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
11972debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
11973should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
11974but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
11975in an ordinary executable.
11976
11977As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
11978separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
11979Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
11980contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
11981@kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
11982the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
11983@file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
11984
11985Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
11986polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
11987describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
11988complete code for a function that computes it:
11989
11990@kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
11991@smallexample
11992unsigned long
11993gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
11994 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
11995@{
11996 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
11997 @{
11998 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
11999 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
12000 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
12001 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
12002 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
12003 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
12004 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
12005 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
12006 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
12007 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
12008 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
12009 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
12010 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
12011 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
12012 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
12013 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
12014 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
12015 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
12016 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
12017 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
12018 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
12019 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
12020 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
12021 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
12022 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
12023 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
12024 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
12025 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
12026 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
12027 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
12028 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
12029 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
12030 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
12031 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
12032 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
12033 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
12034 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
12035 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
12036 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
12037 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
12038 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12039 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12040 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12041 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12042 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12043 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12044 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12045 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12046 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12047 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12048 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12049 0x2d02ef8d
12050 @};
12051 unsigned char *end;
12052
12053 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12054 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12055 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12056 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12057@}
12058@end smallexample
12059
12060
12061@node Symbol Errors
12062@section Errors Reading Symbol Files
12063
12064While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12065such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12066output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12067they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12068debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12069about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12070only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12071times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12072to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12073complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12074Messages}).
12075
12076The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12077
12078@table @code
12079@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12080
12081The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12082(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12083error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12084in its outer scope blocks.
12085
12086@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12087the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12088may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12089function.
12090
12091@item block at @var{address} out of order
12092
12093The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12094order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12095do so.
12096
12097@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12098locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12099can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12100@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
12101Messages}.)
12102
12103@item bad block start address patched
12104
12105The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12106smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12107to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12108
12109@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12110starting on the previous source line.
12111
12112@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12113
12114@cindex foo
12115Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12116larger than the size of the string table.
12117
12118@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12119name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12120with this name.
12121
12122@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12123
12124The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12125not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12126uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12127
12128@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12129This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12130are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12131debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12132on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12133and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12134
12135@item stub type has NULL name
12136
12137@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12138
12139@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12140The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12141information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12142it.
12143
12144@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12145
12146@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12147
12148@end table
12149
12150@node Targets
12151@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12152
12153@cindex debugging target
12154A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12155
12156Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12157in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12158you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12159flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12160host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12161realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12162command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12163(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
12164
12165@cindex target architecture
12166It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12167architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12168one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12169command.
12170
12171@table @code
12172@kindex set architecture
12173@kindex show architecture
12174@item set architecture @var{arch}
12175This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12176value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12177supported architectures.
12178
12179@item show architecture
12180Show the current target architecture.
12181
12182@item set processor
12183@itemx processor
12184@kindex set processor
12185@kindex show processor
12186These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12187and @code{show architecture}.
12188@end table
12189
12190@menu
12191* Active Targets:: Active targets
12192* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12193* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12194@end menu
12195
12196@node Active Targets
12197@section Active Targets
12198
12199@cindex stacking targets
12200@cindex active targets
12201@cindex multiple targets
12202
12203There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12204executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12205active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12206start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12207a core file.
12208
12209For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12210@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12211well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12212@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12213first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12214requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12215are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12216read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12217executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12218
12219When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12220target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12221commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12222an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12223process target is active.
12224
12225Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12226core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
12227Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12228the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
12229Process}).
12230
12231@node Target Commands
12232@section Commands for Managing Targets
12233
12234@table @code
12235@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12236Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12237process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12238facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12239protocol of the target machine.
12240
12241Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12242typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12243with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12244
12245The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12246after executing the command.
12247
12248@kindex help target
12249@item help target
12250Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12251currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12252(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
12253
12254@item help target @var{name}
12255Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12256select it.
12257
12258@kindex set gnutarget
12259@item set gnutarget @var{args}
12260@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12261knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12262a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12263with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12264with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12265
12266@quotation
12267@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12268you must know the actual BFD name.
12269@end quotation
12270
12271@noindent
12272@xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
12273
12274@kindex show gnutarget
12275@item show gnutarget
12276Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12277@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12278@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12279and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12280@end table
12281
12282@cindex common targets
12283Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12284configuration):
12285
12286@table @code
12287@kindex target
12288@item target exec @var{program}
12289@cindex executable file target
12290An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12291@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12292
12293@item target core @var{filename}
12294@cindex core dump file target
12295A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12296@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12297
12298@item target remote @var{medium}
12299@cindex remote target
12300A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12301connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12302protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12303
12304For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12305machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12306
12307@smallexample
12308target remote /dev/ttya
12309@end smallexample
12310
12311@code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12312useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12313system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12314clobbered by the download.
12315
12316@item target sim
12317@cindex built-in simulator target
12318Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12319In general,
12320@smallexample
12321 target sim
12322 load
12323 run
12324@end smallexample
12325@noindent
12326works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12327drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12328provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12329see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12330Processors}.
12331
12332@end table
12333
12334Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12335
12336@table @code
12337
12338@item target nrom @var{dev}
12339@cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12340NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12341
12342@end table
12343
12344Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12345your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12346
12347Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12348you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12349various aspects of this process.
12350
12351@table @code
12352
12353@item set hash
12354@kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12355@cindex hash mark while downloading
12356This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12357downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12358displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12359monitor.
12360
12361@item show hash
12362@kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12363Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12364
12365@item set debug monitor
12366@kindex set debug monitor
12367@cindex display remote monitor communications
12368Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12369@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12370
12371@item show debug monitor
12372@kindex show debug monitor
12373Show the current status of displaying communications between
12374@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12375@end table
12376
12377@table @code
12378
12379@kindex load @var{filename}
12380@item load @var{filename}
12381Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12382@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12383is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12384on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12385@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12386the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12387
12388If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12389execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12390target is @dots{}}''
12391
12392The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12393For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12394link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12395specifies a fixed address.
12396@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12397
12398Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12399load programs into flash memory.
12400
12401@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12402@end table
12403
12404@node Byte Order
12405@section Choosing Target Byte Order
12406
12407@cindex choosing target byte order
12408@cindex target byte order
12409
12410Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12411offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12412orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12413designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12414which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12415@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12416
12417@table @code
12418@kindex set endian
12419@item set endian big
12420Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12421
12422@item set endian little
12423Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12424
12425@item set endian auto
12426Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12427executable.
12428
12429@item show endian
12430Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12431
12432@end table
12433
12434Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12435data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12436target system.
12437
12438
12439@node Remote Debugging
12440@chapter Debugging Remote Programs
12441@cindex remote debugging
12442
12443If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12444@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12445For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12446or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12447powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12448
12449Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12450to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12451@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12452but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12453write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12454communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12455
12456Other remote targets may be available in your
12457configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12458
12459@menu
12460* Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12461* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12462* Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
12463* Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12464@end menu
12465
12466@node Connecting
12467@section Connecting to a Remote Target
12468
12469On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12470your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
12471Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12472program as the first argument.
12473
12474@cindex @code{target remote}
12475@value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12476over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12477each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12478program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12479@code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12480Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12481
12482@table @code
12483
12484@item target remote @var{serial-device}
12485@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12486Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12487to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12488
12489@smallexample
12490target remote /dev/ttyb
12491@end smallexample
12492
12493If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12494@w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12495(@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12496@code{target} command.
12497
12498@item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12499@itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12500@cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12501Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12502The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12503address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12504the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12505it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12506target.
12507
12508For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12509@code{manyfarms}:
12510
12511@smallexample
12512target remote manyfarms:2828
12513@end smallexample
12514
12515If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12516debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12517same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12518port 1234 on your local machine:
12519
12520@smallexample
12521target remote :1234
12522@end smallexample
12523@noindent
12524
12525Note that the colon is still required here.
12526
12527@item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12528@cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12529Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12530connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12531
12532@smallexample
12533target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12534@end smallexample
12535
12536When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12537keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12538can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12539cause havoc with your debugging session.
12540
12541@item target remote | @var{command}
12542@cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12543Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12544pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12545by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12546protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12547standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12548that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12549using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12550
12551If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12552@value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12553program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12554
12555@end table
12556
12557Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12558commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12559remote program.
12560
12561@cindex interrupting remote programs
12562@cindex remote programs, interrupting
12563Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12564interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12565program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12566and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12567interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12568
12569@smallexample
12570Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12571Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12572@end smallexample
12573
12574If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12575(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12576remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12577goes back to waiting.
12578
12579@table @code
12580@kindex detach (remote)
12581@item detach
12582When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12583@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12584Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12585will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12586command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12587
12588@kindex disconnect
12589@item disconnect
12590The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12591the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12592(this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12593the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12594another target.
12595
12596@cindex send command to remote monitor
12597@cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12598@cindex add new commands for external monitor
12599@kindex monitor
12600@item monitor @var{cmd}
12601This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12602remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12603sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12604can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12605and implement.
12606@end table
12607
12608@node Server
12609@section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
12610
12611@kindex gdbserver
12612@cindex remote connection without stubs
12613@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12614allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12615@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12616
12617@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12618because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12619that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12620@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12621@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12622because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12623also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12624started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12625Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12626the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12627do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12628by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12629choice for debugging.
12630
12631@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12632or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12633protocol.
12634
12635@table @emph
12636@item On the target machine,
12637you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12638@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12639strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12640system does all the symbol handling.
12641
12642To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12643the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12644syntax is:
12645
12646@smallexample
12647target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12648@end smallexample
12649
12650@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12651hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12652@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12653@file{/dev/com1}:
12654
12655@smallexample
12656target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12657@end smallexample
12658
12659@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12660with it.
12661
12662To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12663
12664@smallexample
12665target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12666@end smallexample
12667
12668The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12669specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12670TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12671expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12672(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12673you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12674TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12675reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12676conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12677and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12678@code{target remote} command.
12679
12680On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12681This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12682
12683@smallexample
12684target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12685@end smallexample
12686
12687@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
12688to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
12689
12690@pindex pidof
12691@cindex attach to a program by name
12692You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
12693@code{pidof} utility:
12694
12695@smallexample
12696target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{program}`
12697@end smallexample
12698
12699In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
12700has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12701@code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12702
12703@item On the host machine,
12704first make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
12705your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
12706@code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
12707was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-system-root}).
12708
12709The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
12710and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
12711system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
12712are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
12713during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
12714files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
12715programs.
12716
12717Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
12718For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12719the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12720text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12721@samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12722command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12723already on the target.
12724
12725@end table
12726
12727@subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
12728@cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
12729
12730During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
12731@code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
12732Here are the available commands; they are only of interest when
12733debugging @value{GDBN} or @code{gdbserver}.
12734
12735@table @code
12736@item monitor help
12737List the available monitor commands.
12738
12739@item monitor set debug 0
12740@itemx monitor set debug 1
12741Disable or enable general debugging messages.
12742
12743@item monitor set remote-debug 0
12744@itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
12745Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
12746protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
12747
12748@end table
12749
12750@node Remote Configuration
12751@section Remote Configuration
12752
12753@kindex set remote
12754@kindex show remote
12755This section documents the configuration options available when
12756debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
12757extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
12758system-call-allowed}.
12759
12760@table @code
12761@item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
12762@cindex address size for remote targets
12763@cindex bits in remote address
12764Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
12765number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
12766that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
12767default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
12768
12769@item show remoteaddresssize
12770Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
12771
12772@item set remotebaud @var{n}
12773@cindex baud rate for remote targets
12774Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
12775value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
12776remote targets.
12777
12778@item show remotebaud
12779Show the current speed of the remote connection.
12780
12781@item set remotebreak
12782@cindex interrupt remote programs
12783@cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
12784@anchor{set remotebreak}
12785If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
12786when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
12787on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
12788character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
12789expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
12790
12791@item show remotebreak
12792Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
12793interrupt the remote program.
12794
12795@item set remotelogbase @var{base}
12796Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
12797communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
12798@code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
12799@code{ascii}.
12800
12801@item show remotelogbase
12802Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
12803protocol.
12804
12805@item set remotelogfile @var{file}
12806@cindex record serial communications on file
12807Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
12808default is not to record at all.
12809
12810@item show remotelogfile.
12811Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
12812serial communications.
12813
12814@item set remotetimeout @var{num}
12815@cindex timeout for serial communications
12816@cindex remote timeout
12817Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
12818@var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
12819
12820@item show remotetimeout
12821Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
12822responses.
12823
12824@cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12825@cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
12826@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
12827@anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
12828@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
12829@itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
12830Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
12831watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
12832@end table
12833
12834@cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
12835The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
12836your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
12837can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
12838packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
12839packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
12840or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
12841all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
12842see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
12843
12844During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
12845If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
12846in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
12847@value{GDBN} developers.
12848
12849The available settings are:
12850
12851@multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.2 0.35
12852@item Command Name
12853@tab Remote Packet
12854@tab Related Features
12855
12856@item @code{fetch-register-packet}
12857@tab @code{p}
12858@tab @code{info registers}
12859
12860@item @code{set-register-packet}
12861@tab @code{P}
12862@tab @code{set}
12863
12864@item @code{binary-download-packet}
12865@tab @code{X}
12866@tab @code{load}, @code{set}
12867
12868@item @code{read-aux-vector-packet}
12869@tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
12870@tab @code{info auxv}
12871
12872@item @code{symbol-lookup-packet}
12873@tab @code{qSymbol}
12874@tab Detecting multiple threads
12875
12876@item @code{verbose-resume-packet}
12877@tab @code{vCont}
12878@tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
12879
12880@item @code{software-breakpoint-packet}
12881@tab @code{Z0}
12882@tab @code{break}
12883
12884@item @code{hardware-breakpoint-packet}
12885@tab @code{Z1}
12886@tab @code{hbreak}
12887
12888@item @code{write-watchpoint-packet}
12889@tab @code{Z2}
12890@tab @code{watch}
12891
12892@item @code{read-watchpoint-packet}
12893@tab @code{Z3}
12894@tab @code{rwatch}
12895
12896@item @code{access-watchpoint-packet}
12897@tab @code{Z4}
12898@tab @code{awatch}
12899
12900@item @code{get-thread-local-storage-address-packet}
12901@tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
12902@tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
12903
12904@item @code{supported-packets}
12905@tab @code{qSupported}
12906@tab Remote communications parameters
12907
12908@item @code{pass-signals-packet}
12909@tab @code{QPassSignals}
12910@tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
12911
12912@end multitable
12913
12914@node Remote Stub
12915@section Implementing a Remote Stub
12916
12917@cindex debugging stub, example
12918@cindex remote stub, example
12919@cindex stub example, remote debugging
12920The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
12921communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
12922@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
12923these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
12924implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
12925with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
12926organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
12927
12928@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
12929To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
12930@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
12931prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
12932program, you need:
12933
12934@enumerate
12935@item
12936A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
12937have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
12938your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
12939
12940@item
12941A C subroutine library to support your program's
12942subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
12943
12944@item
12945A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
12946download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
12947manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
12948documentation.
12949@end enumerate
12950
12951The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
12952communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
12953machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
12954
12955@table @emph
12956@item On the host,
12957@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
12958else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
12959(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
12960
12961@item On the target,
12962you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
12963implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
12964subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
12965
12966On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
12967@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
12968@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
12969@end table
12970
12971The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
12972machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
12973@sc{sparc} boards.
12974
12975@cindex remote serial stub list
12976These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
12977
12978@table @code
12979
12980@item i386-stub.c
12981@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
12982@cindex Intel
12983@cindex i386
12984For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
12985
12986@item m68k-stub.c
12987@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
12988@cindex Motorola 680x0
12989@cindex m680x0
12990For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
12991
12992@item sh-stub.c
12993@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
12994@cindex Renesas
12995@cindex SH
12996For Renesas SH architectures.
12997
12998@item sparc-stub.c
12999@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
13000@cindex Sparc
13001For @sc{sparc} architectures.
13002
13003@item sparcl-stub.c
13004@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
13005@cindex Fujitsu
13006@cindex SparcLite
13007For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
13008
13009@end table
13010
13011The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
13012recently added stubs.
13013
13014@menu
13015* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
13016* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
13017* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
13018@end menu
13019
13020@node Stub Contents
13021@subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
13022
13023@cindex remote serial stub
13024The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
13025subroutines:
13026
13027@table @code
13028@item set_debug_traps
13029@findex set_debug_traps
13030@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
13031This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
13032program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
13033beginning of your program.
13034
13035@item handle_exception
13036@findex handle_exception
13037@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
13038This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
13039explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
13040run when a trap is triggered.
13041
13042@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13043execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13044with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13045protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13046representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13047information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13048retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13049execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13050@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13051machine.
13052
13053@item breakpoint
13054@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13055Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13056breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13057way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13058machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13059pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13060@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13061simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13062again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13063your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13064@value{GDBN} session gets control.
13065
13066Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13067to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13068start of your debugging session.
13069@end table
13070
13071@node Bootstrapping
13072@subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
13073
13074@cindex remote stub, support routines
13075The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13076chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13077debugging target machine.
13078
13079First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13080serial port.
13081
13082@table @code
13083@item int getDebugChar()
13084@findex getDebugChar
13085Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13086It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13087different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13088
13089@item void putDebugChar(int)
13090@findex putDebugChar
13091Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13092It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13093different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13094@end table
13095
13096@cindex control C, and remote debugging
13097@cindex interrupting remote targets
13098If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13099running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13100for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13101character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13102remote system to stop.
13103
13104Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13105probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13106is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13107@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13108
13109Other routines you need to supply are:
13110
13111@table @code
13112@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13113@findex exceptionHandler
13114Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13115handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13116way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13117are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13118containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13119@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13120its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13121might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13122exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13123@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13124and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13125you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13126should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13127
13128For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13129gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13130should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13131@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13132help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13133
13134@item void flush_i_cache()
13135@findex flush_i_cache
13136On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13137instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13138instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13139
13140On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13141function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13142@end table
13143
13144@noindent
13145You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13146
13147@table @code
13148@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13149@findex memset
13150This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13151memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13152@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13153either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13154@end table
13155
13156If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13157library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13158but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13159subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
13160
13161
13162@node Debug Session
13163@subsection Putting it All Together
13164
13165@cindex remote serial debugging summary
13166In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13167steps.
13168
13169@enumerate
13170@item
13171Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13172(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
13173@display
13174@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13175@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13176@end display
13177
13178@item
13179Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13180
13181@smallexample
13182set_debug_traps();
13183breakpoint();
13184@end smallexample
13185
13186@item
13187For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13188@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13189
13190@smallexample
13191void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13192@end smallexample
13193
13194@noindent
13195but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13196function in your program, that function is called when
13197@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13198error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13199one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13200
13201@item
13202Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13203your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13204
13205@item
13206Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13207the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13208
13209@item
13210@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13211@c document that. FIXME.
13212Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13213whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13214
13215@item
13216Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13217(@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
13218
13219@end enumerate
13220
13221@node Configurations
13222@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13223
13224While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13225cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13226describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13227
13228There are three major categories of configurations: native
13229configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13230operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13231different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13232are quite different from each other.
13233
13234@menu
13235* Native::
13236* Embedded OS::
13237* Embedded Processors::
13238* Architectures::
13239@end menu
13240
13241@node Native
13242@section Native
13243
13244This section describes details specific to particular native
13245configurations.
13246
13247@menu
13248* HP-UX:: HP-UX
13249* BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13250* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13251* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13252* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13253* Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13254* Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13255@end menu
13256
13257@node HP-UX
13258@subsection HP-UX
13259
13260On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13261begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13262name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13263
13264
13265@node BSD libkvm Interface
13266@subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13267
13268@cindex libkvm
13269@cindex kernel memory image
13270@cindex kernel crash dump
13271
13272BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13273interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13274memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13275uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13276dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13277special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13278the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13279@code{kvm} target:
13280
13281@smallexample
13282(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13283@end smallexample
13284
13285For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13286argument:
13287
13288@smallexample
13289(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13290@end smallexample
13291
13292Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13293available:
13294
13295@table @code
13296@kindex kvm
13297@item kvm pcb
13298Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13299
13300@item kvm proc
13301Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13302modern FreeBSD systems.
13303@end table
13304
13305@node SVR4 Process Information
13306@subsection SVR4 Process Information
13307@cindex /proc
13308@cindex examine process image
13309@cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13310
13311Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13312@samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13313process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13314for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13315proc} is available to report information about the process running
13316your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13317proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13318This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13319Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13320
13321@table @code
13322@kindex info proc
13323@cindex process ID
13324@item info proc
13325@itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13326Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13327process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13328that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13329debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13330line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13331executable file's absolute file name.
13332
13333On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13334@samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13335within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13336a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13337needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13338a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13339
13340@item info proc mappings
13341@cindex memory address space mappings
13342Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13343information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13344rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13345includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13346memory access rights to that range.
13347
13348@item info proc stat
13349@itemx info proc status
13350@cindex process detailed status information
13351These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13352the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13353how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13354the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13355consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13356value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13357(type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13358
13359@item info proc all
13360Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13361above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13362
13363@ignore
13364@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13365@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13366@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13367@kindex info proc times
13368@item info proc times
13369Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13370its children.
13371
13372@kindex info proc id
13373@item info proc id
13374Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13375the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13376@end ignore
13377
13378@item set procfs-trace
13379@kindex set procfs-trace
13380@cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13381This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13382
13383@item show procfs-trace
13384@kindex show procfs-trace
13385Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13386
13387@item set procfs-file @var{file}
13388@kindex set procfs-file
13389Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13390@var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13391contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13392standard output.
13393
13394@item show procfs-file
13395@kindex show procfs-file
13396Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13397
13398@item proc-trace-entry
13399@itemx proc-trace-exit
13400@itemx proc-untrace-entry
13401@itemx proc-untrace-exit
13402@kindex proc-trace-entry
13403@kindex proc-trace-exit
13404@kindex proc-untrace-entry
13405@kindex proc-untrace-exit
13406These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13407from the @code{syscall} interface.
13408
13409@item info pidlist
13410@kindex info pidlist
13411@cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13412For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13413processes and all the threads within each process.
13414
13415@item info meminfo
13416@kindex info meminfo
13417@cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13418For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13419@end table
13420
13421@node DJGPP Native
13422@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13423@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13424@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13425@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13426
13427@cindex DPMI
13428@sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13429MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13430that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13431top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13432
13433@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13434defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13435subsection describes those commands.
13436
13437@table @code
13438@kindex info dos
13439@item info dos
13440This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13441information about the target system and important OS structures.
13442
13443@kindex sysinfo
13444@cindex MS-DOS system info
13445@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13446@item info dos sysinfo
13447This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13448platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13449DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13450
13451@cindex GDT
13452@cindex LDT
13453@cindex IDT
13454@cindex segment descriptor tables
13455@cindex descriptor tables display
13456@item info dos gdt
13457@itemx info dos ldt
13458@itemx info dos idt
13459These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13460and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13461tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13462that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13463descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13464descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13465rights.
13466
13467A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13468segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13469allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13470conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13471additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13472
13473@cindex garbled pointers
13474These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13475Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13476displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13477display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13478example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13479debugged program's data segment:
13480
13481@smallexample
13482@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13483@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13484@end smallexample
13485
13486@noindent
13487This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13488the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13489
13490@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13491@item info dos pde
13492@itemx info dos pte
13493These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13494Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13495data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13496into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13497page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13498may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13499Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13500that is currently in use.
13501
13502Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13503Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13504the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13505@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13506Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13507means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13508the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13509
13510@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13511These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13512Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13513controller.
13514
13515These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13516
13517@cindex physical address from linear address
13518@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13519This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13520address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13521already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13522because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13523segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13524the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13525
13526@smallexample
13527@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13528@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13529@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13530@end smallexample
13531
13532@noindent
13533This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13534whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13535attributes of that page.
13536
13537Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13538since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13539address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13540be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13541declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13542@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13543
13544Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13545transfer buffer:
13546
13547@smallexample
13548@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13549@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13550@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13551@end smallexample
13552
13553@noindent
13554(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
135553rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13556clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13557memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13558linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13559
13560This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13561@end table
13562
13563@cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13564In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13565debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13566to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13567
13568@table @code
13569@kindex set com1base
13570@kindex set com1irq
13571@kindex set com2base
13572@kindex set com2irq
13573@kindex set com3base
13574@kindex set com3irq
13575@kindex set com4base
13576@kindex set com4irq
13577@item set com1base @var{addr}
13578This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13579port.
13580
13581@item set com1irq @var{irq}
13582This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13583for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13584
13585There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13586etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13587other 3 COM ports.
13588
13589@kindex show com1base
13590@kindex show com1irq
13591@kindex show com2base
13592@kindex show com2irq
13593@kindex show com3base
13594@kindex show com3irq
13595@kindex show com4base
13596@kindex show com4irq
13597The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13598display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13599lines used by the COM ports.
13600
13601@item info serial
13602@kindex info serial
13603@cindex DOS serial port status
13604This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13605port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13606IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13607counts of various errors encountered so far.
13608@end table
13609
13610
13611@node Cygwin Native
13612@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
13613@cindex MS Windows debugging
13614@cindex native Cygwin debugging
13615@cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13616
13617@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13618DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13619additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
13620Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
13621@ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
13622
13623@table @code
13624@kindex info w32
13625@item info w32
13626This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
13627information about the target system and important OS structures.
13628
13629@item info w32 selector
13630This command displays information returned by
13631the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13632It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13633a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13634Without argument, this command displays information
13635about the six segment registers.
13636
13637@kindex info dll
13638@item info dll
13639This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
13640
13641@kindex dll-symbols
13642@item dll-symbols
13643This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13644add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13645
13646@kindex set cygwin-exceptions
13647@cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
13648@cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
13649@item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
13650If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
13651happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
13652@value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
13653exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
13654``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
13655Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
13656@value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
13657
13658@kindex show cygwin-exceptions
13659@item show cygwin-exceptions
13660Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
13661inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
13662
13663@kindex set new-console
13664@item set new-console @var{mode}
13665If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13666be started in a new console on next start.
13667If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13668be started in the same console as the debugger.
13669
13670@kindex show new-console
13671@item show new-console
13672Displays whether a new console is used
13673when the debuggee is started.
13674
13675@kindex set new-group
13676@item set new-group @var{mode}
13677This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
13678start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
13679This affects the way the Windows OS handles
13680@samp{Ctrl-C}.
13681
13682@kindex show new-group
13683@item show new-group
13684Displays current value of new-group boolean.
13685
13686@kindex set debugevents
13687@item set debugevents
13688This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
13689to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
13690signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
13691unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
13692Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
13693
13694@kindex set debugexec
13695@item set debugexec
13696This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
13697(such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
13698
13699@kindex set debugexceptions
13700@item set debugexceptions
13701This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
13702debuggee seen by the debugger.
13703
13704@kindex set debugmemory
13705@item set debugmemory
13706This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
13707and writes by the debugger.
13708
13709@kindex set shell
13710@item set shell
13711This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
13712via a shell or directly (default value is on).
13713
13714@kindex show shell
13715@item show shell
13716Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
13717
13718@end table
13719
13720@menu
13721* Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13722@end menu
13723
13724@node Non-debug DLL Symbols
13725@subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
13726@cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
13727@cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
13728
13729Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
13730not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
13731@file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
13732symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
13733information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
13734describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
13735``minimal symbols''.
13736
13737Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
13738will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
13739start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
13740program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
13741@value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
13742see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
13743@code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
13744explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
13745cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
13746which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
13747
13748@subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
13749
13750In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
13751tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
13752DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
13753also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
13754sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
13755(particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
13756necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
13757contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
13758exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
13759
13760Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
13761though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
13762symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
13763some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
13764@code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
13765(@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
13766
13767@smallexample
13768(@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
13769All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
13770
13771Non-debugging symbols:
137720x77e885f4 CreateFileA
137730x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
13774@end smallexample
13775
13776@smallexample
13777(@value{GDBP}) info function !
13778All functions matching regular expression "!":
13779
13780Non-debugging symbols:
137810x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
137820x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
137830x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
13784[etc...]
13785@end smallexample
13786
13787@subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
13788
13789Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
13790type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
13791refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
13792contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
13793contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
13794means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
13795a function within a DLL without a running program.
13796
13797Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
13798automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
13799variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
13800type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
13801problem:
13802
13803@smallexample
13804(@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
13805$1 = 268572168
13806@end smallexample
13807
13808@smallexample
13809(@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
138100x10021610: "\230y\""
13811@end smallexample
13812
13813And two possible solutions:
13814
13815@smallexample
13816(@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
13817$2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13818@end smallexample
13819
13820@smallexample
13821(@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
138220x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
13823(@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
138240x10021608: 0x0022fd98
13825(@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
138260x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13827@end smallexample
13828
13829Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
13830starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
13831examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
13832function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
13833to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
13834
13835@smallexample
13836(@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
13837Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
13838@end smallexample
13839
13840The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
13841break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
13842safe.
13843
13844@node Hurd Native
13845@subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
13846@cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
13847
13848This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
13849@sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
13850
13851@table @code
13852@item set signals
13853@itemx set sigs
13854@kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
13855@kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13856This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
13857@value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
13858affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
13859@code{signals}.
13860
13861@item show signals
13862@itemx show sigs
13863@kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
13864@kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13865Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
13866
13867@item set signal-thread
13868@itemx set sigthread
13869@kindex set signal-thread
13870@kindex set sigthread
13871This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
13872thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
13873process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
13874signal-thread}.
13875
13876@item show signal-thread
13877@itemx show sigthread
13878@kindex show signal-thread
13879@kindex show sigthread
13880These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
13881delivered a signal.
13882
13883@item set stopped
13884@kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13885This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
13886as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
13887continued by delivering a signal to it.
13888
13889@item show stopped
13890@kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13891This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
13892stopped.
13893
13894@item set exceptions
13895@kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13896Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
13897When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
13898single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
13899trapping on.
13900
13901@item show exceptions
13902@kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13903Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
13904
13905@item set task pause
13906@kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
13907@cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13908@cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13909This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
13910Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
13911whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
13912effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
13913to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
13914thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
13915
13916@item show task pause
13917@kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
13918Show the current state of task suspension.
13919
13920@item set task detach-suspend-count
13921@cindex task suspend count
13922@cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13923This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
13924@value{GDBN} detaches from it.
13925
13926@item show task detach-suspend-count
13927Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
13928
13929@item set task exception-port
13930@itemx set task excp
13931@cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13932This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
13933forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
13934rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
13935
13936@item set noninvasive
13937@cindex noninvasive task options
13938This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
13939invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
13940is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
13941@code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
13942
13943@item info send-rights
13944@itemx info receive-rights
13945@itemx info port-rights
13946@itemx info port-sets
13947@itemx info dead-names
13948@itemx info ports
13949@itemx info psets
13950@cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13951@cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13952@cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13953@cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13954@cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13955These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
13956receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
13957There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
13958port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
13959
13960@item set thread pause
13961@kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
13962@cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13963@cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13964This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
13965control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
13966thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
13967off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
13968Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
13969control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
13970task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
13971only the current thread.
13972
13973@item show thread pause
13974@kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
13975This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
13976
13977@item set thread run
13978This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13979
13980@item show thread run
13981Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13982
13983@item set thread detach-suspend-count
13984@cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13985@cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13986This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
13987thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
13988found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
13989takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
13990
13991@item show thread detach-suspend-count
13992Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
13993detaching.
13994
13995@item set thread exception-port
13996@itemx set thread excp
13997Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
13998overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
13999@code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
14000
14001@item set thread takeover-suspend-count
14002Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
14003value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
14004changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
14005
14006@item set thread default
14007@itemx show thread default
14008@cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
14009Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
14010default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
14011thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
14012variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
14013threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
14014the non-default commands.
14015@end table
14016
14017
14018@node Neutrino
14019@subsection QNX Neutrino
14020@cindex QNX Neutrino
14021
14022@value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
14023Neutrino target:
14024
14025@table @code
14026@item set debug nto-debug
14027@kindex set debug nto-debug
14028When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
14029Neutrino support.
14030
14031@item show debug nto-debug
14032@kindex show debug nto-debug
14033Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
14034@end table
14035
14036
14037@node Embedded OS
14038@section Embedded Operating Systems
14039
14040This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
14041embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14042architectures.
14043
14044@menu
14045* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14046@end menu
14047
14048@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14049various real-time operating systems.
14050
14051@node VxWorks
14052@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14053
14054@cindex VxWorks
14055
14056@table @code
14057
14058@kindex target vxworks
14059@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14060A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14061is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14062
14063@end table
14064
14065On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14066current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14067
14068@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14069VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14070the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14071both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14072@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14073installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14074@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14075
14076@table @code
14077@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14078@kindex vxworks-timeout
14079All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14080This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14081seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14082your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14083of a thin network line.
14084@end table
14085
14086The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14087this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14088procedures.
14089
14090@findex INCLUDE_RDB
14091To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14092to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14093library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14094VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14095kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14096source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14097information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14098manual.
14099@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14100
14101Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14102your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14103run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14104@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14105
14106@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14107
14108@smallexample
14109(vxgdb)
14110@end smallexample
14111
14112@menu
14113* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14114* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14115* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14116@end menu
14117
14118@node VxWorks Connection
14119@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14120
14121The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14122network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14123
14124@smallexample
14125(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14126@end smallexample
14127
14128@need 750
14129@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14130
14131@smallexample
14132Attaching remote machine across net...
14133Connected to tt.
14134@end smallexample
14135
14136@need 1000
14137@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14138loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14139these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14140path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
14141to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14142
14143@smallexample
14144prog.o: No such file or directory.
14145@end smallexample
14146
14147When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14148the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14149command again.
14150
14151@node VxWorks Download
14152@subsubsection VxWorks Download
14153
14154@cindex download to VxWorks
14155If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14156object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14157@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14158incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14159command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14160to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14161table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14162the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14163filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14164Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14165to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14166the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14167@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14168and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14169program, type this on VxWorks:
14170
14171@smallexample
14172-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14173@end smallexample
14174
14175@noindent
14176Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14177
14178@smallexample
14179(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14180(vxgdb) load prog.o
14181@end smallexample
14182
14183@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14184
14185@smallexample
14186Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14187@end smallexample
14188
14189You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14190after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14191this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14192auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14193history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14194debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14195table.)
14196
14197@node VxWorks Attach
14198@subsubsection Running Tasks
14199
14200@cindex running VxWorks tasks
14201You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14202follows:
14203
14204@smallexample
14205(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14206@end smallexample
14207
14208@noindent
14209where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14210or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14211the time of attachment.
14212
14213@node Embedded Processors
14214@section Embedded Processors
14215
14216This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14217configurations.
14218
14219@cindex send command to simulator
14220Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14221allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14222
14223@table @code
14224@item sim @var{command}
14225@kindex sim@r{, a command}
14226Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14227documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14228acceptable commands.
14229@end table
14230
14231
14232@menu
14233* ARM:: ARM RDI
14234* M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14235* M68K:: Motorola M68K
14236* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14237* OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14238* PA:: HP PA Embedded
14239* PowerPC:: PowerPC
14240* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14241* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14242* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14243* AVR:: Atmel AVR
14244* CRIS:: CRIS
14245* Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14246@end menu
14247
14248@node ARM
14249@subsection ARM
14250@cindex ARM RDI
14251
14252@table @code
14253@kindex target rdi
14254@item target rdi @var{dev}
14255ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14256use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14257monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14258
14259@kindex target rdp
14260@item target rdp @var{dev}
14261ARM Demon monitor.
14262
14263@end table
14264
14265@value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14266
14267@table @code
14268@item set arm disassembler
14269@kindex set arm
14270This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14271@code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14272
14273@item show arm disassembler
14274@kindex show arm
14275Show the current disassembly style.
14276
14277@item set arm apcs32
14278@cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14279This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14280
14281@item show arm apcs32
14282Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14283
14284@item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14285This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14286argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14287
14288@table @code
14289@item auto
14290Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14291@item softfpa
14292Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14293processors.
14294@item fpa
14295GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14296@item softvfp
14297Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14298@item vfp
14299VFP co-processor.
14300@end table
14301
14302@item show arm fpu
14303Show the current type of the FPU.
14304
14305@item set arm abi
14306This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14307
14308@item show arm abi
14309Show the currently used ABI.
14310
14311@item set debug arm
14312Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14313target support subsystem.
14314
14315@item show debug arm
14316Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14317@end table
14318
14319The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14320using the RDI interface:
14321
14322@table @code
14323@item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14324@kindex rdilogfile
14325@cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14326Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14327With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14328no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14329@file{rdi.log}.
14330
14331@item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14332@kindex rdilogenable
14333Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14334enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14335no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14336ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14337are logged to a file.
14338
14339@item set rdiromatzero
14340@kindex set rdiromatzero
14341@cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14342Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14343vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14344(the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14345effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14346
14347@item show rdiromatzero
14348@kindex show rdiromatzero
14349Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14350
14351@item set rdiheartbeat
14352@kindex set rdiheartbeat
14353@cindex RDI heartbeat
14354Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14355turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14356well as the Angel monitor.
14357
14358@item show rdiheartbeat
14359@kindex show rdiheartbeat
14360Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14361@end table
14362
14363
14364@node M32R/D
14365@subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14366
14367@table @code
14368@kindex target m32r
14369@item target m32r @var{dev}
14370Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14371
14372@kindex target m32rsdi
14373@item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14374Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14375@end table
14376
14377The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14378
14379@table @code
14380@item set download-path @var{path}
14381@kindex set download-path
14382@cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14383Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14384
14385@item show download-path
14386@kindex show download-path
14387Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14388
14389@item set board-address @var{addr}
14390@kindex set board-address
14391@cindex M32-EVA target board address
14392Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14393
14394@item show board-address
14395@kindex show board-address
14396Show the current IP address of the target board.
14397
14398@item set server-address @var{addr}
14399@kindex set server-address
14400@cindex download server address (M32R)
14401Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14402host machine.
14403
14404@item show server-address
14405@kindex show server-address
14406Display the IP address of the download server.
14407
14408@item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14409@kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14410Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14411upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14412executable file is uploaded.
14413
14414@item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14415@kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14416Test the @code{upload} command.
14417@end table
14418
14419The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14420
14421@table @code
14422@item sdireset
14423@kindex sdireset
14424@cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14425This command resets the SDI connection.
14426
14427@item sdistatus
14428@kindex sdistatus
14429This command shows the SDI connection status.
14430
14431@item debug_chaos
14432@kindex debug_chaos
14433@cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14434Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14435
14436@item use_debug_dma
14437@kindex use_debug_dma
14438Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14439
14440@item use_mon_code
14441@kindex use_mon_code
14442Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14443
14444@item use_ib_break
14445@kindex use_ib_break
14446Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14447
14448@item use_dbt_break
14449@kindex use_dbt_break
14450Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14451@end table
14452
14453@node M68K
14454@subsection M68k
14455
14456The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
14457target command for the following ROM monitor.
14458
14459@table @code
14460
14461@kindex target dbug
14462@item target dbug @var{dev}
14463dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14464
14465@end table
14466
14467@node MIPS Embedded
14468@subsection MIPS Embedded
14469
14470@cindex MIPS boards
14471@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14472MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14473you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14474
14475@need 1000
14476Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14477
14478@table @code
14479@item target mips @var{port}
14480@kindex target mips @var{port}
14481To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14482name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14483command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14484the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14485been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14486download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14487
14488For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14489port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14490debugger:
14491
14492@smallexample
14493host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14494@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14495(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14496(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14497(@value{GDBP}) run
14498@end smallexample
14499
14500@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14501On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14502connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14503concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14504@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14505
14506@item target pmon @var{port}
14507@kindex target pmon @var{port}
14508PMON ROM monitor.
14509
14510@item target ddb @var{port}
14511@kindex target ddb @var{port}
14512NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14513
14514@item target lsi @var{port}
14515@kindex target lsi @var{port}
14516LSI variant of PMON.
14517
14518@kindex target r3900
14519@item target r3900 @var{dev}
14520Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14521
14522@kindex target array
14523@item target array @var{dev}
14524Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14525
14526@end table
14527
14528
14529@noindent
14530@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14531
14532@table @code
14533@item set mipsfpu double
14534@itemx set mipsfpu single
14535@itemx set mipsfpu none
14536@itemx set mipsfpu auto
14537@itemx show mipsfpu
14538@kindex set mipsfpu
14539@kindex show mipsfpu
14540@cindex MIPS remote floating point
14541@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14542If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14543coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14544need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14545file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14546functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14547@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14548functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14549with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14550processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14551double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14552@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14553
14554In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14555floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14556and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14557
14558As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14559@samp{show mipsfpu}.
14560
14561@item set timeout @var{seconds}
14562@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14563@itemx show timeout
14564@itemx show retransmit-timeout
14565@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14566@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14567@kindex set timeout
14568@kindex show timeout
14569@kindex set retransmit-timeout
14570@kindex show retransmit-timeout
14571You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14572remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14573default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14574waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14575retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14576You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14577retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14578@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14579
14580The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14581is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14582forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14583to run before stopping.
14584
14585@item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14586@kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14587@cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14588Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14589it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14590characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14591
14592@item show syn-garbage-limit
14593@kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14594Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14595trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14596
14597@item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14598@kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14599@cindex remote monitor prompt
14600Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14601remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14602@table @asis
14603@item pmon target
14604@samp{PMON}
14605@item ddb target
14606@samp{NEC010}
14607@item lsi target
14608@samp{PMON>}
14609@end table
14610
14611@item show monitor-prompt
14612@kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14613Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14614remote monitor.
14615
14616@item set monitor-warnings
14617@kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14618Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14619has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14620display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14621PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14622
14623@item show monitor-warnings
14624@kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14625Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14626
14627@item pmon @var{command}
14628@kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14629@cindex send PMON command
14630This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14631monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14632@end table
14633
14634@node OpenRISC 1000
14635@subsection OpenRISC 1000
14636@cindex OpenRISC 1000
14637
14638@cindex or1k boards
14639See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14640about platform and commands.
14641
14642@table @code
14643
14644@kindex target jtag
14645@item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14646
14647Connects to remote JTAG server.
14648JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14649connected via parallel port to the board.
14650
14651Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14652
14653@kindex or1ksim
14654@item or1ksim @var{command}
14655If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14656Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14657
14658@kindex info or1k spr
14659@item info or1k spr
14660Displays spr groups.
14661
14662@item info or1k spr @var{group}
14663@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
14664Displays register names in selected group.
14665
14666@item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
14667@itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
14668@itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
14669@itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
14670Shows information about specified spr register.
14671
14672@kindex spr
14673@item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
14674@itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
14675@itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
14676@itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
14677Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
14678@end table
14679
14680Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
14681It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
14682program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
14683triggers can be set using:
14684@table @code
14685@item $LEA/$LDATA
14686Load effective address/data
14687@item $SEA/$SDATA
14688Store effective address/data
14689@item $AEA/$ADATA
14690Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
14691@item $FETCH
14692Fetch data
14693@end table
14694
14695When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
14696@code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
14697
14698@code{htrace} commands:
14699@cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
14700@table @code
14701@kindex hwatch
14702@item hwatch @var{conditional}
14703Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
14704or Data. For example:
14705
14706@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14707
14708@code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14709
14710@kindex htrace
14711@item htrace info
14712Display information about current HW trace configuration.
14713
14714@item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
14715Set starting criteria for HW trace.
14716
14717@item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
14718Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
14719
14720@item htrace stop @var{conditional}
14721Set HW trace stopping criteria.
14722
14723@item htrace record [@var{data}]*
14724Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
14725triggered.
14726
14727@item htrace enable
14728@itemx htrace disable
14729Enables/disables the HW trace.
14730
14731@item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
14732Clears currently recorded trace data.
14733
14734If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
14735will be written there.
14736
14737@item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
14738Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
14739
14740@item htrace mode continuous
14741Set continuous trace mode.
14742
14743@item htrace mode suspend
14744Set suspend trace mode.
14745
14746@end table
14747
14748@node PowerPC
14749@subsection PowerPC
14750
14751@table @code
14752@kindex target dink32
14753@item target dink32 @var{dev}
14754DINK32 ROM monitor.
14755
14756@kindex target ppcbug
14757@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
14758@kindex target ppcbug1
14759@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
14760PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
14761
14762@kindex target sds
14763@item target sds @var{dev}
14764SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
14765@end table
14766
14767@cindex SDS protocol
14768The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
14769by@value{GDBN}:
14770
14771@table @code
14772@item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
14773@kindex set sdstimeout
14774Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
14775default is 2 seconds.
14776
14777@item show sdstimeout
14778@kindex show sdstimeout
14779Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
14780
14781@item sds @var{command}
14782@kindex sds@r{, a command}
14783Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
14784@end table
14785
14786
14787@node PA
14788@subsection HP PA Embedded
14789
14790@table @code
14791
14792@kindex target op50n
14793@item target op50n @var{dev}
14794OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
14795
14796@kindex target w89k
14797@item target w89k @var{dev}
14798W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
14799
14800@end table
14801
14802@node Sparclet
14803@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
14804
14805@cindex Sparclet
14806
14807@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
14808Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
14809@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14810both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
14811@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
14812
14813@table @code
14814@item remotetimeout @var{args}
14815@kindex remotetimeout
14816@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
14817This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14818seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
14819@end table
14820
14821@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
14822When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
14823information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
14824load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
14825@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
14826
14827@smallexample
14828sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
14829@end smallexample
14830
14831You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
14832
14833@smallexample
14834sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
14835@end smallexample
14836
14837@cindex running, on Sparclet
14838Once you have set
14839your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14840run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
14841(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
14842
14843@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14844
14845@smallexample
14846(gdbslet)
14847@end smallexample
14848
14849@menu
14850* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
14851* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
14852* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
14853* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
14854@end menu
14855
14856@node Sparclet File
14857@subsubsection Setting File to Debug
14858
14859The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
14860
14861@smallexample
14862(gdbslet) file prog
14863@end smallexample
14864
14865@need 1000
14866@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
14867@value{GDBN} locates
14868the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
14869path.
14870If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
14871files will be searched as well.
14872@value{GDBN} locates
14873the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
14874path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
14875If it fails
14876to find a file, it displays a message such as:
14877
14878@smallexample
14879prog: No such file or directory.
14880@end smallexample
14881
14882When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
14883the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
14884@code{target} command again.
14885
14886@node Sparclet Connection
14887@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
14888
14889The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
14890To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
14891
14892@smallexample
14893(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
14894Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
14895main () at ../prog.c:3
14896@end smallexample
14897
14898@need 750
14899@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14900
14901@smallexample
14902Connected to ttya.
14903@end smallexample
14904
14905@node Sparclet Download
14906@subsubsection Sparclet Download
14907
14908@cindex download to Sparclet
14909Once connected to the Sparclet target,
14910you can use the @value{GDBN}
14911@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
14912The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
14913command.
14914Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
14915address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
14916offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
14917of each of the file's sections.
14918For instance, if the program
14919@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
14920and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14921
14922@smallexample
14923(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
14924Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
14925@end smallexample
14926
14927If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
14928to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
14929to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
14930
14931@node Sparclet Execution
14932@subsubsection Running and Debugging
14933
14934@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
14935You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
14936commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
14937manual for the list of commands.
14938
14939@smallexample
14940(gdbslet) b main
14941Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
14942(gdbslet) run
14943Starting program: prog
14944Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
149453 char *symarg = 0;
14946(gdbslet) step
149474 char *execarg = "hello!";
14948(gdbslet)
14949@end smallexample
14950
14951@node Sparclite
14952@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
14953
14954@table @code
14955
14956@kindex target sparclite
14957@item target sparclite @var{dev}
14958Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
14959You must use an additional command to debug the program.
14960For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
14961remote protocol.
14962
14963@end table
14964
14965@node Z8000
14966@subsection Zilog Z8000
14967
14968@cindex Z8000
14969@cindex simulator, Z8000
14970@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
14971
14972When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
14973a Z8000 simulator.
14974
14975For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
14976unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
14977segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
14978appropriate by inspecting the object code.
14979
14980@table @code
14981@item target sim @var{args}
14982@kindex sim
14983@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
14984Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
14985options, specify them via @var{args}.
14986@end table
14987
14988@noindent
14989After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
14990CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
14991@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
14992to run your program, and so on.
14993
14994As well as making available all the usual machine registers
14995(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
14996additional items of information as specially named registers:
14997
14998@table @code
14999
15000@item cycles
15001Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15002
15003@item insts
15004Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15005
15006@item time
15007Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15008
15009@end table
15010
15011You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15012conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15013conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15014simulated clock ticks.
15015
15016@node AVR
15017@subsection Atmel AVR
15018@cindex AVR
15019
15020When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15021following AVR-specific commands:
15022
15023@table @code
15024@item info io_registers
15025@kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15026@cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15027This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15028each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15029@end table
15030
15031@node CRIS
15032@subsection CRIS
15033@cindex CRIS
15034
15035When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15036following CRIS-specific commands:
15037
15038@table @code
15039@item set cris-version @var{ver}
15040@cindex CRIS version
15041Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15042The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15043case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15044
15045@item show cris-version
15046Show the current CRIS version.
15047
15048@item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15049@cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15050Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15051Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15052@code{R59}.
15053
15054@item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15055Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15056
15057@item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15058@cindex CRIS mode
15059Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15060debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15061@samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15062
15063@item show cris-mode
15064Show the current CRIS mode.
15065@end table
15066
15067@node Super-H
15068@subsection Renesas Super-H
15069@cindex Super-H
15070
15071For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15072commands:
15073
15074@table @code
15075@item regs
15076@kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15077Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15078@end table
15079
15080
15081@node Architectures
15082@section Architectures
15083
15084This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15085all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15086
15087@menu
15088* i386::
15089* A29K::
15090* Alpha::
15091* MIPS::
15092* HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15093@end menu
15094
15095@node i386
15096@subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
15097
15098@table @code
15099@item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15100@kindex set struct-convention
15101@cindex struct return convention
15102@cindex struct/union returned in registers
15103Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15104@code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15105@var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15106default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15107are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15108@code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15109be returned in a register.
15110
15111@item show struct-convention
15112@kindex show struct-convention
15113Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15114from functions.
15115@end table
15116
15117@node A29K
15118@subsection A29K
15119
15120@table @code
15121
15122@kindex set rstack_high_address
15123@cindex AMD 29K register stack
15124@cindex register stack, AMD29K
15125@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15126On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15127@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15128extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15129stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15130memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15131this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15132the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15133address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15134hexadecimal.
15135
15136@kindex show rstack_high_address
15137@item show rstack_high_address
15138Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15139processors.
15140
15141@end table
15142
15143@node Alpha
15144@subsection Alpha
15145
15146See the following section.
15147
15148@node MIPS
15149@subsection MIPS
15150
15151@cindex stack on Alpha
15152@cindex stack on MIPS
15153@cindex Alpha stack
15154@cindex MIPS stack
15155Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15156sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15157find the beginning of a function.
15158
15159@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15160To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15161@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15162you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15163commands:
15164
15165@table @code
15166@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15167@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15168Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15169search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15170default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15171larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15172and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15173this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15174
15175@item show heuristic-fence-post
15176Display the current limit.
15177@end table
15178
15179@noindent
15180These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15181for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15182
15183Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15184programs:
15185
15186@table @code
15187@item set mips saved-gpreg-size @var{size}
15188@kindex set mips saved-gpreg-size
15189@cindex MIPS GP register size on stack
15190Set the size of MIPS general-purpose registers saved on the stack.
15191The argument @var{size} can be one of the following:
15192
15193@table @samp
15194@item 32
1519532-bit GP registers
15196@item 64
1519764-bit GP registers
15198@item auto
15199Use the target's default setting or autodetect the saved size from the
15200information contained in the executable. This is the default
15201@end table
15202
15203@item show mips saved-gpreg-size
15204@kindex show mips saved-gpreg-size
15205Show the current size of MIPS GP registers on the stack.
15206
15207@item set mips stack-arg-size @var{size}
15208@kindex set mips stack-arg-size
15209@cindex MIPS stack space for arguments
15210Set the amount of stack space reserved for arguments to functions.
15211The argument can be one of @code{"32"}, @code{"64"} or @code{"auto"}
15212(the default).
15213
15214@item set mips abi @var{arg}
15215@kindex set mips abi
15216@cindex set ABI for MIPS
15217Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15218values of @var{arg} are:
15219
15220@table @samp
15221@item auto
15222The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15223default).
15224@item o32
15225@item o64
15226@item n32
15227@item n64
15228@item eabi32
15229@item eabi64
15230@item auto
15231@end table
15232
15233@item show mips abi
15234@kindex show mips abi
15235Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15236
15237@item set mipsfpu
15238@itemx show mipsfpu
15239@xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15240
15241@item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15242@kindex set mips mask-address
15243@cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15244This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15245MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15246@samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15247setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15248
15249@item show mips mask-address
15250@kindex show mips mask-address
15251Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15252not.
15253
15254@item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15255@kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15256This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15257transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15258that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15259and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15260
15261@item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15262@kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15263Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15264
15265@item set debug mips
15266@kindex set debug mips
15267This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15268target code in @value{GDBN}.
15269
15270@item show debug mips
15271@kindex show debug mips
15272Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15273@end table
15274
15275
15276@node HPPA
15277@subsection HPPA
15278@cindex HPPA support
15279
15280When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
15281following special commands:
15282
15283@table @code
15284@item set debug hppa
15285@kindex set debug hppa
15286This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
15287messages are to be displayed.
15288
15289@item show debug hppa
15290Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15291
15292@item maint print unwind @var{address}
15293@kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15294This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15295given @var{address}.
15296
15297@end table
15298
15299
15300@node Controlling GDB
15301@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15302
15303You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15304@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15305data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
15306described here.
15307
15308@menu
15309* Prompt:: Prompt
15310* Editing:: Command editing
15311* Command History:: Command history
15312* Screen Size:: Screen size
15313* Numbers:: Numbers
15314* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15315* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15316* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15317@end menu
15318
15319@node Prompt
15320@section Prompt
15321
15322@cindex prompt
15323
15324@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15325called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15326can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15327instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15328the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15329which one you are talking to.
15330
15331@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15332prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15333or a prompt that does not.
15334
15335@table @code
15336@kindex set prompt
15337@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15338Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15339
15340@kindex show prompt
15341@item show prompt
15342Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15343@end table
15344
15345@node Editing
15346@section Command Editing
15347@cindex readline
15348@cindex command line editing
15349
15350@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15351@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15352command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15353or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15354substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15355debugging sessions.
15356
15357You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15358command @code{set}.
15359
15360@table @code
15361@kindex set editing
15362@cindex editing
15363@item set editing
15364@itemx set editing on
15365Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15366
15367@item set editing off
15368Disable command line editing.
15369
15370@kindex show editing
15371@item show editing
15372Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15373@end table
15374
15375@xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15376interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15377encouraged to read that chapter.
15378
15379@node Command History
15380@section Command History
15381@cindex command history
15382
15383@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15384debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15385happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15386history facility.
15387
15388@value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15389package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15390Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15391
15392To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15393the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
15394means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15395affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15396pressed on a line by itself.
15397
15398@cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15399The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15400history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15401use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15402
15403Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15404history.
15405
15406@table @code
15407@cindex history substitution
15408@cindex history file
15409@kindex set history filename
15410@cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15411@item set history filename @var{fname}
15412Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15413This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15414list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15415exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15416the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15417to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15418@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15419is not set.
15420
15421@cindex save command history
15422@kindex set history save
15423@item set history save
15424@itemx set history save on
15425Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15426@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15427
15428@item set history save off
15429Stop recording command history in a file.
15430
15431@cindex history size
15432@kindex set history size
15433@cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15434@item set history size @var{size}
15435Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15436This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15437@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15438@end table
15439
15440History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15441@xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15442
15443@cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15444Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15445is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15446@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15447follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15448a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15449history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15450@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15451
15452The commands to control history expansion are:
15453
15454@table @code
15455@item set history expansion on
15456@itemx set history expansion
15457@kindex set history expansion
15458Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15459
15460@item set history expansion off
15461Disable history expansion.
15462
15463@c @group
15464@kindex show history
15465@item show history
15466@itemx show history filename
15467@itemx show history save
15468@itemx show history size
15469@itemx show history expansion
15470These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15471@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15472@c @end group
15473@end table
15474
15475@table @code
15476@kindex show commands
15477@cindex show last commands
15478@cindex display command history
15479@item show commands
15480Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15481
15482@item show commands @var{n}
15483Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15484
15485@item show commands +
15486Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15487@end table
15488
15489@node Screen Size
15490@section Screen Size
15491@cindex size of screen
15492@cindex pauses in output
15493
15494Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15495information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15496@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15497output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15498to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15499determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15500printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15501rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15502
15503Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15504driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15505together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15506@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15507you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15508width} commands:
15509
15510@table @code
15511@kindex set height
15512@kindex set width
15513@kindex show width
15514@kindex show height
15515@item set height @var{lpp}
15516@itemx show height
15517@itemx set width @var{cpl}
15518@itemx show width
15519These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15520a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15521commands display the current settings.
15522
15523If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15524output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15525file or to an editor buffer.
15526
15527Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15528from wrapping its output.
15529
15530@item set pagination on
15531@itemx set pagination off
15532@kindex set pagination
15533Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15534pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15535
15536@item show pagination
15537@kindex show pagination
15538Show the current pagination mode.
15539@end table
15540
15541@node Numbers
15542@section Numbers
15543@cindex number representation
15544@cindex entering numbers
15545
15546You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15547@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15548@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15549begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15550@samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
1555110; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15552format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15553both input and output with the commands described below.
15554
15555@table @code
15556@kindex set input-radix
15557@item set input-radix @var{base}
15558Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15559for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15560specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15561example, any of
15562
15563@smallexample
15564set input-radix 012
15565set input-radix 10.
15566set input-radix 0xa
15567@end smallexample
15568
15569@noindent
15570sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15571leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15572@samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15573interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15574@samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15575change the radix.
15576
15577@kindex set output-radix
15578@item set output-radix @var{base}
15579Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15580for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15581specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15582
15583@kindex show input-radix
15584@item show input-radix
15585Display the current default base for numeric input.
15586
15587@kindex show output-radix
15588@item show output-radix
15589Display the current default base for numeric display.
15590
15591@item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15592@itemx show radix
15593@kindex set radix
15594@kindex show radix
15595These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15596of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15597the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15598default value of 10.
15599
15600@end table
15601
15602@node ABI
15603@section Configuring the Current ABI
15604
15605@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
15606application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
15607conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
15608current ABI.
15609
15610@cindex OS ABI
15611@kindex set osabi
15612@kindex show osabi
15613
15614One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
15615system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
15616@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
15617but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
15618One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
15619an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
15620not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
15621platform provides.
15622
15623@table @code
15624@item show osabi
15625Show the OS ABI currently in use.
15626
15627@item set osabi
15628With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
15629
15630@item set osabi @var{abi}
15631Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
15632@end table
15633
15634@cindex float promotion
15635
15636Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
15637function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
15638(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
15639according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
15640(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
15641@code{double} and then passed.
15642
15643Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
15644a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
15645as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
15646
15647@table @code
15648@kindex set coerce-float-to-double
15649@item set coerce-float-to-double
15650@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
15651Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
15652to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
15653
15654@item set coerce-float-to-double off
15655Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
15656functions.
15657
15658@kindex show coerce-float-to-double
15659@item show coerce-float-to-double
15660Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
15661@end table
15662
15663@kindex set cp-abi
15664@kindex show cp-abi
15665@value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
15666objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
15667used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
15668programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
15669multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
15670program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
15671Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
15672before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
15673``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
15674use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
15675``auto''.
15676
15677@table @code
15678@item show cp-abi
15679Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
15680
15681@item set cp-abi
15682With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
15683
15684@item set cp-abi @var{abi}
15685@itemx set cp-abi auto
15686Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
15687@end table
15688
15689@node Messages/Warnings
15690@section Optional Warnings and Messages
15691
15692@cindex verbose operation
15693@cindex optional warnings
15694By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
15695running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
15696command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
15697internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
15698
15699Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
15700which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
15701see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
15702
15703@table @code
15704@kindex set verbose
15705@item set verbose on
15706Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15707
15708@item set verbose off
15709Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
15710
15711@kindex show verbose
15712@item show verbose
15713Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
15714@end table
15715
15716By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
15717object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
15718find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
15719Symbol Files}).
15720
15721@table @code
15722
15723@kindex set complaints
15724@item set complaints @var{limit}
15725Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
15726unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
15727@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
15728to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
15729
15730@kindex show complaints
15731@item show complaints
15732Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
15733
15734@end table
15735
15736By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
15737lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
15738you try to run a program which is already running:
15739
15740@smallexample
15741(@value{GDBP}) run
15742The program being debugged has been started already.
15743Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
15744@end smallexample
15745
15746If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
15747commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
15748
15749@table @code
15750
15751@kindex set confirm
15752@cindex flinching
15753@cindex confirmation
15754@cindex stupid questions
15755@item set confirm off
15756Disables confirmation requests.
15757
15758@item set confirm on
15759Enables confirmation requests (the default).
15760
15761@kindex show confirm
15762@item show confirm
15763Displays state of confirmation requests.
15764
15765@end table
15766
15767@cindex command tracing
15768If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
15769useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
15770printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
15771quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
15772
15773@table @code
15774@kindex set trace-commands
15775@cindex command scripts, debugging
15776@item set trace-commands on
15777Enable command tracing.
15778@item set trace-commands off
15779Disable command tracing.
15780@item show trace-commands
15781Display the current state of command tracing.
15782@end table
15783
15784@node Debugging Output
15785@section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
15786@cindex optional debugging messages
15787
15788@value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
15789various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
15790interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
15791section documents those commands.
15792
15793@table @code
15794@kindex set exec-done-display
15795@item set exec-done-display
15796Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
15797completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
15798asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
15799@kindex show exec-done-display
15800@item show exec-done-display
15801Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
15802notification.
15803@kindex set debug
15804@cindex gdbarch debugging info
15805@cindex architecture debugging info
15806@item set debug arch
15807Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
15808@kindex show debug
15809@item show debug arch
15810Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
15811@item set debug aix-thread
15812@cindex AIX threads
15813Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
15814module.
15815@item show debug aix-thread
15816Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
15817@item set debug event
15818@cindex event debugging info
15819Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
15820default is off.
15821@item show debug event
15822Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
15823info.
15824@item set debug expression
15825@cindex expression debugging info
15826Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
15827expression parsing. The default is off.
15828@item show debug expression
15829Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
15830@value{GDBN} expression parsing.
15831@item set debug frame
15832@cindex frame debugging info
15833Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
15834default is off.
15835@item show debug frame
15836Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
15837info.
15838@item set debug infrun
15839@cindex inferior debugging info
15840Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
15841The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
15842for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
15843@item show debug infrun
15844Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
15845@item set debug lin-lwp
15846@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
15847@cindex Linux lightweight processes
15848Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
15849@item show debug lin-lwp
15850Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
15851@item set debug observer
15852@cindex observer debugging info
15853Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
15854includes info such as the notification of observable events.
15855@item show debug observer
15856Displays the current state of observer debugging.
15857@item set debug overload
15858@cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
15859Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
15860info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
15861is off.
15862@item show debug overload
15863Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
15864debugging info.
15865@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
15866@cindex serial connections, debugging
15867@cindex debug remote protocol
15868@cindex remote protocol debugging
15869@cindex display remote packets
15870@item set debug remote
15871Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
15872the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
15873@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
15874@item show debug remote
15875Displays the state of display of remote packets.
15876@item set debug serial
15877Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
15878default is off.
15879@item show debug serial
15880Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
15881info.
15882@item set debug solib-frv
15883@cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
15884Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
15885@item show debug solib-frv
15886Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
15887messages.
15888@item set debug target
15889@cindex target debugging info
15890Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
15891includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
15892default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
15893value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
15894until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
15895@item show debug target
15896Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
15897info.
15898@item set debugvarobj
15899@cindex variable object debugging info
15900Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
15901info. The default is off.
15902@item show debugvarobj
15903Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
15904debugging info.
15905@item set debug xml
15906@cindex XML parser debugging
15907Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
15908@item show debug xml
15909Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
15910@end table
15911
15912@node Sequences
15913@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
15914
15915Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
15916Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
15917commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
15918files.
15919
15920@menu
15921* Define:: How to define your own commands
15922* Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
15923* Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
15924* Output:: Commands for controlled output
15925@end menu
15926
15927@node Define
15928@section User-defined Commands
15929
15930@cindex user-defined command
15931@cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
15932A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
15933which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
15934@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
15935separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
15936via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
15937
15938@smallexample
15939define adder
15940 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
15941end
15942@end smallexample
15943
15944@noindent
15945To execute the command use:
15946
15947@smallexample
15948adder 1 2 3
15949@end smallexample
15950
15951@noindent
15952This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
15953its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
15954reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
15955functions calls.
15956
15957@cindex argument count in user-defined commands
15958@cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
15959In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
15960been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
15961
15962@smallexample
15963define adder
15964 if $argc == 2
15965 print $arg0 + $arg1
15966 end
15967 if $argc == 3
15968 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
15969 end
15970end
15971@end smallexample
15972
15973@table @code
15974
15975@kindex define
15976@item define @var{commandname}
15977Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
15978by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
15979
15980The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
15981which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
15982commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
15983
15984@kindex document
15985@kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
15986@item document @var{commandname}
15987Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
15988accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
15989defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
15990reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
15991After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
15992@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
15993
15994You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
15995documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
15996does not change the documentation.
15997
15998@kindex dont-repeat
15999@cindex don't repeat command
16000@item dont-repeat
16001Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16002command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16003(@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16004
16005@kindex help user-defined
16006@item help user-defined
16007List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16008(if any) for each.
16009
16010@kindex show user
16011@item show user
16012@itemx show user @var{commandname}
16013Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16014not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16015definitions for all user-defined commands.
16016
16017@cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16018@kindex show max-user-call-depth
16019@kindex set max-user-call-depth
16020@item show max-user-call-depth
16021@itemx set max-user-call-depth
16022The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16023levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
16024infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16025@end table
16026
16027In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16028use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16029
16030When user-defined commands are executed, the
16031commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16032stops execution of the user-defined command.
16033
16034If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16035without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16036commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16037messages when used in a user-defined command.
16038
16039@node Hooks
16040@section User-defined Command Hooks
16041@cindex command hooks
16042@cindex hooks, for commands
16043@cindex hooks, pre-command
16044
16045@kindex hook
16046You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16047command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16048command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16049before that command.
16050
16051@cindex hooks, post-command
16052@kindex hookpost
16053A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16054Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16055@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16056that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16057pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16058
16059It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16060occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16061
16062@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16063@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16064
16065@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16066In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16067(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16068execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16069displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16070
16071For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16072single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16073you could define:
16074
16075@smallexample
16076define hook-stop
16077handle SIGALRM nopass
16078end
16079
16080define hook-run
16081handle SIGALRM pass
16082end
16083
16084define hook-continue
16085handle SIGALRM pass
16086end
16087@end smallexample
16088
16089As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
16090command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16091you could define:
16092
16093@smallexample
16094define hook-echo
16095echo <<<---
16096end
16097
16098define hookpost-echo
16099echo --->>>\n
16100end
16101
16102(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16103<<<---Hello World--->>>
16104(@value{GDBP})
16105
16106@end smallexample
16107
16108You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16109not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16110name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16111@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16112@c or not?
16113If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16114@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16115(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16116
16117If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16118get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16119
16120@node Command Files
16121@section Command Files
16122
16123@cindex command files
16124@cindex scripting commands
16125A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16126@value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16127also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16128does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16129terminal.
16130
16131You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16132command:
16133
16134@table @code
16135@kindex source
16136@cindex execute commands from a file
16137@item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16138Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16139@end table
16140
16141The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16142unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16143@emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16144printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16145execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16146
16147@value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16148on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16149
16150If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16151each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16152@var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16153
16154Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16155without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16156normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16157when called from command files.
16158
16159@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16160mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16161standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16162not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16163the next command.
16164
16165@smallexample
16166gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16167@end smallexample
16168
16169(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16170will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16171would be directed to @file{log}.
16172
16173Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16174commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16175complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16176variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16177built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16178deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16179complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16180conditionally, etc.
16181
16182@table @code
16183@kindex if
16184@kindex else
16185@item if
16186@itemx else
16187This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16188commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16189expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16190are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16191There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16192of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16193end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16194
16195@kindex while
16196@item while
16197This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16198@code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16199to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16200line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16201@dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16202executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16203
16204@kindex loop_break
16205@item loop_break
16206This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16207Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16208line.
16209
16210@kindex loop_continue
16211@item loop_continue
16212This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16213in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16214branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16215the controlling expression.
16216
16217@kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16218@item end
16219Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16220@code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16221@end table
16222
16223
16224@node Output
16225@section Commands for Controlled Output
16226
16227During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16228@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16229explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16230describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16231want.
16232
16233@table @code
16234@kindex echo
16235@item echo @var{text}
16236@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16237@c because it is not in ANSI.
16238Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16239@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16240newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16241In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16242by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16243string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16244trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16245To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16246@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16247
16248A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16249the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16250
16251@smallexample
16252echo This is some text\n\
16253which is continued\n\
16254onto several lines.\n
16255@end smallexample
16256
16257produces the same output as
16258
16259@smallexample
16260echo This is some text\n
16261echo which is continued\n
16262echo onto several lines.\n
16263@end smallexample
16264
16265@kindex output
16266@item output @var{expression}
16267Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16268newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16269value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16270on expressions.
16271
16272@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16273Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16274the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16275Formats}, for more information.
16276
16277@kindex printf
16278@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16279Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
16280@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
16281either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
16282@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
16283subroutine
16284@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
16285@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
16286@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
16287@c supported.
16288
16289@smallexample
16290printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16291@end smallexample
16292
16293For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16294
16295@smallexample
16296printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16297@end smallexample
16298
16299The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
16300string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
16301letter.
16302@end table
16303
16304@node Interpreters
16305@chapter Command Interpreters
16306@cindex command interpreters
16307
16308@value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16309infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16310between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16311
16312@value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16313interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16314and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16315describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16316
16317By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16318However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16319interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16320startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16321
16322@table @code
16323@item console
16324@cindex console interpreter
16325The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16326used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16327@value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16328
16329@item mi
16330@cindex mi interpreter
16331The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16332by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16333or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16334Interface}.
16335
16336@item mi2
16337@cindex mi2 interpreter
16338The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16339
16340@item mi1
16341@cindex mi1 interpreter
16342The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16343
16344@end table
16345
16346@cindex invoke another interpreter
16347The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16348switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16349precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16350enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16351@value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16352the IDE inoperable!
16353
16354@kindex interpreter-exec
16355Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16356commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16357command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16358@code{interpreter-exec} command:
16359
16360@smallexample
16361interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16362@end smallexample
16363
16364@sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16365@value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16366
16367@node TUI
16368@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16369@cindex TUI
16370@cindex Text User Interface
16371
16372@menu
16373* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16374* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16375* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16376* TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
16377* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16378@end menu
16379
16380The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short, is a terminal
16381interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16382file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16383commands in separate text windows.
16384
16385The TUI is enabled by invoking @value{GDBN} using either
16386@pindex gdbtui
16387@samp{gdbtui} or @samp{gdb -tui}.
16388
16389@node TUI Overview
16390@section TUI Overview
16391
16392The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
16393@value{GDBN} runs:
16394
16395@itemize @bullet
16396@item
16397A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
16398windows on the terminal.
16399
16400@item
16401A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
16402the TUI.
16403@end itemize
16404
16405In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
16406on the terminal:
16407
16408@table @emph
16409@item command
16410This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16411prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16412managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
16413window is always visible.
16414
16415@item source
16416The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16417line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16418
16419@item assembly
16420The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16421
16422@item register
16423This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
16424a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
16425changed are highlighted.
16426
16427@end table
16428
16429The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16430by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
16431Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
16432indicates the breakpoint type:
16433
16434@table @code
16435@item B
16436Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16437
16438@item b
16439Breakpoint which was never hit.
16440
16441@item H
16442Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16443
16444@item h
16445Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16446
16447@end table
16448
16449The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16450
16451@table @code
16452@item +
16453Breakpoint is enabled.
16454
16455@item -
16456Breakpoint is disabled.
16457
16458@end table
16459
16460The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
16461and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
16462changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
16463These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
16464layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
16465The following layouts are available:
16466
16467@itemize @bullet
16468@item
16469source
16470
16471@item
16472assembly
16473
16474@item
16475source and assembly
16476
16477@item
16478source and registers
16479
16480@item
16481assembly and registers
16482
16483@end itemize
16484
16485On top of the command window a status line gives various information
16486concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
16487updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
16488are displayed:
16489
16490@table @emph
16491@item target
16492Indicates the current gdb target
16493(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16494
16495@item process
16496Gives information about the current process or thread number.
16497When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16498
16499@item function
16500Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16501The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16502When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
16503the string @code{??} is displayed.
16504
16505@item line
16506Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16507When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
16508
16509@item pc
16510Indicates the current program counter address.
16511
16512@end table
16513
16514@node TUI Keys
16515@section TUI Key Bindings
16516@cindex TUI key bindings
16517
16518The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16519(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
16520They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
16521directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
16522a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
16523@value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
16524are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16525
16526@table @kbd
16527@kindex C-x C-a
16528@item C-x C-a
16529@kindex C-x a
16530@itemx C-x a
16531@kindex C-x A
16532@itemx C-x A
16533Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
16534the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
16535its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
16536mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
16537The screen is then refreshed.
16538
16539@kindex C-x 1
16540@item C-x 1
16541Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16542either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16543is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16544
16545Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16546
16547@kindex C-x 2
16548@item C-x 2
16549Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16550layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
16551When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16552previous layout and the new one.
16553
16554Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16555
16556@kindex C-x o
16557@item C-x o
16558Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
16559(like scrolling and arrow keys) to the active window. This command
16560gives the focus to the next TUI window.
16561
16562Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
16563
16564@kindex C-x s
16565@item C-x s
16566Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
16567(@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
16568
16569@end table
16570
16571The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
16572
16573@table @key
16574@kindex PgUp
16575@item PgUp
16576Scroll the active window one page up.
16577
16578@kindex PgDn
16579@item PgDn
16580Scroll the active window one page down.
16581
16582@kindex Up
16583@item Up
16584Scroll the active window one line up.
16585
16586@kindex Down
16587@item Down
16588Scroll the active window one line down.
16589
16590@kindex Left
16591@item Left
16592Scroll the active window one column left.
16593
16594@kindex Right
16595@item Right
16596Scroll the active window one column right.
16597
16598@kindex C-L
16599@item C-L
16600Refresh the screen.
16601
16602@end table
16603
16604In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
16605for scrolling. This means they are available for readline when the
16606active window is the command window. When the command window
16607does not have the focus, it is necessary to use other readline
16608key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b} and @kbd{C-f}.
16609
16610@node TUI Single Key Mode
16611@section TUI Single Key Mode
16612@cindex TUI single key mode
16613
16614The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
16615key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
16616some gdb commands.
16617
16618@table @kbd
16619@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16620@item c
16621continue
16622
16623@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16624@item d
16625down
16626
16627@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16628@item f
16629finish
16630
16631@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16632@item n
16633next
16634
16635@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16636@item q
16637exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
16638
16639@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16640@item r
16641run
16642
16643@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16644@item s
16645step
16646
16647@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16648@item u
16649up
16650
16651@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16652@item v
16653info locals
16654
16655@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16656@item w
16657where
16658
16659@end table
16660
16661Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
16662The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
16663it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
16664with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
16665@emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
16666this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
16667
16668
16669@node TUI Commands
16670@section TUI-specific Commands
16671@cindex TUI commands
16672
16673The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
16674These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
16675the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
16676is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
16677in the TUI mode.
16678
16679@table @code
16680@item info win
16681@kindex info win
16682List and give the size of all displayed windows.
16683
16684@item layout next
16685@kindex layout
16686Display the next layout.
16687
16688@item layout prev
16689Display the previous layout.
16690
16691@item layout src
16692Display the source window only.
16693
16694@item layout asm
16695Display the assembly window only.
16696
16697@item layout split
16698Display the source and assembly window.
16699
16700@item layout regs
16701Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
16702
16703@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
16704@kindex focus
16705Set the focus to the named window.
16706This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
16707can be affected to another window.
16708
16709@item refresh
16710@kindex refresh
16711Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
16712
16713@item tui reg float
16714@kindex tui reg
16715Show the floating point registers in the register window.
16716
16717@item tui reg general
16718Show the general registers in the register window.
16719
16720@item tui reg next
16721Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
16722their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
16723following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
16724@code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
16725
16726@item tui reg system
16727Show the system registers in the register window.
16728
16729@item update
16730@kindex update
16731Update the source window and the current execution point.
16732
16733@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
16734@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
16735@kindex winheight
16736Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
16737lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
16738decrease it.
16739
16740@item tabset
16741@kindex tabset @var{nchars}
16742Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
16743
16744@end table
16745
16746@node TUI Configuration
16747@section TUI Configuration Variables
16748@cindex TUI configuration variables
16749
16750The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
16751appearance of windows on the terminal.
16752
16753@table @code
16754@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
16755@kindex set tui border-kind
16756Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
16757The possible values are the following:
16758@table @code
16759@item space
16760Use a space character to draw the border.
16761
16762@item ascii
16763Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
16764
16765@item acs
16766Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
16767drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
16768
16769@end table
16770
16771@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
16772@kindex set tui active-border-mode
16773Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
16774The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
16775@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
16776
16777@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
16778@kindex set tui border-mode
16779Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
16780The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
16781@table @code
16782@item normal
16783Use normal attributes to display the border.
16784
16785@item standout
16786Use standout mode.
16787
16788@item reverse
16789Use reverse video mode.
16790
16791@item half
16792Use half bright mode.
16793
16794@item half-standout
16795Use half bright and standout mode.
16796
16797@item bold
16798Use extra bright or bold mode.
16799
16800@item bold-standout
16801Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
16802
16803@end table
16804
16805@end table
16806
16807@node Emacs
16808@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
16809
16810@cindex Emacs
16811@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
16812A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
16813edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
16814@value{GDBN}.
16815
16816To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
16817executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
16818@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
16819created Emacs buffer.
16820@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
16821
16822Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
16823things:
16824
16825@itemize @bullet
16826@item
16827All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
16828@end itemize
16829
16830This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
16831and output done by the program you are debugging.
16832
16833This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
16834commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
16835in this way.
16836
16837All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
16838with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
16839way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
16840stop.
16841
16842@itemize @bullet
16843@item
16844@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
16845@end itemize
16846
16847Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
16848source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
16849left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
16850source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
16851and the source.
16852
16853Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
16854usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
16855
16856If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
16857gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
16858your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
16859sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
16860with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
16861program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
16862some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
16863@value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
16864buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
16865
16866The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
16867line of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer and this serves as a default for
16868the commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate
16869on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
16870
16871By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
16872need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
16873keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
16874customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
16875one you want.
16876
16877In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
16878addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
16879
16880@table @kbd
16881@item C-h m
16882Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
16883
16884@item C-c C-s
16885Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
16886update the display window to show the current file and location.
16887
16888@item C-c C-n
16889Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
16890calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
16891to show the current file and location.
16892
16893@item C-c C-i
16894Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
16895display window accordingly.
16896
16897@item C-c C-f
16898Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
16899@code{finish} command.
16900
16901@item C-c C-r
16902Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
16903command.
16904
16905@item C-c <
16906Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
16907(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
16908like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
16909
16910@item C-c >
16911Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
16912@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
16913@end table
16914
16915In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
16916tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
16917
16918If you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, then Emacs displays a separate frame which
16919shows a backtrace when the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer is current. Move
16920point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it become the
16921current frame and display the associated source in the source buffer.
16922Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the selected frame become the
16923current one.
16924
16925If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
16926it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
16927request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
16928the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
16929frame.
16930
16931The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
16932which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
16933the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
16934communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
16935delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
16936to correspond properly with the code.
16937
16938The description given here is for GNU Emacs version 21.3 and a more
16939detailed description of its interaction with @value{GDBN} is given in
16940the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}).
16941
16942@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
16943@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
16944@ignore
16945@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
16946@kindex Epoch
16947@kindex inspect
16948
16949Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
16950called the @code{epoch}
16951environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
16952@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
16953each value is printed in its own window.
16954@end ignore
16955
16956
16957@node GDB/MI
16958@chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
16959
16960@unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
16961
16962@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
16963@sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
16964@value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
16965@option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
16966is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
16967use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
16968
16969This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
16970in the form of a reference manual.
16971
16972Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
16973features described below are incomplete and subject to change
16974(@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
16975
16976@unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
16977
16978@cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
16979This chapter uses the following notation:
16980
16981@itemize @bullet
16982@item
16983@code{|} separates two alternatives.
16984
16985@item
16986@code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
16987it may or may not be given.
16988
16989@item
16990@code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
16991may repeat zero or more times.
16992
16993@item
16994@code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
16995may repeat one or more times.
16996
16997@item
16998@code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
16999@end itemize
17000
17001@ignore
17002@heading Dependencies
17003@end ignore
17004
17005@menu
17006* GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17007* GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17008* GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17009* GDB/MI Output Records::
17010* GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17011* GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17012* GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17013* GDB/MI Program Context::
17014* GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17015* GDB/MI Program Execution::
17016* GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17017* GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17018* GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17019* GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17020* GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17021* GDB/MI File Commands::
17022@ignore
17023* GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17024* GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17025* GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17026@end ignore
17027* GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17028* GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17029@end menu
17030
17031@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17032@node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17033@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17034
17035@menu
17036* GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17037* GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17038@end menu
17039
17040@node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17041@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17042
17043@cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17044@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17045@table @code
17046@item @var{command} @expansion{}
17047@code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17048
17049@item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17050@code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17051@var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17052
17053@item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17054@code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17055@code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17056
17057@item @var{token} @expansion{}
17058"any sequence of digits"
17059
17060@item @var{option} @expansion{}
17061@code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17062
17063@item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17064@code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17065
17066@item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17067@emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17068
17069@item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17070@emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17071"-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17072
17073@item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17074@code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17075
17076@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17077@code{CR | CR-LF}
17078@end table
17079
17080@noindent
17081Notes:
17082
17083@itemize @bullet
17084@item
17085The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17086output is described below.
17087
17088@item
17089The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17090finishes.
17091
17092@item
17093Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17094list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17095followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17096parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17097@samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17098@end itemize
17099
17100Pragmatics:
17101
17102@itemize @bullet
17103@item
17104We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17105
17106@item
17107We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17108@end itemize
17109
17110@node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17111@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17112
17113@cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17114@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17115The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17116followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17117is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17118terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17119
17120If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17121corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17122@var{token}.
17123
17124@table @code
17125@item @var{output} @expansion{}
17126@code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17127
17128@item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17129@code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17130
17131@item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17132@code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17133
17134@item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17135@code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17136
17137@item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17138@code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17139
17140@item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17141@code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17142
17143@item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17144@code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17145
17146@item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17147@code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17148
17149@item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17150@code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17151
17152@item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17153@code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17154depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17155
17156@item @var{result} @expansion{}
17157@code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17158
17159@item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17160@code{ @var{string} }
17161
17162@item @var{value} @expansion{}
17163@code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17164
17165@item @var{const} @expansion{}
17166@code{@var{c-string}}
17167
17168@item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17169@code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17170
17171@item @var{list} @expansion{}
17172@code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17173@var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17174
17175@item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17176@code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17177
17178@item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17179@code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17180
17181@item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17182@code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17183
17184@item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17185@code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17186
17187@item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17188@code{CR | CR-LF}
17189
17190@item @var{token} @expansion{}
17191@emph{any sequence of digits}.
17192@end table
17193
17194@noindent
17195Notes:
17196
17197@itemize @bullet
17198@item
17199All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17200
17201@item
17202The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17203command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17204@var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17205original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17206
17207@item
17208@cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17209@var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17210progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17211prefixed by @samp{+}.
17212
17213@item
17214@cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17215@var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17216(stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17217@samp{*}.
17218
17219@item
17220@cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17221@var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17222client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17223output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17224
17225@item
17226@cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17227@var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17228console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17229output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17230
17231@item
17232@cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17233@var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17234All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17235
17236@item
17237@cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17238@var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17239instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17240the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17241
17242@item
17243@cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17244New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17245@var{values}.
17246
17247
17248@end itemize
17249
17250@xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17251details about the various output records.
17252
17253@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17254@node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17255@section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17256
17257@cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17258@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17259
17260For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17261but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17262that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17263command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17264@code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17265@samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17266
17267This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17268recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17269(@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17270
17271@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17272@node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17273@section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17274@cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17275
17276The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17277program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17278
17279Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17280by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17281to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17282section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17283might change.
17284
17285Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17286for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17287list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17288parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17289
17290@itemize @bullet
17291@item
17292New MI commands may be added.
17293
17294@item
17295New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17296
17297@item
17298The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
17299@code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
17300
17301@c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17302@c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17303
17304@c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17305@c resolve inconsistencies.
17306@end itemize
17307
17308If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17309will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17310output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17311@value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17312responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17313
17314@c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17315@c version?
17316
17317The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17318end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17319follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17320@email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17321@email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17322Group, which has the aim of creating a more general MI protocol
17323called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17324for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17325@cindex mailing lists
17326
17327@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17328@node GDB/MI Output Records
17329@section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17330
17331@menu
17332* GDB/MI Result Records::
17333* GDB/MI Stream Records::
17334* GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17335@end menu
17336
17337@node GDB/MI Result Records
17338@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17339
17340@cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17341@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17342In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17343@sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17344
17345@table @code
17346@findex ^done
17347@item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17348The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17349values.
17350
17351@item "^running"
17352@findex ^running
17353@c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17354The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17355running.
17356
17357@item "^connected"
17358@findex ^connected
17359@value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
17360
17361@item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17362@findex ^error
17363The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17364error message.
17365
17366@item "^exit"
17367@findex ^exit
17368@value{GDBN} has terminated.
17369
17370@end table
17371
17372@node GDB/MI Stream Records
17373@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17374
17375@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17376@cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17377@value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17378target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17379funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17380
17381Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17382identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17383Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17384@code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17385line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17386
17387@table @code
17388@item "~" @var{string-output}
17389The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17390CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17391
17392@item "@@" @var{string-output}
17393The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17394target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17395asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17396
17397@item "&" @var{string-output}
17398The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17399internals.
17400@end table
17401
17402@node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17403@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17404
17405@cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17406@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17407@dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17408additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17409consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17410target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17411
17412The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17413In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17414
17415@table @code
17416@item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17417@end table
17418
17419@var{reason} can be one of the following:
17420
17421@table @code
17422@item breakpoint-hit
17423A breakpoint was reached.
17424@item watchpoint-trigger
17425A watchpoint was triggered.
17426@item read-watchpoint-trigger
17427A read watchpoint was triggered.
17428@item access-watchpoint-trigger
17429An access watchpoint was triggered.
17430@item function-finished
17431An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17432@item location-reached
17433An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17434@item watchpoint-scope
17435A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17436@item end-stepping-range
17437An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17438similar CLI command was accomplished.
17439@item exited-signalled
17440The inferior exited because of a signal.
17441@item exited
17442The inferior exited.
17443@item exited-normally
17444The inferior exited normally.
17445@item signal-received
17446A signal was received by the inferior.
17447@end table
17448
17449
17450@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17451@node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17452@section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17453@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17454
17455This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17456the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17457following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17458the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17459
17460Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17461readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17462
17463@subheading Setting a Breakpoint
17464
17465Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17466information of the breakpoint.
17467
17468@smallexample
17469-> -break-insert main
17470<- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17471 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17472 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17473<- (gdb)
17474@end smallexample
17475
17476@subheading Program Execution
17477
17478Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
17479reason that execution stopped.
17480
17481@smallexample
17482-> -exec-run
17483<- ^running
17484<- (gdb)
17485<- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
17486 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
17487 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
17488 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
17489<- (gdb)
17490-> -exec-continue
17491<- ^running
17492<- (gdb)
17493<- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
17494<- (gdb)
17495@end smallexample
17496
17497@subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
17498
17499Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
17500
17501@smallexample
17502-> (gdb)
17503<- -gdb-exit
17504<- ^exit
17505@end smallexample
17506
17507@subheading A Bad Command
17508
17509Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17510
17511@smallexample
17512-> -rubbish
17513<- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17514<- (gdb)
17515@end smallexample
17516
17517
17518@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17519@node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17520@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17521
17522The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17523commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17524
17525@subheading Motivation
17526
17527The motivation for this collection of commands.
17528
17529@subheading Introduction
17530
17531A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17532
17533@subheading Commands
17534
17535For each command in the block, the following is described:
17536
17537@subsubheading Synopsis
17538
17539@smallexample
17540 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17541@end smallexample
17542
17543@subsubheading Result
17544
17545@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17546
17547The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17548
17549@subsubheading Example
17550
17551Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
17552not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
17553
17554
17555@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17556@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
17557@section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
17558
17559@cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
17560@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
17561This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
17562breakpoints.
17563
17564@subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
17565@findex -break-after
17566
17567@subsubheading Synopsis
17568
17569@smallexample
17570 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
17571@end smallexample
17572
17573The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
17574hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
17575the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
17576@samp{-break-list} command below.
17577
17578@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17579
17580The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
17581
17582@subsubheading Example
17583
17584@smallexample
17585(gdb)
17586-break-insert main
17587^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
17588fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
17589(gdb)
17590-break-after 1 3
17591~
17592^done
17593(gdb)
17594-break-list
17595^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17596hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17597@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17598@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17599@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17600@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17601@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17602body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17603addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17604line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17605(gdb)
17606@end smallexample
17607
17608@ignore
17609@subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
17610@findex -break-catch
17611
17612@subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
17613@findex -break-commands
17614@end ignore
17615
17616
17617@subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
17618@findex -break-condition
17619
17620@subsubheading Synopsis
17621
17622@smallexample
17623 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
17624@end smallexample
17625
17626Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
17627@var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
17628@samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
17629command below).
17630
17631@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17632
17633The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
17634
17635@subsubheading Example
17636
17637@smallexample
17638(gdb)
17639-break-condition 1 1
17640^done
17641(gdb)
17642-break-list
17643^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17644hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17645@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17646@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17647@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17648@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17649@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17650body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17651addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17652line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17653(gdb)
17654@end smallexample
17655
17656@subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
17657@findex -break-delete
17658
17659@subsubheading Synopsis
17660
17661@smallexample
17662 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17663@end smallexample
17664
17665Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
17666list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
17667
17668@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17669
17670The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
17671
17672@subsubheading Example
17673
17674@smallexample
17675(gdb)
17676-break-delete 1
17677^done
17678(gdb)
17679-break-list
17680^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
17681hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17682@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17683@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17684@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17685@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17686@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17687body=[]@}
17688(gdb)
17689@end smallexample
17690
17691@subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
17692@findex -break-disable
17693
17694@subsubheading Synopsis
17695
17696@smallexample
17697 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17698@end smallexample
17699
17700Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
17701break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
17702
17703@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17704
17705The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
17706
17707@subsubheading Example
17708
17709@smallexample
17710(gdb)
17711-break-disable 2
17712^done
17713(gdb)
17714-break-list
17715^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17716hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17717@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17718@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17719@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17720@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17721@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17722body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
17723addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17724line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17725(gdb)
17726@end smallexample
17727
17728@subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
17729@findex -break-enable
17730
17731@subsubheading Synopsis
17732
17733@smallexample
17734 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
17735@end smallexample
17736
17737Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
17738
17739@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17740
17741The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
17742
17743@subsubheading Example
17744
17745@smallexample
17746(gdb)
17747-break-enable 2
17748^done
17749(gdb)
17750-break-list
17751^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17752hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17753@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17754@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17755@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17756@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17757@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17758body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17759addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17760line="5",times="0"@}]@}
17761(gdb)
17762@end smallexample
17763
17764@subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
17765@findex -break-info
17766
17767@subsubheading Synopsis
17768
17769@smallexample
17770 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
17771@end smallexample
17772
17773@c REDUNDANT???
17774Get information about a single breakpoint.
17775
17776@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17777
17778The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
17779
17780@subsubheading Example
17781N.A.
17782
17783@subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
17784@findex -break-insert
17785
17786@subsubheading Synopsis
17787
17788@smallexample
17789 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
17790 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
17791 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
17792@end smallexample
17793
17794@noindent
17795If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
17796
17797@itemize @bullet
17798@item function
17799@c @item +offset
17800@c @item -offset
17801@c @item linenum
17802@item filename:linenum
17803@item filename:function
17804@item *address
17805@end itemize
17806
17807The possible optional parameters of this command are:
17808
17809@table @samp
17810@item -t
17811Insert a temporary breakpoint.
17812@item -h
17813Insert a hardware breakpoint.
17814@item -c @var{condition}
17815Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
17816@item -i @var{ignore-count}
17817Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
17818@item -r
17819Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
17820given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
17821expressions.
17822@end table
17823
17824@subsubheading Result
17825
17826The result is in the form:
17827
17828@smallexample
17829^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
17830enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
17831fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
17832times="@var{times}"@}
17833@end smallexample
17834
17835@noindent
17836where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
17837@var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
17838inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
17839this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
17840and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
17841(always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
17842which use the same output).
17843
17844Note: this format is open to change.
17845@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
17846
17847@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17848
17849The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
17850@samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
17851
17852@subsubheading Example
17853
17854@smallexample
17855(gdb)
17856-break-insert main
17857^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
17858fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
17859(gdb)
17860-break-insert -t foo
17861^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
17862fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
17863(gdb)
17864-break-list
17865^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17866hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17867@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17868@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17869@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17870@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17871@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17872body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17873addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
17874fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
17875bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
17876addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
17877fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
17878(gdb)
17879-break-insert -r foo.*
17880~int foo(int, int);
17881^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
17882"fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
17883(gdb)
17884@end smallexample
17885
17886@subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
17887@findex -break-list
17888
17889@subsubheading Synopsis
17890
17891@smallexample
17892 -break-list
17893@end smallexample
17894
17895Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
17896
17897@table @samp
17898@item Number
17899number of the breakpoint
17900@item Type
17901type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
17902@item Disposition
17903should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
17904or @samp{nokeep}
17905@item Enabled
17906is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
17907@item Address
17908memory location at which the breakpoint is set
17909@item What
17910logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
17911name, line number
17912@item Times
17913number of times the breakpoint has been hit
17914@end table
17915
17916If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
17917@code{body} field is an empty list.
17918
17919@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17920
17921The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
17922
17923@subsubheading Example
17924
17925@smallexample
17926(gdb)
17927-break-list
17928^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
17929hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17930@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17931@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17932@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17933@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17934@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17935body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17936addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
17937bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17938addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17939line="13",times="0"@}]@}
17940(gdb)
17941@end smallexample
17942
17943Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
17944
17945@smallexample
17946(gdb)
17947-break-list
17948^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
17949hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17950@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17951@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17952@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17953@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17954@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17955body=[]@}
17956(gdb)
17957@end smallexample
17958
17959@subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
17960@findex -break-watch
17961
17962@subsubheading Synopsis
17963
17964@smallexample
17965 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
17966@end smallexample
17967
17968Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
17969@dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
17970read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
17971option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
17972trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
17973either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
17974i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
17975@xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
17976
17977Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
17978breakpoints inserted.
17979
17980@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17981
17982The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
17983@samp{rwatch}.
17984
17985@subsubheading Example
17986
17987Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
17988
17989@smallexample
17990(gdb)
17991-break-watch x
17992^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
17993(gdb)
17994-exec-continue
17995^running
17996(gdb)
17997*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
17998value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
17999frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18000fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18001(gdb)
18002@end smallexample
18003
18004Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18005the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18006for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18007
18008@smallexample
18009(gdb)
18010-break-watch C
18011^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18012(gdb)
18013-exec-continue
18014^running
18015(gdb)
18016*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18017wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18018frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18019file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18020fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18021(gdb)
18022-exec-continue
18023^running
18024(gdb)
18025*stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18026frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18027value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18028file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18029fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18030(gdb)
18031@end smallexample
18032
18033Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18034execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18035deleted.
18036
18037@smallexample
18038(gdb)
18039-break-watch C
18040^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18041(gdb)
18042-break-list
18043^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18044hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18045@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18046@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18047@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18048@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18049@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18050body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18051addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18052file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18053fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18054bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18055enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18056(gdb)
18057-exec-continue
18058^running
18059(gdb)
18060*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18061value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18062frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18063file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18064fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18065(gdb)
18066-break-list
18067^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18068hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18069@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18070@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18071@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18072@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18073@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18074body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18075addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18076file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18077fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18078bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18079enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18080(gdb)
18081-exec-continue
18082^running
18083^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18084frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18085value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18086file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18087fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18088(gdb)
18089-break-list
18090^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18091hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18092@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18093@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18094@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18095@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18096@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18097body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18098addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18099file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18100fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18101times="1"@}]@}
18102(gdb)
18103@end smallexample
18104
18105@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18106@node GDB/MI Program Context
18107@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18108
18109@subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18110@findex -exec-arguments
18111
18112
18113@subsubheading Synopsis
18114
18115@smallexample
18116 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18117@end smallexample
18118
18119Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18120@samp{-exec-run}.
18121
18122@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18123
18124The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18125
18126@subsubheading Example
18127
18128@c FIXME!
18129Don't have one around.
18130
18131
18132@subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18133@findex -exec-show-arguments
18134
18135@subsubheading Synopsis
18136
18137@smallexample
18138 -exec-show-arguments
18139@end smallexample
18140
18141Print the arguments of the program.
18142
18143@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18144
18145The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18146
18147@subsubheading Example
18148N.A.
18149
18150
18151@subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18152@findex -environment-cd
18153
18154@subsubheading Synopsis
18155
18156@smallexample
18157 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18158@end smallexample
18159
18160Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18161
18162@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18163
18164The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18165
18166@subsubheading Example
18167
18168@smallexample
18169(gdb)
18170-environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18171^done
18172(gdb)
18173@end smallexample
18174
18175
18176@subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18177@findex -environment-directory
18178
18179@subsubheading Synopsis
18180
18181@smallexample
18182 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18183@end smallexample
18184
18185Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18186If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18187search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18188@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18189occurs as normal.
18190Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18191multiple directories in a single command
18192results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18193search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18194If blanks are needed as
18195part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18196the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18197by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18198character must not be used
18199in any directory name.
18200If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18201
18202@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18203
18204The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18205
18206@subsubheading Example
18207
18208@smallexample
18209(gdb)
18210-environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18211^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18212(gdb)
18213-environment-directory ""
18214^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18215(gdb)
18216-environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18217^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18218(gdb)
18219-environment-directory -r
18220^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18221(gdb)
18222@end smallexample
18223
18224
18225@subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18226@findex -environment-path
18227
18228@subsubheading Synopsis
18229
18230@smallexample
18231 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18232@end smallexample
18233
18234Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18235If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18236search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18237supplied in addition to the
18238@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18239occurs as normal.
18240Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18241multiple directories in a single command
18242results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18243search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18244If blanks are needed as
18245part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18246the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18247by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
18248character must not be used
18249in any directory name.
18250If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18251
18252
18253@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18254
18255The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18256
18257@subsubheading Example
18258
18259@smallexample
18260(gdb)
18261-environment-path
18262^done,path="/usr/bin"
18263(gdb)
18264-environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18265^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18266(gdb)
18267-environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18268^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18269(gdb)
18270@end smallexample
18271
18272
18273@subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18274@findex -environment-pwd
18275
18276@subsubheading Synopsis
18277
18278@smallexample
18279 -environment-pwd
18280@end smallexample
18281
18282Show the current working directory.
18283
18284@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18285
18286The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18287
18288@subsubheading Example
18289
18290@smallexample
18291(gdb)
18292-environment-pwd
18293^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18294(gdb)
18295@end smallexample
18296
18297@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18298@node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18299@section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18300
18301
18302@subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18303@findex -thread-info
18304
18305@subsubheading Synopsis
18306
18307@smallexample
18308 -thread-info
18309@end smallexample
18310
18311@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18312
18313No equivalent.
18314
18315@subsubheading Example
18316N.A.
18317
18318
18319@subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18320@findex -thread-list-all-threads
18321
18322@subsubheading Synopsis
18323
18324@smallexample
18325 -thread-list-all-threads
18326@end smallexample
18327
18328@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18329
18330The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18331
18332@subsubheading Example
18333N.A.
18334
18335
18336@subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18337@findex -thread-list-ids
18338
18339@subsubheading Synopsis
18340
18341@smallexample
18342 -thread-list-ids
18343@end smallexample
18344
18345Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18346end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18347
18348@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18349
18350Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18351
18352@subsubheading Example
18353
18354No threads present, besides the main process:
18355
18356@smallexample
18357(gdb)
18358-thread-list-ids
18359^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18360(gdb)
18361@end smallexample
18362
18363
18364Several threads:
18365
18366@smallexample
18367(gdb)
18368-thread-list-ids
18369^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18370number-of-threads="3"
18371(gdb)
18372@end smallexample
18373
18374
18375@subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18376@findex -thread-select
18377
18378@subsubheading Synopsis
18379
18380@smallexample
18381 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18382@end smallexample
18383
18384Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18385current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18386
18387@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18388
18389The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18390
18391@subsubheading Example
18392
18393@smallexample
18394(gdb)
18395-exec-next
18396^running
18397(gdb)
18398*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18399file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18400(gdb)
18401-thread-list-ids
18402^done,
18403thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18404number-of-threads="3"
18405(gdb)
18406-thread-select 3
18407^done,new-thread-id="3",
18408frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18409args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18410@{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18411(gdb)
18412@end smallexample
18413
18414@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18415@node GDB/MI Program Execution
18416@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18417
18418These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18419record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
18420asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18421other cases.
18422
18423@subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18424@findex -exec-continue
18425
18426@subsubheading Synopsis
18427
18428@smallexample
18429 -exec-continue
18430@end smallexample
18431
18432Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18433encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18434
18435@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18436
18437The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18438
18439@subsubheading Example
18440
18441@smallexample
18442-exec-continue
18443^running
18444(gdb)
18445@@Hello world
18446*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18447file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18448(gdb)
18449@end smallexample
18450
18451
18452@subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18453@findex -exec-finish
18454
18455@subsubheading Synopsis
18456
18457@smallexample
18458 -exec-finish
18459@end smallexample
18460
18461Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18462function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18463
18464@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18465
18466The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18467
18468@subsubheading Example
18469
18470Function returning @code{void}.
18471
18472@smallexample
18473-exec-finish
18474^running
18475(gdb)
18476@@hello from foo
18477*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18478file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
18479(gdb)
18480@end smallexample
18481
18482Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18483@value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18484value itself.
18485
18486@smallexample
18487-exec-finish
18488^running
18489(gdb)
18490*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18491args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18492file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18493gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18494(gdb)
18495@end smallexample
18496
18497
18498@subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18499@findex -exec-interrupt
18500
18501@subsubheading Synopsis
18502
18503@smallexample
18504 -exec-interrupt
18505@end smallexample
18506
18507Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
18508associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
18509that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
18510appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18511interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18512
18513@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18514
18515The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18516
18517@subsubheading Example
18518
18519@smallexample
18520(gdb)
18521111-exec-continue
18522111^running
18523
18524(gdb)
18525222-exec-interrupt
18526222^done
18527(gdb)
18528111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18529frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18530fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
18531(gdb)
18532
18533(gdb)
18534-exec-interrupt
18535^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18536(gdb)
18537@end smallexample
18538
18539
18540@subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18541@findex -exec-next
18542
18543@subsubheading Synopsis
18544
18545@smallexample
18546 -exec-next
18547@end smallexample
18548
18549Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18550of the next source line is reached.
18551
18552@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18553
18554The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
18555
18556@subsubheading Example
18557
18558@smallexample
18559-exec-next
18560^running
18561(gdb)
18562*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
18563(gdb)
18564@end smallexample
18565
18566
18567@subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
18568@findex -exec-next-instruction
18569
18570@subsubheading Synopsis
18571
18572@smallexample
18573 -exec-next-instruction
18574@end smallexample
18575
18576Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
18577call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
18578instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
18579printed as well.
18580
18581@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18582
18583The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
18584
18585@subsubheading Example
18586
18587@smallexample
18588(gdb)
18589-exec-next-instruction
18590^running
18591
18592(gdb)
18593*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18594addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
18595(gdb)
18596@end smallexample
18597
18598
18599@subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
18600@findex -exec-return
18601
18602@subsubheading Synopsis
18603
18604@smallexample
18605 -exec-return
18606@end smallexample
18607
18608Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
18609Displays the new current frame.
18610
18611@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18612
18613The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
18614
18615@subsubheading Example
18616
18617@smallexample
18618(gdb)
18619200-break-insert callee4
18620200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
18621file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18622(gdb)
18623000-exec-run
18624000^running
18625(gdb)
18626000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18627frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18628file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18629fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18630(gdb)
18631205-break-delete
18632205^done
18633(gdb)
18634111-exec-return
18635111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
18636args=[@{name="strarg",
18637value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18638file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18639fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18640(gdb)
18641@end smallexample
18642
18643
18644@subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
18645@findex -exec-run
18646
18647@subsubheading Synopsis
18648
18649@smallexample
18650 -exec-run
18651@end smallexample
18652
18653Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
18654executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
18655exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
18656the program has exited exceptionally.
18657
18658@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18659
18660The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
18661
18662@subsubheading Examples
18663
18664@smallexample
18665(gdb)
18666-break-insert main
18667^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18668(gdb)
18669-exec-run
18670^running
18671(gdb)
18672*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18673frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18674fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
18675(gdb)
18676@end smallexample
18677
18678@noindent
18679Program exited normally:
18680
18681@smallexample
18682(gdb)
18683-exec-run
18684^running
18685(gdb)
18686x = 55
18687*stopped,reason="exited-normally"
18688(gdb)
18689@end smallexample
18690
18691@noindent
18692Program exited exceptionally:
18693
18694@smallexample
18695(gdb)
18696-exec-run
18697^running
18698(gdb)
18699x = 55
18700*stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
18701(gdb)
18702@end smallexample
18703
18704Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
18705@code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
18706
18707@smallexample
18708(gdb)
18709*stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
18710signal-meaning="Interrupt"
18711@end smallexample
18712
18713
18714@c @subheading -exec-signal
18715
18716
18717@subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
18718@findex -exec-step
18719
18720@subsubheading Synopsis
18721
18722@smallexample
18723 -exec-step
18724@end smallexample
18725
18726Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18727of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
18728function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
18729function.
18730
18731@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18732
18733The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
18734
18735@subsubheading Example
18736
18737Stepping into a function:
18738
18739@smallexample
18740-exec-step
18741^running
18742(gdb)
18743*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18744frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
18745@{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
18746fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
18747(gdb)
18748@end smallexample
18749
18750Regular stepping:
18751
18752@smallexample
18753-exec-step
18754^running
18755(gdb)
18756*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
18757(gdb)
18758@end smallexample
18759
18760
18761@subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
18762@findex -exec-step-instruction
18763
18764@subsubheading Synopsis
18765
18766@smallexample
18767 -exec-step-instruction
18768@end smallexample
18769
18770Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
18771output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
18772we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
18773case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
18774well.
18775
18776@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18777
18778The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
18779
18780@subsubheading Example
18781
18782@smallexample
18783(gdb)
18784-exec-step-instruction
18785^running
18786
18787(gdb)
18788*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18789frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18790fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
18791(gdb)
18792-exec-step-instruction
18793^running
18794
18795(gdb)
18796*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18797frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18798fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
18799(gdb)
18800@end smallexample
18801
18802
18803@subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
18804@findex -exec-until
18805
18806@subsubheading Synopsis
18807
18808@smallexample
18809 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
18810@end smallexample
18811
18812Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
18813argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
18814until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
18815reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
18816
18817@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18818
18819The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
18820
18821@subsubheading Example
18822
18823@smallexample
18824(gdb)
18825-exec-until recursive2.c:6
18826^running
18827(gdb)
18828x = 55
18829*stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18830file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
18831(gdb)
18832@end smallexample
18833
18834@ignore
18835@subheading -file-clear
18836Is this going away????
18837@end ignore
18838
18839@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18840@node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
18841@section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
18842
18843
18844@subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
18845@findex -stack-info-frame
18846
18847@subsubheading Synopsis
18848
18849@smallexample
18850 -stack-info-frame
18851@end smallexample
18852
18853Get info on the selected frame.
18854
18855@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18856
18857The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
18858(without arguments).
18859
18860@subsubheading Example
18861
18862@smallexample
18863(gdb)
18864-stack-info-frame
18865^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
18866file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18867fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
18868(gdb)
18869@end smallexample
18870
18871@subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
18872@findex -stack-info-depth
18873
18874@subsubheading Synopsis
18875
18876@smallexample
18877 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
18878@end smallexample
18879
18880Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
18881is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
18882
18883@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18884
18885There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
18886
18887@subsubheading Example
18888
18889For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
18890
18891@smallexample
18892(gdb)
18893-stack-info-depth
18894^done,depth="12"
18895(gdb)
18896-stack-info-depth 4
18897^done,depth="4"
18898(gdb)
18899-stack-info-depth 12
18900^done,depth="12"
18901(gdb)
18902-stack-info-depth 11
18903^done,depth="11"
18904(gdb)
18905-stack-info-depth 13
18906^done,depth="12"
18907(gdb)
18908@end smallexample
18909
18910@subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
18911@findex -stack-list-arguments
18912
18913@subsubheading Synopsis
18914
18915@smallexample
18916 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
18917 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
18918@end smallexample
18919
18920Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
18921and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
18922@var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
18923call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
18924at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
18925larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
18926@var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
18927which case only existing frames will be returned.
18928
18929The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
189300 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
18931means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
18932
18933@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18934
18935@value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
18936@samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
18937functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
18938
18939@subsubheading Example
18940
18941@smallexample
18942(gdb)
18943-stack-list-frames
18944^done,
18945stack=[
18946frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18947file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18948fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
18949frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
18950file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18951fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
18952frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
18953file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18954fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
18955frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
18956file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18957fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
18958frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
18959file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18960fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
18961(gdb)
18962-stack-list-arguments 0
18963^done,
18964stack-args=[
18965frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
18966frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
18967frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
18968frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
18969frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
18970(gdb)
18971-stack-list-arguments 1
18972^done,
18973stack-args=[
18974frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
18975frame=@{level="1",
18976 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
18977frame=@{level="2",args=[
18978@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
18979@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
18980@{frame=@{level="3",args=[
18981@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
18982@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
18983@{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
18984frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
18985(gdb)
18986-stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
18987^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
18988(gdb)
18989-stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
18990^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
18991args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
18992@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
18993(gdb)
18994@end smallexample
18995
18996@c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
18997
18998
18999@subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19000@findex -stack-list-frames
19001
19002@subsubheading Synopsis
19003
19004@smallexample
19005 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19006@end smallexample
19007
19008List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19009following info:
19010
19011@table @samp
19012@item @var{level}
19013The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
19014@item @var{addr}
19015The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19016@item @var{func}
19017Function name.
19018@item @var{file}
19019File name of the source file where the function lives.
19020@item @var{line}
19021Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19022@end table
19023
19024If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19025whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19026levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19027are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19028an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19029frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19030actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19031
19032@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19033
19034The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19035
19036@subsubheading Example
19037
19038Full stack backtrace:
19039
19040@smallexample
19041(gdb)
19042-stack-list-frames
19043^done,stack=
19044[frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19045 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19046frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19047 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19048frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19049 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19050frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19051 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19052frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19053 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19054frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19055 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19056frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19057 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19058frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19059 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19060frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19061 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19062frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19063 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19064frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19065 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19066frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19067 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19068(gdb)
19069@end smallexample
19070
19071Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19072
19073@smallexample
19074(gdb)
19075-stack-list-frames 3 5
19076^done,stack=
19077[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19078 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19079frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19080 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19081frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19082 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19083(gdb)
19084@end smallexample
19085
19086Show a single frame:
19087
19088@smallexample
19089(gdb)
19090-stack-list-frames 3 3
19091^done,stack=
19092[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19093 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19094(gdb)
19095@end smallexample
19096
19097
19098@subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19099@findex -stack-list-locals
19100
19101@subsubheading Synopsis
19102
19103@smallexample
19104 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19105@end smallexample
19106
19107Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19108@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19109the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19110values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19111type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19112structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19113display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19114other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
19115more detail.
19116
19117@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19118
19119@samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19120
19121@subsubheading Example
19122
19123@smallexample
19124(gdb)
19125-stack-list-locals 0
19126^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19127(gdb)
19128-stack-list-locals --all-values
19129^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19130 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19131-stack-list-locals --simple-values
19132^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19133 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19134(gdb)
19135@end smallexample
19136
19137
19138@subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19139@findex -stack-select-frame
19140
19141@subsubheading Synopsis
19142
19143@smallexample
19144 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19145@end smallexample
19146
19147Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19148the stack.
19149
19150@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19151
19152The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19153@samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19154
19155@subsubheading Example
19156
19157@smallexample
19158(gdb)
19159-stack-select-frame 2
19160^done
19161(gdb)
19162@end smallexample
19163
19164@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19165@node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19166@section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19167
19168@ignore
19169
19170@subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19171
19172For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19173expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19174used by @code{Insight}.
19175
19176The two main reasons for that are:
19177
19178@enumerate 1
19179@item
19180It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19181
19182@item
19183It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19184now).
19185@end enumerate
19186
19187The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19188slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19189describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19190hints about their use.
19191
19192@emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19193expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19194least, the following operations:
19195
19196@itemize @bullet
19197@item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19198@item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19199@item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19200@item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19201@end itemize
19202
19203@end ignore
19204
19205@subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
19206
19207@cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19208
19209Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
19210changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
19211work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
19212simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
19213is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
19214frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
19215expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
19216expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
19217variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
19218operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
19219object, or to change display format.
19220
19221Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
19222that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
19223a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
19224element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
19225children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
19226leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types.
19227
19228For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
19229string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
19230obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
19231that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
19232contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
19233
19234A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
19235the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
19236variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
19237operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
19238be transferred to the frontend.
19239
19240The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19241access this functionality:
19242
19243@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19244@item @strong{Operation}
19245@tab @strong{Description}
19246
19247@item @code{-var-create}
19248@tab create a variable object
19249@item @code{-var-delete}
19250@tab delete the variable object and/or its children
19251@item @code{-var-set-format}
19252@tab set the display format of this variable
19253@item @code{-var-show-format}
19254@tab show the display format of this variable
19255@item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19256@tab tells how many children this object has
19257@item @code{-var-list-children}
19258@tab return a list of the object's children
19259@item @code{-var-info-type}
19260@tab show the type of this variable object
19261@item @code{-var-info-expression}
19262@tab print what this variable object represents
19263@item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19264@tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19265@item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19266@tab get the value of this variable
19267@item @code{-var-assign}
19268@tab set the value of this variable
19269@item @code{-var-update}
19270@tab update the variable and its children
19271@end multitable
19272
19273In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19274how it can be used.
19275
19276@subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19277
19278@subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19279@findex -var-create
19280
19281@subsubheading Synopsis
19282
19283@smallexample
19284 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19285 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19286@end smallexample
19287
19288This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19289a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19290register.
19291
19292The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19293referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19294system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19295unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19296The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19297
19298The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19299specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19300frame should be used.
19301
19302@var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19303begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19304
19305@itemize @bullet
19306@item
19307@samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19308
19309@item
19310@samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19311
19312@item
19313@samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19314@end itemize
19315
19316@subsubheading Result
19317
19318This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19319object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19320the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19321
19322@smallexample
19323 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19324@end smallexample
19325
19326
19327@subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19328@findex -var-delete
19329
19330@subsubheading Synopsis
19331
19332@smallexample
19333 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
19334@end smallexample
19335
19336Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19337With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
19338
19339Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19340
19341
19342@subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19343@findex -var-set-format
19344
19345@subsubheading Synopsis
19346
19347@smallexample
19348 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19349@end smallexample
19350
19351Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19352@var{format-spec}.
19353
19354The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19355
19356@smallexample
19357 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19358 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19359@end smallexample
19360
19361The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
19362based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19363for pointers, etc.).
19364
19365For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
19366variable itself, and the children are not affected.
19367
19368@subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19369@findex -var-show-format
19370
19371@subsubheading Synopsis
19372
19373@smallexample
19374 -var-show-format @var{name}
19375@end smallexample
19376
19377Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19378
19379@smallexample
19380 @var{format} @expansion{}
19381 @var{format-spec}
19382@end smallexample
19383
19384
19385@subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19386@findex -var-info-num-children
19387
19388@subsubheading Synopsis
19389
19390@smallexample
19391 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19392@end smallexample
19393
19394Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19395
19396@smallexample
19397 numchild=@var{n}
19398@end smallexample
19399
19400
19401@subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19402@findex -var-list-children
19403
19404@subsubheading Synopsis
19405
19406@smallexample
19407 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19408@end smallexample
19409@anchor{-var-list-children}
19410
19411Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19412create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19413a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19414@code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19415@var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19416values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19417value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19418and unions.
19419
19420@subsubheading Example
19421
19422@smallexample
19423(gdb)
19424 -var-list-children n
19425 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19426 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19427(gdb)
19428 -var-list-children --all-values n
19429 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19430 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19431@end smallexample
19432
19433
19434@subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19435@findex -var-info-type
19436
19437@subsubheading Synopsis
19438
19439@smallexample
19440 -var-info-type @var{name}
19441@end smallexample
19442
19443Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19444returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19445@value{GDBN} CLI:
19446
19447@smallexample
19448 type=@var{typename}
19449@end smallexample
19450
19451
19452@subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19453@findex -var-info-expression
19454
19455@subsubheading Synopsis
19456
19457@smallexample
19458 -var-info-expression @var{name}
19459@end smallexample
19460
19461Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
19462
19463@smallexample
19464 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
19465@end smallexample
19466
19467@noindent
19468where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
19469
19470@subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
19471@findex -var-show-attributes
19472
19473@subsubheading Synopsis
19474
19475@smallexample
19476 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
19477@end smallexample
19478
19479List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
19480
19481@smallexample
19482 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
19483@end smallexample
19484
19485@noindent
19486where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
19487
19488@subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
19489@findex -var-evaluate-expression
19490
19491@subsubheading Synopsis
19492
19493@smallexample
19494 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
19495@end smallexample
19496
19497Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
19498object and returns its value as a string. The format of the
19499string can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
19500
19501@smallexample
19502 value=@var{value}
19503@end smallexample
19504
19505Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
19506before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
19507
19508@subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
19509@findex -var-assign
19510
19511@subsubheading Synopsis
19512
19513@smallexample
19514 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
19515@end smallexample
19516
19517Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
19518by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
19519value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
19520subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
19521
19522@subsubheading Example
19523
19524@smallexample
19525(gdb)
19526-var-assign var1 3
19527^done,value="3"
19528(gdb)
19529-var-update *
19530^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
19531(gdb)
19532@end smallexample
19533
19534@subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
19535@findex -var-update
19536
19537@subsubheading Synopsis
19538
19539@smallexample
19540 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
19541@end smallexample
19542
19543Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
19544@var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
19545list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
19546be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
19547@code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
19548@code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
19549object names, all existing variable objects are updated. The option
19550@var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
19551names are printed. The possible values of this options are the same
19552as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
19553recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
19554number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
19555
19556
19557@subsubheading Example
19558
19559@smallexample
19560(gdb)
19561-var-assign var1 3
19562^done,value="3"
19563(gdb)
19564-var-update --all-values var1
19565^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
19566type_changed="false"@}]
19567(gdb)
19568@end smallexample
19569
19570@anchor{-var-update}
19571The field in_scope may take three values:
19572
19573@table @code
19574@item "true"
19575The variable object's current value is valid.
19576
19577@item "false"
19578The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
19579hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
19580scope.
19581
19582@item "invalid"
19583The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
19584This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
19585either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
19586command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
19587objects.
19588@end table
19589
19590In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
19591be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
19592
19593@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19594@node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
19595@section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
19596
19597@cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
19598@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
19599This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
19600examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
19601
19602@c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
19603@c @subheading -data-assign
19604@c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
19605@c @subsubheading GDB Command
19606@c set variable
19607@c @subsubheading Example
19608@c N.A.
19609
19610@subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
19611@findex -data-disassemble
19612
19613@subsubheading Synopsis
19614
19615@smallexample
19616 -data-disassemble
19617 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
19618 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
19619 -- @var{mode}
19620@end smallexample
19621
19622@noindent
19623Where:
19624
19625@table @samp
19626@item @var{start-addr}
19627is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
19628@item @var{end-addr}
19629is the end address
19630@item @var{filename}
19631is the name of the file to disassemble
19632@item @var{linenum}
19633is the line number to disassemble around
19634@item @var{lines}
19635is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
19636the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
19637specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
19638@var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
19639@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
19640displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
19641@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
19642are displayed.
19643@item @var{mode}
19644is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
19645disassembly).
19646@end table
19647
19648@subsubheading Result
19649
19650The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
19651
19652@itemize @bullet
19653@item Address
19654@item Func-name
19655@item Offset
19656@item Instruction
19657@end itemize
19658
19659Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
19660directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
19661
19662@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19663
19664There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
19665
19666@subsubheading Example
19667
19668Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
19669
19670@smallexample
19671(gdb)
19672-data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
19673^done,
19674asm_insns=[
19675@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19676inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19677@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19678inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19679@{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
19680inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
19681@{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
19682inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19683@{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
19684inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
19685(gdb)
19686@end smallexample
19687
19688Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
19689@code{main}.
19690
19691@smallexample
19692-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
19693^done,asm_insns=[
19694@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19695inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
19696@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19697inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19698@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19699inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19700[@dots{}]
19701@{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
19702@{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
19703(gdb)
19704@end smallexample
19705
19706Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
19707
19708@smallexample
19709(gdb)
19710-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
19711^done,asm_insns=[
19712@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19713inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
19714@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19715inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19716@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19717inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
19718(gdb)
19719@end smallexample
19720
19721Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
19722
19723@smallexample
19724(gdb)
19725-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
19726^done,asm_insns=[
19727src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
19728file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
19729 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
19730@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19731inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
19732src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
19733file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
19734 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
19735@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19736inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19737@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19738inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
19739(gdb)
19740@end smallexample
19741
19742
19743@subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
19744@findex -data-evaluate-expression
19745
19746@subsubheading Synopsis
19747
19748@smallexample
19749 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
19750@end smallexample
19751
19752Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
19753inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
19754If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
19755
19756@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19757
19758The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
19759@samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
19760@samp{gdb_eval} command.
19761
19762@subsubheading Example
19763
19764In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
19765@dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
19766Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
19767output.
19768
19769@smallexample
19770211-data-evaluate-expression A
19771211^done,value="1"
19772(gdb)
19773311-data-evaluate-expression &A
19774311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
19775(gdb)
19776411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
19777411^done,value="4"
19778(gdb)
19779511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
19780511^done,value="4"
19781(gdb)
19782@end smallexample
19783
19784
19785@subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
19786@findex -data-list-changed-registers
19787
19788@subsubheading Synopsis
19789
19790@smallexample
19791 -data-list-changed-registers
19792@end smallexample
19793
19794Display a list of the registers that have changed.
19795
19796@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19797
19798@value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
19799has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
19800
19801@subsubheading Example
19802
19803On a PPC MBX board:
19804
19805@smallexample
19806(gdb)
19807-exec-continue
19808^running
19809
19810(gdb)
19811*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
19812args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
19813(gdb)
19814-data-list-changed-registers
19815^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
19816"10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
19817"24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
19818(gdb)
19819@end smallexample
19820
19821
19822@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
19823@findex -data-list-register-names
19824
19825@subsubheading Synopsis
19826
19827@smallexample
19828 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
19829@end smallexample
19830
19831Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
19832are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
19833integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
19834names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
19835consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
19836include empty register names.
19837
19838@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19839
19840@value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
19841@samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
19842corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
19843
19844@subsubheading Example
19845
19846For the PPC MBX board:
19847@smallexample
19848(gdb)
19849-data-list-register-names
19850^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
19851"r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
19852"r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
19853"r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
19854"f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
19855"f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
19856"", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
19857(gdb)
19858-data-list-register-names 1 2 3
19859^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
19860(gdb)
19861@end smallexample
19862
19863@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
19864@findex -data-list-register-values
19865
19866@subsubheading Synopsis
19867
19868@smallexample
19869 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
19870@end smallexample
19871
19872Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
19873which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
19874list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
19875numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
19876
19877Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
19878
19879@table @code
19880@item x
19881Hexadecimal
19882@item o
19883Octal
19884@item t
19885Binary
19886@item d
19887Decimal
19888@item r
19889Raw
19890@item N
19891Natural
19892@end table
19893
19894@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19895
19896The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
19897all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
19898
19899@subsubheading Example
19900
19901For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
19902don't appear in the actual output):
19903
19904@smallexample
19905(gdb)
19906-data-list-register-values r 64 65
19907^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
19908@{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
19909(gdb)
19910-data-list-register-values x
19911^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
19912@{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
19913@{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
19914@{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
19915@{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
19916@{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
19917@{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
19918@{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
19919@{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
19920@{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
19921@{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
19922@{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
19923@{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
19924@{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
19925@{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
19926@{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
19927@{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
19928@{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
19929@{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
19930@{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
19931@{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
19932@{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
19933@{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
19934@{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
19935@{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
19936@{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
19937@{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
19938@{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
19939@{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
19940@{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
19941@{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
19942@{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
19943@{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
19944@{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
19945@{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
19946@{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
19947(gdb)
19948@end smallexample
19949
19950
19951@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
19952@findex -data-read-memory
19953
19954@subsubheading Synopsis
19955
19956@smallexample
19957 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
19958 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
19959 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
19960@end smallexample
19961
19962@noindent
19963where:
19964
19965@table @samp
19966@item @var{address}
19967An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
19968read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
19969quoted using the C convention.
19970
19971@item @var{word-format}
19972The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
19973same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
19974,Output Formats}).
19975
19976@item @var{word-size}
19977The size of each memory word in bytes.
19978
19979@item @var{nr-rows}
19980The number of rows in the output table.
19981
19982@item @var{nr-cols}
19983The number of columns in the output table.
19984
19985@item @var{aschar}
19986If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
19987value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
19988member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
19989characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
19990
19991@item @var{byte-offset}
19992An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
19993@end table
19994
19995This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
19996@var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
19997@code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
19998(returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
19999of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20000using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20001in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20002@samp{addr}.
20003
20004The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20005@samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20006@samp{prev-page}.
20007
20008@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20009
20010The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20011@samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20012
20013@subsubheading Example
20014
20015Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20016@code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20017word. Display each word in hex.
20018
20019@smallexample
20020(gdb)
200219-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
200229^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20023next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20024prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20025@{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20026@{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20027@{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20028(gdb)
20029@end smallexample
20030
20031Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20032display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20033
20034@smallexample
20035(gdb)
200365-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
200375^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20038next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20039next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20040@{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20041(gdb)
20042@end smallexample
20043
20044Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20045as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20046used as the non-printable character.
20047
20048@smallexample
20049(gdb)
200504-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
200514^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20052next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20053next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20054@{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20055@{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20056@{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20057@{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20058@{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20059@{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20060@{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20061@{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20062(gdb)
20063@end smallexample
20064
20065@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20066@node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20067@section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20068
20069The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20070
20071@c @subheading -trace-actions
20072
20073@c @subheading -trace-delete
20074
20075@c @subheading -trace-disable
20076
20077@c @subheading -trace-dump
20078
20079@c @subheading -trace-enable
20080
20081@c @subheading -trace-exists
20082
20083@c @subheading -trace-find
20084
20085@c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20086
20087@c @subheading -trace-info
20088
20089@c @subheading -trace-insert
20090
20091@c @subheading -trace-list
20092
20093@c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20094
20095@c @subheading -trace-save
20096
20097@c @subheading -trace-start
20098
20099@c @subheading -trace-stop
20100
20101
20102@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20103@node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20104@section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20105
20106
20107@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20108@findex -symbol-info-address
20109
20110@subsubheading Synopsis
20111
20112@smallexample
20113 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20114@end smallexample
20115
20116Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20117
20118@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20119
20120The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20121
20122@subsubheading Example
20123N.A.
20124
20125
20126@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20127@findex -symbol-info-file
20128
20129@subsubheading Synopsis
20130
20131@smallexample
20132 -symbol-info-file
20133@end smallexample
20134
20135Show the file for the symbol.
20136
20137@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20138
20139There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20140@samp{gdb_find_file}.
20141
20142@subsubheading Example
20143N.A.
20144
20145
20146@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20147@findex -symbol-info-function
20148
20149@subsubheading Synopsis
20150
20151@smallexample
20152 -symbol-info-function
20153@end smallexample
20154
20155Show which function the symbol lives in.
20156
20157@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20158
20159@samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20160
20161@subsubheading Example
20162N.A.
20163
20164
20165@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20166@findex -symbol-info-line
20167
20168@subsubheading Synopsis
20169
20170@smallexample
20171 -symbol-info-line
20172@end smallexample
20173
20174Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20175
20176@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20177
20178The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20179@code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20180
20181@subsubheading Example
20182N.A.
20183
20184
20185@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20186@findex -symbol-info-symbol
20187
20188@subsubheading Synopsis
20189
20190@smallexample
20191 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20192@end smallexample
20193
20194Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20195
20196@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20197
20198The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20199
20200@subsubheading Example
20201N.A.
20202
20203
20204@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20205@findex -symbol-list-functions
20206
20207@subsubheading Synopsis
20208
20209@smallexample
20210 -symbol-list-functions
20211@end smallexample
20212
20213List the functions in the executable.
20214
20215@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20216
20217@samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20218@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20219
20220@subsubheading Example
20221N.A.
20222
20223
20224@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20225@findex -symbol-list-lines
20226
20227@subsubheading Synopsis
20228
20229@smallexample
20230 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20231@end smallexample
20232
20233Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20234addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20235ascending PC order.
20236
20237@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20238
20239There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20240
20241@subsubheading Example
20242@smallexample
20243(gdb)
20244-symbol-list-lines basics.c
20245^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20246(gdb)
20247@end smallexample
20248
20249
20250@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20251@findex -symbol-list-types
20252
20253@subsubheading Synopsis
20254
20255@smallexample
20256 -symbol-list-types
20257@end smallexample
20258
20259List all the type names.
20260
20261@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20262
20263The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20264@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20265
20266@subsubheading Example
20267N.A.
20268
20269
20270@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20271@findex -symbol-list-variables
20272
20273@subsubheading Synopsis
20274
20275@smallexample
20276 -symbol-list-variables
20277@end smallexample
20278
20279List all the global and static variable names.
20280
20281@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20282
20283@samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20284
20285@subsubheading Example
20286N.A.
20287
20288
20289@subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20290@findex -symbol-locate
20291
20292@subsubheading Synopsis
20293
20294@smallexample
20295 -symbol-locate
20296@end smallexample
20297
20298@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20299
20300@samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20301
20302@subsubheading Example
20303N.A.
20304
20305
20306@subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20307@findex -symbol-type
20308
20309@subsubheading Synopsis
20310
20311@smallexample
20312 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20313@end smallexample
20314
20315Show type of @var{variable}.
20316
20317@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20318
20319The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20320@samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20321
20322@subsubheading Example
20323N.A.
20324
20325
20326@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20327@node GDB/MI File Commands
20328@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20329
20330This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20331and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20332
20333@subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20334@findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20335
20336@subsubheading Synopsis
20337
20338@smallexample
20339 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20340@end smallexample
20341
20342Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20343which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20344command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20345are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20346error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20347notification.
20348
20349@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20350
20351The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20352
20353@subsubheading Example
20354
20355@smallexample
20356(gdb)
20357-file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20358^done
20359(gdb)
20360@end smallexample
20361
20362
20363@subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20364@findex -file-exec-file
20365
20366@subsubheading Synopsis
20367
20368@smallexample
20369 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20370@end smallexample
20371
20372Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20373@samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20374from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20375about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20376notification.
20377
20378@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20379
20380The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20381
20382@subsubheading Example
20383
20384@smallexample
20385(gdb)
20386-file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20387^done
20388(gdb)
20389@end smallexample
20390
20391
20392@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
20393@findex -file-list-exec-sections
20394
20395@subsubheading Synopsis
20396
20397@smallexample
20398 -file-list-exec-sections
20399@end smallexample
20400
20401List the sections of the current executable file.
20402
20403@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20404
20405The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
20406information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
20407@samp{gdb_load_info}.
20408
20409@subsubheading Example
20410N.A.
20411
20412
20413@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
20414@findex -file-list-exec-source-file
20415
20416@subsubheading Synopsis
20417
20418@smallexample
20419 -file-list-exec-source-file
20420@end smallexample
20421
20422List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
20423to the current source file for the current executable.
20424
20425@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20426
20427The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
20428
20429@subsubheading Example
20430
20431@smallexample
20432(gdb)
20433123-file-list-exec-source-file
20434123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
20435(gdb)
20436@end smallexample
20437
20438
20439@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
20440@findex -file-list-exec-source-files
20441
20442@subsubheading Synopsis
20443
20444@smallexample
20445 -file-list-exec-source-files
20446@end smallexample
20447
20448List the source files for the current executable.
20449
20450It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
20451the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
20452
20453@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20454
20455The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
20456@code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
20457
20458@subsubheading Example
20459@smallexample
20460(gdb)
20461-file-list-exec-source-files
20462^done,files=[
20463@{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
20464@{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
20465@{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
20466(gdb)
20467@end smallexample
20468
20469@subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
20470@findex -file-list-shared-libraries
20471
20472@subsubheading Synopsis
20473
20474@smallexample
20475 -file-list-shared-libraries
20476@end smallexample
20477
20478List the shared libraries in the program.
20479
20480@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20481
20482The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
20483
20484@subsubheading Example
20485N.A.
20486
20487
20488@subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
20489@findex -file-list-symbol-files
20490
20491@subsubheading Synopsis
20492
20493@smallexample
20494 -file-list-symbol-files
20495@end smallexample
20496
20497List symbol files.
20498
20499@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20500
20501The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
20502
20503@subsubheading Example
20504N.A.
20505
20506
20507@subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
20508@findex -file-symbol-file
20509
20510@subsubheading Synopsis
20511
20512@smallexample
20513 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
20514@end smallexample
20515
20516Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
20517used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
20518produced, except for a completion notification.
20519
20520@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20521
20522The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
20523
20524@subsubheading Example
20525
20526@smallexample
20527(gdb)
20528-file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20529^done
20530(gdb)
20531@end smallexample
20532
20533@ignore
20534@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20535@node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
20536@section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
20537
20538The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
20539
20540@c @subheading -overlay-auto
20541
20542@c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
20543
20544@c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
20545
20546@c @subheading -overlay-map
20547
20548@c @subheading -overlay-off
20549
20550@c @subheading -overlay-on
20551
20552@c @subheading -overlay-unmap
20553
20554@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20555@node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
20556@section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
20557
20558Signal handling commands are not implemented.
20559
20560@c @subheading -signal-handle
20561
20562@c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
20563
20564@c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
20565@end ignore
20566
20567
20568@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20569@node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
20570@section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
20571
20572
20573@subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
20574@findex -target-attach
20575
20576@subsubheading Synopsis
20577
20578@smallexample
20579 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
20580@end smallexample
20581
20582Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
20583
20584@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20585
20586The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
20587
20588@subsubheading Example
20589N.A.
20590
20591
20592@subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
20593@findex -target-compare-sections
20594
20595@subsubheading Synopsis
20596
20597@smallexample
20598 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
20599@end smallexample
20600
20601Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
20602Without the argument, all sections are compared.
20603
20604@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20605
20606The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
20607
20608@subsubheading Example
20609N.A.
20610
20611
20612@subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
20613@findex -target-detach
20614
20615@subsubheading Synopsis
20616
20617@smallexample
20618 -target-detach
20619@end smallexample
20620
20621Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
20622There's no output.
20623
20624@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20625
20626The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
20627
20628@subsubheading Example
20629
20630@smallexample
20631(gdb)
20632-target-detach
20633^done
20634(gdb)
20635@end smallexample
20636
20637
20638@subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
20639@findex -target-disconnect
20640
20641@subsubheading Synopsis
20642
20643@smallexample
20644 -target-disconnect
20645@end smallexample
20646
20647Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
20648generally not resumed.
20649
20650@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20651
20652The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
20653
20654@subsubheading Example
20655
20656@smallexample
20657(gdb)
20658-target-disconnect
20659^done
20660(gdb)
20661@end smallexample
20662
20663
20664@subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
20665@findex -target-download
20666
20667@subsubheading Synopsis
20668
20669@smallexample
20670 -target-download
20671@end smallexample
20672
20673Loads the executable onto the remote target.
20674It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
20675
20676@table @samp
20677@item section
20678The name of the section.
20679@item section-sent
20680The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
20681@item section-size
20682The size of the section.
20683@item total-sent
20684The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
20685@item total-size
20686The size of the overall executable to download.
20687@end table
20688
20689@noindent
20690Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
20691@sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
20692
20693In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
20694downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
20695
20696@table @samp
20697@item section
20698The name of the section.
20699@item section-size
20700The size of the section.
20701@item total-size
20702The size of the overall executable to download.
20703@end table
20704
20705@noindent
20706At the end, a summary is printed.
20707
20708@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20709
20710The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
20711
20712@subsubheading Example
20713
20714Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
20715have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
20716
20717@smallexample
20718(gdb)
20719-target-download
20720+download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
20721+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
20722total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
20723+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
20724total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
20725+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
20726total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
20727+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
20728total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
20729+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
20730total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
20731+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
20732total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
20733+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
20734total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
20735+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
20736total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
20737+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
20738total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
20739+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
20740total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
20741+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
20742total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
20743+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
20744total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
20745+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
20746total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
20747+download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
20748+download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
20749+download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
20750+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
20751total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
20752+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
20753total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
20754+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
20755total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
20756+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
20757total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
20758+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
20759total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
20760+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
20761total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
20762^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
20763write-rate="429"
20764(gdb)
20765@end smallexample
20766
20767
20768@subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
20769@findex -target-exec-status
20770
20771@subsubheading Synopsis
20772
20773@smallexample
20774 -target-exec-status
20775@end smallexample
20776
20777Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
20778not, for instance).
20779
20780@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20781
20782There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
20783
20784@subsubheading Example
20785N.A.
20786
20787
20788@subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
20789@findex -target-list-available-targets
20790
20791@subsubheading Synopsis
20792
20793@smallexample
20794 -target-list-available-targets
20795@end smallexample
20796
20797List the possible targets to connect to.
20798
20799@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20800
20801The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
20802
20803@subsubheading Example
20804N.A.
20805
20806
20807@subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
20808@findex -target-list-current-targets
20809
20810@subsubheading Synopsis
20811
20812@smallexample
20813 -target-list-current-targets
20814@end smallexample
20815
20816Describe the current target.
20817
20818@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20819
20820The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
20821other things).
20822
20823@subsubheading Example
20824N.A.
20825
20826
20827@subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
20828@findex -target-list-parameters
20829
20830@subsubheading Synopsis
20831
20832@smallexample
20833 -target-list-parameters
20834@end smallexample
20835
20836@c ????
20837
20838@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20839
20840No equivalent.
20841
20842@subsubheading Example
20843N.A.
20844
20845
20846@subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
20847@findex -target-select
20848
20849@subsubheading Synopsis
20850
20851@smallexample
20852 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
20853@end smallexample
20854
20855Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
20856
20857@table @samp
20858@item @var{type}
20859The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
20860@item @var{parameters}
20861Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
20862Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
20863@end table
20864
20865The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
20866which the target program is, in the following form:
20867
20868@smallexample
20869^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
20870 args=[@var{arg list}]
20871@end smallexample
20872
20873@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20874
20875The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
20876
20877@subsubheading Example
20878
20879@smallexample
20880(gdb)
20881-target-select async /dev/ttya
20882^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
20883(gdb)
20884@end smallexample
20885
20886@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20887@node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
20888@section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
20889
20890@c @subheading -gdb-complete
20891
20892@subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
20893@findex -gdb-exit
20894
20895@subsubheading Synopsis
20896
20897@smallexample
20898 -gdb-exit
20899@end smallexample
20900
20901Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
20902
20903@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20904
20905Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
20906
20907@subsubheading Example
20908
20909@smallexample
20910(gdb)
20911-gdb-exit
20912^exit
20913@end smallexample
20914
20915
20916@subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
20917@findex -exec-abort
20918
20919@subsubheading Synopsis
20920
20921@smallexample
20922 -exec-abort
20923@end smallexample
20924
20925Kill the inferior running program.
20926
20927@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20928
20929The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
20930
20931@subsubheading Example
20932N.A.
20933
20934
20935@subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
20936@findex -gdb-set
20937
20938@subsubheading Synopsis
20939
20940@smallexample
20941 -gdb-set
20942@end smallexample
20943
20944Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
20945@c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
20946
20947@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20948
20949The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
20950
20951@subsubheading Example
20952
20953@smallexample
20954(gdb)
20955-gdb-set $foo=3
20956^done
20957(gdb)
20958@end smallexample
20959
20960
20961@subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
20962@findex -gdb-show
20963
20964@subsubheading Synopsis
20965
20966@smallexample
20967 -gdb-show
20968@end smallexample
20969
20970Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
20971
20972@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20973
20974The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
20975
20976@subsubheading Example
20977
20978@smallexample
20979(gdb)
20980-gdb-show annotate
20981^done,value="0"
20982(gdb)
20983@end smallexample
20984
20985@c @subheading -gdb-source
20986
20987
20988@subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
20989@findex -gdb-version
20990
20991@subsubheading Synopsis
20992
20993@smallexample
20994 -gdb-version
20995@end smallexample
20996
20997Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
20998
20999@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21000
21001The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21002default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21003
21004@subsubheading Example
21005
21006@c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21007@c box in TeX.
21008@smallexample
21009(gdb)
21010-gdb-version
21011~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21012~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21013~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21014~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21015~ certain conditions.
21016~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21017~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21018~ details.
21019~This GDB was configured as
21020 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21021^done
21022(gdb)
21023@end smallexample
21024
21025@subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21026@findex -interpreter-exec
21027
21028@subheading Synopsis
21029
21030@smallexample
21031-interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21032@end smallexample
21033@anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21034
21035Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21036
21037@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21038
21039The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21040
21041@subheading Example
21042
21043@smallexample
21044(gdb)
21045-interpreter-exec console "break main"
21046&"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21047&"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21048~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21049^done
21050(gdb)
21051@end smallexample
21052
21053@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21054@findex -inferior-tty-set
21055
21056@subheading Synopsis
21057
21058@smallexample
21059-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21060@end smallexample
21061
21062Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21063
21064@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21065
21066The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21067
21068@subheading Example
21069
21070@smallexample
21071(gdb)
21072-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21073^done
21074(gdb)
21075@end smallexample
21076
21077@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21078@findex -inferior-tty-show
21079
21080@subheading Synopsis
21081
21082@smallexample
21083-inferior-tty-show
21084@end smallexample
21085
21086Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21087
21088@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21089
21090The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21091
21092@subheading Example
21093
21094@smallexample
21095(gdb)
21096-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21097^done
21098(gdb)
21099-inferior-tty-show
21100^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21101(gdb)
21102@end smallexample
21103
21104@subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
21105@findex -enable-timings
21106
21107@subheading Synopsis
21108
21109@smallexample
21110-enable-timings [yes | no]
21111@end smallexample
21112
21113Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
21114command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
21115developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
21116equivalent to @samp{yes}.
21117
21118@subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21119
21120No equivalent.
21121
21122@subheading Example
21123
21124@smallexample
21125(gdb)
21126-enable-timings
21127^done
21128(gdb)
21129-break-insert main
21130^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
21131addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
21132fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
21133time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
21134(gdb)
21135-enable-timings no
21136^done
21137(gdb)
21138-exec-run
21139^running
21140(gdb)
21141*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
21142frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
21143@{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
21144fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
21145(gdb)
21146@end smallexample
21147
21148@node Annotations
21149@chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21150
21151This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21152designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21153similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21154relatively high level.
21155
21156The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21157(@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21158
21159@ignore
21160This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21161@end ignore
21162
21163@menu
21164* Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21165* Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21166* Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21167* Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21168* Annotations for Running::
21169 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21170* Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21171@end menu
21172
21173@node Annotations Overview
21174@section What is an Annotation?
21175@cindex annotations
21176
21177Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21178characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21179information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21180is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21181information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21182additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21183cannot contain newline characters.
21184
21185Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21186characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21187no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21188@samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21189annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21190means those three characters as output.
21191
21192The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21193@option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21194how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21195values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21196is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21197subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21198for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21199been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21200Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21201
21202@table @code
21203@kindex set annotate
21204@item set annotate @var{level}
21205The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21206annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21207
21208@item show annotate
21209@kindex show annotate
21210Show the current annotation level.
21211@end table
21212
21213This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21214
21215A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21216
21217@smallexample
21218$ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21219GNU gdb 6.0
21220Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21221GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21222and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21223under certain conditions.
21224Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21225There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21226for details.
21227This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21228
21229^Z^Zpre-prompt
21230(@value{GDBP})
21231^Z^Zprompt
21232@kbd{quit}
21233
21234^Z^Zpost-prompt
21235$
21236@end smallexample
21237
21238Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21239@value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21240denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21241output from @value{GDBN}.
21242
21243@node Prompting
21244@section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21245
21246@cindex annotations for prompts
21247When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21248to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21249over, etc.
21250
21251Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21252input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21253denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21254annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21255annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21256associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21257features the following annotations:
21258
21259@smallexample
21260^Z^Zpre-prompt
21261^Z^Zprompt
21262^Z^Zpost-prompt
21263@end smallexample
21264
21265The input types are
21266
21267@table @code
21268@findex pre-prompt annotation
21269@findex prompt annotation
21270@findex post-prompt annotation
21271@item prompt
21272When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21273
21274@findex pre-commands annotation
21275@findex commands annotation
21276@findex post-commands annotation
21277@item commands
21278When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21279command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21280
21281@findex pre-overload-choice annotation
21282@findex overload-choice annotation
21283@findex post-overload-choice annotation
21284@item overload-choice
21285When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21286
21287@findex pre-query annotation
21288@findex query annotation
21289@findex post-query annotation
21290@item query
21291When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21292
21293@findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
21294@findex prompt-for-continue annotation
21295@findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
21296@item prompt-for-continue
21297When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21298expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21299prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21300presence of annotations.
21301@end table
21302
21303@node Errors
21304@section Errors
21305@cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21306
21307@findex quit annotation
21308@smallexample
21309^Z^Zquit
21310@end smallexample
21311
21312This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21313
21314@findex error annotation
21315@smallexample
21316^Z^Zerror
21317@end smallexample
21318
21319This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21320
21321Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21322in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21323@code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21324cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21325cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21326does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21327to the top level.
21328
21329@findex error-begin annotation
21330A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
21331
21332@smallexample
21333^Z^Zerror-begin
21334@end smallexample
21335
21336Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
21337message.
21338
21339Warning messages are not yet annotated.
21340@c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
21341@c range_error(), and possibly other places.
21342
21343@node Invalidation
21344@section Invalidation Notices
21345
21346@cindex annotations for invalidation messages
21347The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
21348changed.
21349
21350@table @code
21351@findex frames-invalid annotation
21352@item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
21353
21354The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
21355have changed.
21356
21357@findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
21358@item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
21359
21360The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
21361deleted a breakpoint.
21362@end table
21363
21364@node Annotations for Running
21365@section Running the Program
21366@cindex annotations for running programs
21367
21368@findex starting annotation
21369@findex stopping annotation
21370When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
21371@code{step} or @code{continue},
21372
21373@smallexample
21374^Z^Zstarting
21375@end smallexample
21376
21377is output. When the program stops,
21378
21379@smallexample
21380^Z^Zstopped
21381@end smallexample
21382
21383is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
21384annotations describe how the program stopped.
21385
21386@table @code
21387@findex exited annotation
21388@item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
21389The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
21390successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
21391
21392@findex signalled annotation
21393@findex signal-name annotation
21394@findex signal-name-end annotation
21395@findex signal-string annotation
21396@findex signal-string-end annotation
21397@item ^Z^Zsignalled
21398The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
21399annotation continues:
21400
21401@smallexample
21402@var{intro-text}
21403^Z^Zsignal-name
21404@var{name}
21405^Z^Zsignal-name-end
21406@var{middle-text}
21407^Z^Zsignal-string
21408@var{string}
21409^Z^Zsignal-string-end
21410@var{end-text}
21411@end smallexample
21412
21413@noindent
21414where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
21415@code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
21416as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
21417@var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
21418user's benefit and have no particular format.
21419
21420@findex signal annotation
21421@item ^Z^Zsignal
21422The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
21423just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
21424terminated with it.
21425
21426@findex breakpoint annotation
21427@item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
21428The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
21429
21430@findex watchpoint annotation
21431@item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
21432The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
21433@end table
21434
21435@node Source Annotations
21436@section Displaying Source
21437@cindex annotations for source display
21438
21439@findex source annotation
21440The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
21441
21442@smallexample
21443^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
21444@end smallexample
21445
21446where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
21447file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
21448first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
21449within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
21450debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
21451@var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
21452line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
21453@var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
21454source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
21455followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
21456depend on the language).
21457
21458@node GDB Bugs
21459@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
21460@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
21461@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
21462
21463Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
21464
21465Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
21466may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
21467the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
21468reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
21469
21470In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
21471information that enables us to fix the bug.
21472
21473@menu
21474* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
21475* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
21476@end menu
21477
21478@node Bug Criteria
21479@section Have You Found a Bug?
21480@cindex bug criteria
21481
21482If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
21483
21484@itemize @bullet
21485@cindex fatal signal
21486@cindex debugger crash
21487@cindex crash of debugger
21488@item
21489If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
21490@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
21491
21492@cindex error on valid input
21493@item
21494If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
21495bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
21496somewhere in the connection to the target.)
21497
21498@cindex invalid input
21499@item
21500If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
21501that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
21502``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
21503for traditional practice''.
21504
21505@item
21506If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
21507for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
21508@end itemize
21509
21510@node Bug Reporting
21511@section How to Report Bugs
21512@cindex bug reports
21513@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
21514
21515A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
21516If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
21517contact that organization first.
21518
21519You can find contact information for many support companies and
21520individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
21521distribution.
21522@c should add a web page ref...
21523
21524In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
21525@value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
21526@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
21527page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
21528be used.
21529
21530@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
21531@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
21532not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
21533@samp{bug-gdb}.
21534
21535The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
21536serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
21537the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
21538newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
21539problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
21540path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
21541we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
21542bug reports to the mailing list.
21543
21544The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
21545@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
21546fact or leave it out, state it!
21547
21548Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
21549problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
21550assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
21551Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
21552stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
21553name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
21554of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
21555the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
21556easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
21557
21558Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
21559bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
21560you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
21561self-contained.
21562
21563Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
21564bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
21565@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
21566bugs properly.
21567
21568To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
21569
21570@itemize @bullet
21571@item
21572The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
21573with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
21574version}.
21575
21576Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
21577the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
21578
21579@item
21580The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
21581version number.
21582
21583@item
21584What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
21585``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
21586
21587@item
21588What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
21589debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
21590C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
21591to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
21592those compilers.
21593
21594@item
21595The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
21596observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
21597you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
21598Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
21599
21600If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
21601and then we might not encounter the bug.
21602
21603@item
21604A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
21605reproduce the bug.
21606
21607@item
21608A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
21609incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
21610
21611Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
21612will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
21613not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
21614a chance to make a mistake.
21615
21616Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
21617say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
21618copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
21619the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
21620crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
21621ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
21622us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
21623to draw any conclusion from our observations.
21624
21625@pindex script
21626@cindex recording a session script
21627To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
21628such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
21629Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
21630include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
21631
21632Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
21633inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
21634
21635@item
21636If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
21637diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
21638it by context, not by line number.
21639
21640The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
21641sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
21642
21643@end itemize
21644
21645Here are some things that are not necessary:
21646
21647@itemize @bullet
21648@item
21649A description of the envelope of the bug.
21650
21651Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
21652which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
21653changes will not affect it.
21654
21655This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
21656will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
21657with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
21658We recommend that you save your time for something else.
21659
21660Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
21661of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
21662output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
21663less time, and so on.
21664
21665However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
21666report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
21667
21668@item
21669A patch for the bug.
21670
21671A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
21672the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
21673a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
21674to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
21675
21676Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
21677construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
21678through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
21679to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
21680
21681And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
21682patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
21683help us to understand.
21684
21685@item
21686A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
21687
21688Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
21689things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
21690@end itemize
21691
21692@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
21693@c and consists of the two following files:
21694@c rluser.texinfo
21695@c inc-hist.texinfo
21696@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
21697@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
21698@include rluser.texi
21699@include inc-hist.texinfo
21700
21701
21702@node Formatting Documentation
21703@appendix Formatting Documentation
21704
21705@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
21706@cindex reference card
21707The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
21708for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
21709subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
21710@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
21711release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
21712you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
21713
21714The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
21715can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
21716
21717@smallexample
21718make refcard.dvi
21719@end smallexample
21720
21721The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
21722mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
21723that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
21724high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
21725your @sc{dvi} output program.
21726
21727@cindex documentation
21728
21729All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
21730distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
21731a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
21732on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
21733formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
21734and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
21735
21736@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
21737version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
21738file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
21739subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
21740necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
21741but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
21742Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
21743@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
21744
21745If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
21746Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
21747@code{makeinfo}.
21748
21749If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
21750@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
21751version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
21752
21753@smallexample
21754cd gdb
21755make gdb.info
21756@end smallexample
21757
21758If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
21759a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
21760Texinfo definitions file.
21761
21762@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
21763produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
21764document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
21765has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
21766command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
21767(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
21768require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
21769
21770@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
21771@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
21772written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
21773typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
21774and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
21775directory.
21776
21777If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
21778typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
21779subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
21780@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
21781
21782@smallexample
21783make gdb.dvi
21784@end smallexample
21785
21786Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
21787
21788@node Installing GDB
21789@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
21790@cindex installation
21791
21792@menu
21793* Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
21794* Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
21795* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
21796* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
21797* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
21798@end menu
21799
21800@node Requirements
21801@section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
21802@cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
21803
21804Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
21805Other packages will be used only if they are found.
21806
21807@heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
21808@table @asis
21809@item ISO C90 compiler
21810@value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
21811working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
21812
21813@end table
21814
21815@heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
21816@table @asis
21817@item Expat
21818@anchor{Expat}
21819@value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
21820included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
21821can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
21822The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
21823standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
21824use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
21825
21826Expat is used for remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
21827and for target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions}).
21828
21829@end table
21830
21831@node Running Configure
21832@section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
21833@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
21834@value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
21835of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
21836build the @code{gdb} program.
21837@iftex
21838@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
21839@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
21840look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
21841installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
21842@end iftex
21843
21844The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
21845@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
21846appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
21847
21848For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
21849@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
21850
21851@table @code
21852@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
21853script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
21854
21855@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
21856the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
21857
21858@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
21859source for the Binary File Descriptor library
21860
21861@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
21862@sc{gnu} include files
21863
21864@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
21865source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
21866
21867@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
21868source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
21869
21870@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
21871source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
21872
21873@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
21874source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
21875
21876@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
21877source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
21878@end table
21879
21880The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
21881from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
21882this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
21883
21884First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
21885if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
21886identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
21887argument.
21888
21889For example:
21890
21891@smallexample
21892cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
21893./configure @var{host}
21894make
21895@end smallexample
21896
21897@noindent
21898where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
21899@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
21900(You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
21901correct value by examining your system.)
21902
21903Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
21904@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
21905libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
21906binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
21907
21908@need 750
21909@file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
21910system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
21911shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
21912
21913@smallexample
21914sh configure @var{host}
21915@end smallexample
21916
21917If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
21918directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
21919@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
21920@file{configure}
21921creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
21922you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
21923
21924You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
21925source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
21926@file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
21927that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
21928if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
21929of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
21930configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
21931directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
21932about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
21933
21934You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
21935However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
21936the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
21937that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
21938let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
21939
21940@node Separate Objdir
21941@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
21942
21943If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
21944you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
21945host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
21946allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
21947rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
21948handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
21949@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
21950program specified there.
21951
21952To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
21953with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
21954(You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
21955itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
21956would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
21957the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
21958
21959For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
21960separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
21961
21962@smallexample
21963@group
21964cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
21965mkdir ../gdb-sun4
21966cd ../gdb-sun4
21967../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
21968make
21969@end group
21970@end smallexample
21971
21972When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
21973directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
21974(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
21975the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
21976directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
21977@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
21978
21979Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
21980instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
21981like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
21982one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
21983build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
21984
21985One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
21986directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
21987@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
21988programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
21989You specify a cross-debugging target by
21990giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
21991
21992When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
21993it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
21994called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
21995
21996The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
21997directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
21998directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
21999directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22000will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22001
22002When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22003directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22004if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22005with each other.
22006
22007@node Config Names
22008@section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
22009
22010The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
22011script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22012aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22013of information in the following pattern:
22014
22015@smallexample
22016@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22017@end smallexample
22018
22019For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22020or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22021option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22022
22023The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22024any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22025aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22026@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22027script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22028abbreviations---for example:
22029
22030@smallexample
22031% sh config.sub i386-linux
22032i386-pc-linux-gnu
22033% sh config.sub alpha-linux
22034alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22035% sh config.sub hp9k700
22036hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22037% sh config.sub sun4
22038sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22039% sh config.sub sun3
22040m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22041% sh config.sub i986v
22042Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22043@end smallexample
22044
22045@noindent
22046@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22047directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22048
22049@node Configure Options
22050@section @file{configure} Options
22051
22052Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
22053are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
22054several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22055Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
22056
22057@smallexample
22058configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22059 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22060 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22061 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22062 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22063 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22064 @var{host}
22065@end smallexample
22066
22067@noindent
22068You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22069@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22070@samp{--}.
22071
22072@table @code
22073@item --help
22074Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
22075
22076@item --prefix=@var{dir}
22077Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22078@file{@var{dir}}.
22079
22080@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22081Configure the source to install programs under directory
22082@file{@var{dir}}.
22083
22084@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22085@need 2000
22086@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22087@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22088@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22089Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22090@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22091build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22092directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
22093the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22094directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
22095the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22096@var{dirname}.
22097
22098@item --norecursion
22099Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
22100propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22101
22102@item --target=@var{target}
22103Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22104@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22105programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22106
22107There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22108
22109@item @var{host} @dots{}
22110Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22111
22112There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22113@end table
22114
22115There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22116needed for special purposes only.
22117
22118@node Maintenance Commands
22119@appendix Maintenance Commands
22120@cindex maintenance commands
22121@cindex internal commands
22122
22123In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22124includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22125that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22126provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22127messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22128
22129@table @code
22130@kindex maint agent
22131@item maint agent @var{expression}
22132Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22133This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22134(@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22135
22136@kindex maint info breakpoints
22137@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22138Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22139breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22140internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22141breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22142is shown:
22143
22144@table @code
22145@item breakpoint
22146Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22147
22148@item watchpoint
22149Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22150
22151@item longjmp
22152Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22153@code{longjmp} calls.
22154
22155@item longjmp resume
22156Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22157
22158@item until
22159Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22160
22161@item finish
22162Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22163
22164@item shlib events
22165Shared library events.
22166
22167@end table
22168
22169@kindex maint check-symtabs
22170@item maint check-symtabs
22171Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22172
22173@kindex maint cplus first_component
22174@item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22175Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22176
22177@kindex maint cplus namespace
22178@item maint cplus namespace
22179Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22180
22181@kindex maint demangle
22182@item maint demangle @var{name}
22183Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
22184
22185@kindex maint deprecate
22186@kindex maint undeprecate
22187@cindex deprecated commands
22188@item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22189@itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22190Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22191cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22192argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22193favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22194the replacement as part of the warning.
22195
22196@kindex maint dump-me
22197@item maint dump-me
22198@cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22199Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22200This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22201with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22202
22203@kindex maint internal-error
22204@kindex maint internal-warning
22205@item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22206@itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22207Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22208or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22209or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22210internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22211either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22212@value{GDBN} session.
22213
22214These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22215used as the text of the error or warning message.
22216
22217Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
22218
22219@smallexample
22220(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22221@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22222A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22223debugging may prove unreliable.
22224Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22225Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22226(@value{GDBP})
22227@end smallexample
22228
22229@kindex maint packet
22230@item maint packet @var{text}
22231If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22232then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22233displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22234@samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22235checksum.
22236
22237@kindex maint print architecture
22238@item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22239Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22240@var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22241
22242@kindex maint print dummy-frames
22243@item maint print dummy-frames
22244Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22245
22246@smallexample
22247(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22248@dots{}
22249(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22250Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
2225158 return (a + b);
22252The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22253@dots{}
22254(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
222550x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22256 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22257 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22258(@value{GDBP})
22259@end smallexample
22260
22261Takes an optional file parameter.
22262
22263@kindex maint print registers
22264@kindex maint print raw-registers
22265@kindex maint print cooked-registers
22266@kindex maint print register-groups
22267@item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22268@itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22269@itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22270@itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22271Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22272
22273The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22274the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22275includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22276@code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22277register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22278@value{GDBN} Internals}.
22279
22280These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22281write the information.
22282
22283@kindex maint print reggroups
22284@item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22285Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22286optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22287information.
22288
22289The register groups info looks like this:
22290
22291@smallexample
22292(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22293 Group Type
22294 general user
22295 float user
22296 all user
22297 vector user
22298 system user
22299 save internal
22300 restore internal
22301@end smallexample
22302
22303@kindex flushregs
22304@item flushregs
22305This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22306
22307@kindex maint print objfiles
22308@cindex info for known object files
22309@item maint print objfiles
22310Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22311command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22312and symtabs.
22313
22314@kindex maint print statistics
22315@cindex bcache statistics
22316@item maint print statistics
22317This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
22318about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
22319statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
22320of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
22321defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
22322the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
22323used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
22324sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
22325average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
22326savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
22327lengths.
22328
22329@kindex maint print target-stack
22330@cindex target stack description
22331@item maint print target-stack
22332A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
22333kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
22334so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
22335In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
22336until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
22337address.
22338
22339This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
22340the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
22341
22342@kindex maint print type
22343@cindex type chain of a data type
22344@item maint print type @var{expr}
22345Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
22346can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
22347that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
22348a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
22349data structures, including its flags and contained types.
22350
22351@kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22352@kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22353@item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22354@itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22355Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
22356
22357@cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
22358In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
22359produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
22360reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
22361This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
22362cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
22363compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
22364memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
22365slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
22366
22367@kindex maint set profile
22368@kindex maint show profile
22369@cindex profiling GDB
22370@item maint set profile
22371@itemx maint show profile
22372Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
22373
22374Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
22375command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
22376collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
22377exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
22378if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
22379(often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
22380data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
22381
22382Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
22383compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
22384
22385@kindex maint show-debug-regs
22386@cindex x86 hardware debug registers
22387@item maint show-debug-regs
22388Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
22389registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
22390enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
22391removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
22392triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
22393
22394@kindex maint space
22395@cindex memory used by commands
22396@item maint space
22397Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
22398nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
22399took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
22400by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
22401switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22402
22403@kindex maint time
22404@cindex time of command execution
22405@item maint time
22406Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
22407set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
22408took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
22409This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
22410@option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22411
22412@kindex maint translate-address
22413@item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
22414Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
22415@var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
22416@value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
22417the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
22418the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
22419command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
22420
22421@end table
22422
22423The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
22424@value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
22425
22426@table @code
22427@item set watchdog @var{nsec}
22428@kindex set watchdog
22429@cindex watchdog timer
22430@cindex timeout for commands
22431Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
22432target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
22433reports and error and the command is aborted.
22434
22435@item show watchdog
22436Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
22437@end table
22438
22439@node Remote Protocol
22440@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
22441
22442@menu
22443* Overview::
22444* Packets::
22445* Stop Reply Packets::
22446* General Query Packets::
22447* Register Packet Format::
22448* Tracepoint Packets::
22449* Interrupts::
22450* Examples::
22451* File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
22452* Memory Map Format::
22453@end menu
22454
22455@node Overview
22456@section Overview
22457
22458There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
22459protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
22460machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
22461recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
22462
22463In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
22464transmitted and received data respectfully.
22465
22466@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
22467@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
22468@cindex remote serial protocol
22469All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
22470sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
22471@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
22472@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
22473
22474@smallexample
22475@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22476@end smallexample
22477@noindent
22478
22479@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
22480@noindent
22481The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
22482characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
22483eight bit unsigned checksum).
22484
22485Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
22486specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
22487
22488@smallexample
22489@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22490@end smallexample
22491
22492@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
22493@noindent
22494That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
22495has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
22496since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
22497
22498@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
22499When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
22500response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
22501the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
22502retransmission):
22503
22504@smallexample
22505-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22506<- @code{+}
22507@end smallexample
22508@noindent
22509
22510The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
22511debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
22512the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
22513when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
22514
22515@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
22516exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
22517exceptions).
22518
22519@cindex remote protocol, field separator
22520Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
22521@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
22522@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
22523
22524Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
22525@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
22526would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
22527
22528@cindex remote protocol, binary data
22529@anchor{Binary Data}
22530Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
22531digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
22532protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
22533Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
22534connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
22535binary data.
22536
22537The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
22538as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
22539character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
22540For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
22541bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
22542@code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
22543@samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
22544must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
22545is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
22546(described next).
22547
22548Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
22549means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
22550which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
22551@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
22552where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
22553characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
22554value greater than 126 should not be used.
22555
22556So:
22557@smallexample
22558"@code{0* }"
22559@end smallexample
22560@noindent
22561means the same as "0000".
22562
22563The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
22564error number. That number is not well defined.
22565
22566@cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
22567For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
22568(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
22569protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
22570on that response.
22571
22572A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
22573@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
22574optional.
22575
22576@node Packets
22577@section Packets
22578
22579The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
22580@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
22581@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
22582I/O extension of the remote protocol.
22583
22584Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
22585syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
22586include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
22587part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
22588separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
22589@var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
22590bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
22591@var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
22592@samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
22593@var{baz}.
22594
22595Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
22596letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
22597
22598Here are the packet descriptions.
22599
22600@table @samp
22601
22602@item !
22603@cindex @samp{!} packet
22604Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
22605persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
22606debugged.
22607
22608Reply:
22609@table @samp
22610@item OK
22611The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
22612@end table
22613
22614@item ?
22615@cindex @samp{?} packet
22616Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
22617step and continue.
22618
22619Reply:
22620@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22621
22622@item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
22623@cindex @samp{A} packet
22624Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
22625specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
22626@var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
22627
22628Reply:
22629@table @samp
22630@item OK
22631The arguments were set.
22632@item E @var{NN}
22633An error occurred.
22634@end table
22635
22636@item b @var{baud}
22637@cindex @samp{b} packet
22638(Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
22639Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
22640
22641JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
22642received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
22643problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
22644
22645Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
22646it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
22647some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
22648switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
22649of view, nothing actually happened.}
22650
22651@item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
22652@cindex @samp{B} packet
22653Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
22654breakpoint at @var{addr}.
22655
22656Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
22657(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
22658
22659@item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
22660@cindex @samp{c} packet
22661Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
22662resume at current address.
22663
22664Reply:
22665@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22666
22667@item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
22668@cindex @samp{C} packet
22669Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
22670@samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
22671
22672Reply:
22673@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22674
22675@item d
22676@cindex @samp{d} packet
22677Toggle debug flag.
22678
22679Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
22680(@pxref{General Query Packets}).
22681
22682@item D
22683@cindex @samp{D} packet
22684Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
22685before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
22686
22687Reply:
22688@table @samp
22689@item OK
22690for success
22691@item E @var{NN}
22692for an error
22693@end table
22694
22695@item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
22696@cindex @samp{F} packet
22697A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
22698This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
22699Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
22700
22701@item g
22702@anchor{read registers packet}
22703@cindex @samp{g} packet
22704Read general registers.
22705
22706Reply:
22707@table @samp
22708@item @var{XX@dots{}}
22709Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
22710with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
22711each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
22712determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros
22713@code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The
22714specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
22715@item E @var{NN}
22716for an error.
22717@end table
22718
22719@item G @var{XX@dots{}}
22720@cindex @samp{G} packet
22721Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
22722description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
22723
22724Reply:
22725@table @samp
22726@item OK
22727for success
22728@item E @var{NN}
22729for an error
22730@end table
22731
22732@item H @var{c} @var{t}
22733@cindex @samp{H} packet
22734Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
22735@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
22736should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
22737operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
22738the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
22739
22740Reply:
22741@table @samp
22742@item OK
22743for success
22744@item E @var{NN}
22745for an error
22746@end table
22747
22748@c FIXME: JTC:
22749@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
22750@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
22751@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
22752@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
22753@c described. For example:
22754@c
22755@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22756@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
22757@c otherwise returns current registers.
22758@c
22759@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22760@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
22761@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
22762
22763@item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
22764@anchor{cycle step packet}
22765@cindex @samp{i} packet
22766Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
22767present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
22768step starting at that address.
22769
22770@item I
22771@cindex @samp{I} packet
22772Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
22773step packet}.
22774
22775@item k
22776@cindex @samp{k} packet
22777Kill request.
22778
22779FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
22780thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
22781thread?)}.
22782
22783@item m @var{addr},@var{length}
22784@cindex @samp{m} packet
22785Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22786Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
22787
22788The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
22789data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
22790and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
22791use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
22792suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
22793@cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
22794@cindex size of remote memory accesses
22795@cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
22796
22797Reply:
22798@table @samp
22799@item @var{XX@dots{}}
22800Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
22801number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
22802server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
22803@item E @var{NN}
22804@var{NN} is errno
22805@end table
22806
22807@item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
22808@cindex @samp{M} packet
22809Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
22810@var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
22811hexadecimal number.
22812
22813Reply:
22814@table @samp
22815@item OK
22816for success
22817@item E @var{NN}
22818for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
22819written).
22820@end table
22821
22822@item p @var{n}
22823@cindex @samp{p} packet
22824Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
22825@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
22826register value is encoded.
22827
22828Reply:
22829@table @samp
22830@item @var{XX@dots{}}
22831the register's value
22832@item E @var{NN}
22833for an error
22834@item
22835Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
22836@end table
22837
22838@item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
22839@anchor{write register packet}
22840@cindex @samp{P} packet
22841Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
22842number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
22843digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
22844
22845Reply:
22846@table @samp
22847@item OK
22848for success
22849@item E @var{NN}
22850for an error
22851@end table
22852
22853@item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
22854@itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
22855@cindex @samp{q} packet
22856@cindex @samp{Q} packet
22857General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
22858described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
22859
22860@item r
22861@cindex @samp{r} packet
22862Reset the entire system.
22863
22864Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
22865
22866@item R @var{XX}
22867@cindex @samp{R} packet
22868Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
22869This packet is only available in extended mode.
22870
22871The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
22872
22873@item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
22874@cindex @samp{s} packet
22875Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
22876@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
22877
22878Reply:
22879@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22880
22881@item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
22882@anchor{step with signal packet}
22883@cindex @samp{S} packet
22884Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
22885requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
22886
22887Reply:
22888@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22889
22890@item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
22891@cindex @samp{t} packet
22892Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
22893@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
22894@var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
22895
22896@item T @var{XX}
22897@cindex @samp{T} packet
22898Find out if the thread XX is alive.
22899
22900Reply:
22901@table @samp
22902@item OK
22903thread is still alive
22904@item E @var{NN}
22905thread is dead
22906@end table
22907
22908@item v
22909Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
22910up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
22911
22912@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
22913@cindex @samp{vCont} packet
22914Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
22915If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
22916threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
22917specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
22918default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
22919Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
22920
22921@table @samp
22922@item c
22923Continue.
22924@item C @var{sig}
22925Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
22926@item s
22927Step.
22928@item S @var{sig}
22929Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
22930@end table
22931
22932The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
22933not supported in @samp{vCont}.
22934
22935Reply:
22936@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22937
22938@item vCont?
22939@cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
22940Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
22941
22942Reply:
22943@table @samp
22944@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
22945The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
22946command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
22947@item
22948The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
22949@end table
22950
22951@item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
22952@cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
22953Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
22954@var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
22955its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
22956flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
22957Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
22958together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
22959stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
22960packet is received.
22961
22962Reply:
22963@table @samp
22964@item OK
22965for success
22966@item E @var{NN}
22967for an error
22968@end table
22969
22970@item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
22971@cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
22972Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
22973is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
22974packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
22975@samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
22976not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
22977(although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
22978have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
22979@samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
22980neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
22981target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
22982
22983
22984Reply:
22985@table @samp
22986@item OK
22987for success
22988@item E.memtype
22989for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
22990@item E @var{NN}
22991for an error
22992@end table
22993
22994@item vFlashDone
22995@cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
22996Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
22997The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
22998@samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
22999@samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23000regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23001request is completed.
23002
23003@item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23004@anchor{X packet}
23005@cindex @samp{X} packet
23006Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23007@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23008@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23009
23010Reply:
23011@table @samp
23012@item OK
23013for success
23014@item E @var{NN}
23015for an error
23016@end table
23017
23018@item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23019@itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23020@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23021@cindex @samp{z} packet
23022@cindex @samp{Z} packets
23023Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23024watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23025@var{length} bytes.
23026
23027Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23028separately.
23029
23030@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23031for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23032remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23033@samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23034avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23035be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23036
23037@item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23038@itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23039@cindex @samp{z0} packet
23040@cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23041Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23042@var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23043
23044A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23045@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23046@var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23047breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23048@sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23049
23050@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23051code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23052overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23053target, is not defined.}
23054
23055Reply:
23056@table @samp
23057@item OK
23058success
23059@item
23060not supported
23061@item E @var{NN}
23062for an error
23063@end table
23064
23065@item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23066@itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23067@cindex @samp{z1} packet
23068@cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23069Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23070address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23071
23072A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23073dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23074
23075@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23076movement.}
23077
23078Reply:
23079@table @samp
23080@item OK
23081success
23082@item
23083not supported
23084@item E @var{NN}
23085for an error
23086@end table
23087
23088@item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23089@itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23090@cindex @samp{z2} packet
23091@cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23092Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23093
23094Reply:
23095@table @samp
23096@item OK
23097success
23098@item
23099not supported
23100@item E @var{NN}
23101for an error
23102@end table
23103
23104@item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23105@itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23106@cindex @samp{z3} packet
23107@cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23108Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23109
23110Reply:
23111@table @samp
23112@item OK
23113success
23114@item
23115not supported
23116@item E @var{NN}
23117for an error
23118@end table
23119
23120@item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23121@itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23122@cindex @samp{z4} packet
23123@cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23124Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23125
23126Reply:
23127@table @samp
23128@item OK
23129success
23130@item
23131not supported
23132@item E @var{NN}
23133for an error
23134@end table
23135
23136@end table
23137
23138@node Stop Reply Packets
23139@section Stop Reply Packets
23140@cindex stop reply packets
23141
23142The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23143receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23144@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23145when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23146number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
23147@value{GDBN} source code.
23148
23149As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23150reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23151syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23152components.
23153
23154@table @samp
23155
23156@item S @var{AA}
23157The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23158number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
23159@var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
23160
23161@item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23162@cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23163The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23164number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
23165@samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
23166and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
23167round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
23168this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
23169@enumerate
23170@item
23171If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23172corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23173series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23174two-digit hex number.
23175@item
23176If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23177hex.
23178@item
23179If @var{n} is @samp{watch}, @samp{rwatch}, or @samp{awatch}, then the
23180packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23181hex.
23182@item
23183Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23184and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23185future.
23186@end enumerate
23187
23188@item W @var{AA}
23189The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23190applicable to certain targets.
23191
23192@item X @var{AA}
23193The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23194
23195@item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23196@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23197written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23198while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23199for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23200
23201@item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23202@var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23203be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23204correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23205@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
23206system calls.
23207
23208@samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23209this very system call.
23210
23211The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23212call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23213with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23214reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23215or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
23216Protocol Extension}, for more details.
23217
23218@end table
23219
23220@node General Query Packets
23221@section General Query Packets
23222@cindex remote query requests
23223
23224Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23225packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23226query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23227sending information to and from the stub.
23228
23229The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23230indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23231@value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23232definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23233conventions:
23234
23235@itemize @bullet
23236@item
23237The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23238@item
23239Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23240letter.
23241@item
23242The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23243lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23244the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23245foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23246@end itemize
23247
23248The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
23249parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
23250separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
23251full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
23252in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
23253with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
23254packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
23255for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
23256are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
23257existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
23258packet.}.
23259
23260Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23261has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23262explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23263templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23264@value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23265
23266Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23267
23268@table @samp
23269
23270@item qC
23271@cindex current thread, remote request
23272@cindex @samp{qC} packet
23273Return the current thread id.
23274
23275Reply:
23276@table @samp
23277@item QC @var{pid}
23278Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
23279@item @r{(anything else)}
23280Any other reply implies the old pid.
23281@end table
23282
23283@item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
23284@cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
23285@cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
23286Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
23287Reply:
23288@table @samp
23289@item E @var{NN}
23290An error (such as memory fault)
23291@item C @var{crc32}
23292The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
23293@end table
23294
23295@item qfThreadInfo
23296@itemx qsThreadInfo
23297@cindex list active threads, remote request
23298@cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
23299@cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
23300Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
23301may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
23302works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
23303obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
23304be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
23305sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
23306
23307NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
23308
23309Reply:
23310@table @samp
23311@item m @var{id}
23312A single thread id
23313@item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
23314a comma-separated list of thread ids
23315@item l
23316(lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
23317@end table
23318
23319In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
23320more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
23321@value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
23322ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
23323with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
23324
23325@item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
23326@cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
23327@cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
23328Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
23329by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
23330
23331@var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
23332thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
23333
23334@var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
23335thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
23336information associated with the variable.)
23337
23338@var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
23339the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
23340a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
23341object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
23342Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
23343differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
23344
23345Reply:
23346@table @samp
23347@item @var{XX}@dots{}
23348Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
23349local storage requested.
23350
23351@item E @var{nn}
23352An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23353
23354@item
23355An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
23356@end table
23357
23358@item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
23359Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
23360digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
23361subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
23362number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
23363(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
23364returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
23365
23366Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
23367
23368Reply:
23369@table @samp
23370@item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
23371Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
23372returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
23373and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
23374digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
23375is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
23376digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
23377@end table
23378
23379@item qOffsets
23380@cindex section offsets, remote request
23381@cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
23382Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
23383image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
23384response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
23385offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
23386
23387Reply:
23388@table @samp
23389@item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy};Bss=@var{zzz}
23390@end table
23391
23392@item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
23393@cindex thread information, remote request
23394@cindex @samp{qP} packet
23395Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
23396encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
23397
23398Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
23399(see below).
23400
23401Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
23402
23403@item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
23404@cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
23405@cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
23406@anchor{QPassSignals}
23407Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
23408Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
23409(@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
23410strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
23411the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
23412reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
23413combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
23414new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
23415@var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
23416
23417Reply:
23418@table @samp
23419@item OK
23420The request succeeded.
23421
23422@item E @var{nn}
23423An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23424
23425@item
23426An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
23427the stub.
23428@end table
23429
23430Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
23431command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
23432This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23433by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23434
23435@item qRcmd,@var{command}
23436@cindex execute remote command, remote request
23437@cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
23438@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
23439execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
23440string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
23441with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
23442packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
23443stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
23444
23445Reply:
23446@table @samp
23447@item OK
23448A command response with no output.
23449@item @var{OUTPUT}
23450A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
23451@item E @var{NN}
23452Indicate a badly formed request.
23453@item
23454An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
23455@end table
23456
23457(Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
23458command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23459conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23460packets.)
23461
23462@item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
23463@cindex supported packets, remote query
23464@cindex features of the remote protocol
23465@cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
23466@anchor{qSupported}
23467Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
23468query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
23469@value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
23470features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
23471at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
23472packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
23473high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
23474be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
23475stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
23476automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
23477reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
23478unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
23479helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
23480versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
23481
23482Reply:
23483@table @samp
23484@item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
23485The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
23486depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
23487possible forms).
23488@item
23489An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
23490or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
23491@end table
23492
23493The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
23494@samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
23495are:
23496
23497@table @samp
23498@item @var{name}=@var{value}
23499The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
23500with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
23501on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
23502@item @var{name}+
23503The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
23504need an associated value.
23505@item @var{name}-
23506The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
23507@item @var{name}?
23508The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
23509@value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
23510needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
23511but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
23512@end table
23513
23514Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
23515supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
23516request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
23517state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
23518a different version of @value{GDBN}.
23519
23520No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
23521are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
23522@var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
23523packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
23524versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
23525for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
23526advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
23527improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
23528responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
23529the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
23530of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
23531describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
23532all the features it supports.
23533
23534Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
23535responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
23536
23537Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
23538should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
23539require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
23540form response.
23541
23542Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
23543@samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
23544in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
23545stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
23546
23547Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
23548mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
23549architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
23550about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
23551stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
23552
23553These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
23554
23555@multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.2 0.2 0.2
23556@c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
23557@c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
23558@item Feature Name
23559@tab Value Required
23560@tab Default
23561@tab Probe Allowed
23562
23563@item @samp{PacketSize}
23564@tab Yes
23565@tab @samp{-}
23566@tab No
23567
23568@item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
23569@tab No
23570@tab @samp{-}
23571@tab Yes
23572
23573@item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
23574@tab No
23575@tab @samp{-}
23576@tab Yes
23577
23578@item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
23579@tab No
23580@tab @samp{-}
23581@tab Yes
23582
23583@item @samp{QPassSignals}
23584@tab No
23585@tab @samp{-}
23586@tab Yes
23587
23588@end multitable
23589
23590These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
23591
23592@table @samp
23593@cindex packet size, remote protocol
23594@item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
23595The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
23596length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
23597transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
23598data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
23599There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
23600stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
23601byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
23602@value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
23603
23604@item qXfer:auxv:read
23605The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
23606(@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
23607
23608@item qXfer:features:read
23609The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
23610(@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
23611
23612@item qXfer:memory-map:read
23613The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
23614(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
23615
23616@item QPassSignals
23617The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
23618(@pxref{QPassSignals}).
23619
23620@end table
23621
23622@item qSymbol::
23623@cindex symbol lookup, remote request
23624@cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
23625Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
23626requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
23627
23628Reply:
23629@table @samp
23630@item OK
23631The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23632@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23633The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
23634@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
23635@samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
23636below.
23637@end table
23638
23639@item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
23640Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
23641
23642@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
23643target has previously requested.
23644
23645@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
23646@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
23647will be empty.
23648
23649Reply:
23650@table @samp
23651@item OK
23652The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23653@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23654The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
23655encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
23656(if available), until the target ceases to request them.
23657@end table
23658
23659@item QTDP
23660@itemx QTFrame
23661@xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23662
23663@item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
23664@cindex thread attributes info, remote request
23665@cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
23666Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
23667the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
23668string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
23669for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
23670displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
23671examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
23672@samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
23673
23674Reply:
23675@table @samp
23676@item @var{XX}@dots{}
23677Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
23678comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
23679the thread's attributes.
23680@end table
23681
23682(Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
23683the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23684conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23685packets.)
23686
23687@item QTStart
23688@itemx QTStop
23689@itemx QTinit
23690@itemx QTro
23691@itemx qTStatus
23692@xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23693
23694@item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23695@cindex read special object, remote request
23696@cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
23697@anchor{qXfer read}
23698Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
23699identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
23700starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
23701encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the object; it can supply
23702additional details about what data to access.
23703
23704Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
23705@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
23706formats, listed below.
23707
23708@table @samp
23709@item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23710@anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
23711Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
23712auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
23713
23714This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23715by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23716
23717@item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23718@anchor{qXfer target description read}
23719Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
23720annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
23721always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
23722
23723This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23724by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23725
23726@item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23727@anchor{qXfer memory map read}
23728Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
23729annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
23730(@pxref{qXfer read}).
23731
23732This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23733by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23734@end table
23735
23736Reply:
23737@table @samp
23738@item m @var{data}
23739Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
23740target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
23741it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
23742block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
23743@var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
23744request.
23745
23746@item l @var{data}
23747Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
23748There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
23749than the @var{length} in the request.
23750
23751@item l
23752The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
23753There is no more data to be read.
23754
23755@item E00
23756The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23757
23758@item E @var{nn}
23759The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
23760@var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23761
23762@item
23763An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
23764the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
23765@end table
23766
23767@item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
23768@cindex write data into object, remote request
23769Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
23770identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
23771into the data. @samp{@var{data}@dots{}} is the binary-encoded data
23772(@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
23773is specific to the object; it can supply additional details about what data
23774to access.
23775
23776No requests of this form are presently in use. This specification
23777serves as a placeholder to document the common format that new
23778specific request specifications ought to use.
23779
23780Reply:
23781@table @samp
23782@item @var{nn}
23783@var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
23784This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
23785
23786@item E00
23787The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23788
23789@item E @var{nn}
23790The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
23791@var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23792
23793@item
23794An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
23795recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
23796@end table
23797
23798@item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
23799Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
23800not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
23801@var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
23802must respond with an empty packet.
23803
23804@end table
23805
23806@node Register Packet Format
23807@section Register Packet Format
23808
23809The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
23810In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
23811sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
23812to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
23813byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
23814most-significant - least-significant.
23815
23816@table @r
23817
23818@item MIPS32
23819
23820All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
2382132 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
23822registers; fsr; fir; fp.
23823
23824@item MIPS64
23825
23826All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
23827thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
23828as @code{MIPS32}.
23829
23830@end table
23831
23832@node Tracepoint Packets
23833@section Tracepoint Packets
23834@cindex tracepoint packets
23835@cindex packets, tracepoint
23836
23837Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
23838tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
23839
23840@table @samp
23841
23842@item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
23843Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
23844is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
23845the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
23846count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
23847present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
23848tracepoint's actions.
23849
23850Replies:
23851@table @samp
23852@item OK
23853The packet was understood and carried out.
23854@item
23855The packet was not recognized.
23856@end table
23857
23858@item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
23859Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
23860@var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
23861this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
23862another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
23863trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
23864specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
23865
23866In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
23867can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
23868is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
23869actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
23870taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
23871@samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
23872tracepoint actions.
23873
23874The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
23875actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
23876following forms:
23877
23878@table @samp
23879
23880@item R @var{mask}
23881Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
23882a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
23883@var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
23884zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
23885not fit in a 32-bit word.
23886
23887@item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
23888Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
23889number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
23890@samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
23891address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
23892@var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
23893values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
23894
23895@item X @var{len},@var{expr}
23896Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
23897it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
23898@ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
23899two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
23900in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
23901packet).
23902
23903@end table
23904
23905Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
23906packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
23907length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
23908action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
23909actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
23910must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
23911``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
23912separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
23913
23914Replies:
23915@table @samp
23916@item OK
23917The packet was understood and carried out.
23918@item
23919The packet was not recognized.
23920@end table
23921
23922@item QTFrame:@var{n}
23923Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
23924register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
23925request packets from @value{GDBN}.
23926
23927A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
23928requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
23929without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
23930one of the following forms:
23931
23932@table @samp
23933@item F @var{f}
23934The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
23935@var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
23936was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
23937
23938@item T @var{t}
23939The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
23940@var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
23941
23942@end table
23943
23944@item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
23945Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
23946currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
23947@var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
23948
23949@item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
23950Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
23951currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
23952is a hexadecimal number.
23953
23954@item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
23955Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
23956currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
23957and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
23958numbers.
23959
23960@item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
23961Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
23962frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
23963
23964@item QTStart
23965Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
23966hits in the trace frame buffer.
23967
23968@item QTStop
23969End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
23970
23971@item QTinit
23972Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
23973
23974@item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
23975Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
23976will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
23977if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
23978
23979@value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
23980containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
23981still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
23982there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
23983
23984@item qTStatus
23985Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
23986
23987Replies:
23988@table @samp
23989@item T0
23990There is no trace experiment running.
23991@item T1
23992There is a trace experiment running.
23993@end table
23994
23995@end table
23996
23997
23998@node Interrupts
23999@section Interrupts
24000@cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
24001
24002When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
24003attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
24004control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
24005setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
24006
24007The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
24008mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
24009not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
24010interfaces.
24011
24012@samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
24013transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
24014@code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
24015the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
24016transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
24017and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
24018(@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
24019@code{0x03} as part of its packet.
24020
24021Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
24022precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
24023implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
24024running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
24025Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
24026of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
24027program is stopped will be discarded.
24028
24029@node Examples
24030@section Examples
24031
24032Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
24033does not get any direct output:
24034
24035@smallexample
24036-> @code{R00}
24037<- @code{+}
24038@emph{target restarts}
24039-> @code{?}
24040<- @code{+}
24041<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24042-> @code{+}
24043@end smallexample
24044
24045Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
24046
24047@smallexample
24048-> @code{G1445@dots{}}
24049<- @code{+}
24050-> @code{s}
24051<- @code{+}
24052@emph{time passes}
24053<- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24054-> @code{+}
24055-> @code{g}
24056<- @code{+}
24057<- @code{1455@dots{}}
24058-> @code{+}
24059@end smallexample
24060
24061@node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24062@section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
24063@cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
24064
24065@menu
24066* File-I/O Overview::
24067* Protocol Basics::
24068* The F Request Packet::
24069* The F Reply Packet::
24070* The Ctrl-C Message::
24071* Console I/O::
24072* List of Supported Calls::
24073* Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
24074* Constants::
24075* File-I/O Examples::
24076@end menu
24077
24078@node File-I/O Overview
24079@subsection File-I/O Overview
24080@cindex file-i/o overview
24081
24082The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
24083target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
24084system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
24085remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
24086actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
24087This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
24088
24089The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
24090It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
24091@value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
24092translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
24093protocol representations when data is transmitted.
24094
24095The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
24096@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24097or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
24098the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
24099memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
24100the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
24101(@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
24102
24103The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
24104the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
24105after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
24106previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
24107request from @value{GDBN} is required.
24108
24109@smallexample
24110(@value{GDBP}) continue
24111 <- target requests 'system call X'
24112 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
24113 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
24114 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
24115 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
24116@end smallexample
24117
24118The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
24119the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
24120named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
24121system are not supported by this protocol.
24122
24123@node Protocol Basics
24124@subsection Protocol Basics
24125@cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
24126
24127The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
24128as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
24129@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
24130the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
24131of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
24132This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
24133to call the appropriate host system call:
24134
24135@itemize @bullet
24136@item
24137A unique identifier for the requested system call.
24138
24139@item
24140All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
24141in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
24142pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
24143Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
24144
24145@end itemize
24146
24147At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
24148
24149@itemize @bullet
24150@item
24151If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
24152system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
24153standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
24154expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
24155packet.
24156
24157@item
24158@value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
24159representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
24160
24161@item
24162@value{GDBN} calls the system call.
24163
24164@item
24165It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
24166
24167@item
24168If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
24169by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
24170target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
24171by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
24172packet.
24173
24174@end itemize
24175
24176Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
24177necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
24178
24179@itemize @bullet
24180@item
24181Return value.
24182
24183@item
24184@code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
24185
24186@item
24187``Ctrl-C'' flag.
24188
24189@end itemize
24190
24191After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
24192the latest continue or step action.
24193
24194@node The F Request Packet
24195@subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
24196@cindex file-i/o request packet
24197@cindex @code{F} request packet
24198
24199The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
24200
24201@table @samp
24202@item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
24203
24204@var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
24205This is just the name of the function.
24206
24207@var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
24208Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
24209of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
24210datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
24211of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
24212comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
24213string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
24214
24215@end table
24216
24217
24218
24219@node The F Reply Packet
24220@subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
24221@cindex file-i/o reply packet
24222@cindex @code{F} reply packet
24223
24224The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
24225
24226@table @samp
24227
24228@item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific
24229attachment}
24230
24231@var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
24232
24233@var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
24234representation.
24235This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
24236
24237@var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
24238case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
24239The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
24240
24241@smallexample
24242F0,0,C
24243@end smallexample
24244
24245@noindent
24246or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
24247
24248@smallexample
24249F-1,4,C
24250@end smallexample
24251
24252@noindent
24253assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
24254
24255@end table
24256
24257
24258@node The Ctrl-C Message
24259@subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
24260@cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
24261
24262If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
24263reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
24264the target should behave as if it had
24265gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
24266interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
24267(as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
24268packet.
24269
24270It's important for the target to know in which
24271state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
24272
24273@itemize @bullet
24274@item
24275The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
24276
24277@item
24278The system call on the host has been finished.
24279
24280@end itemize
24281
24282These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
24283returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
24284call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
24285on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
24286system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
24287as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
24288
24289@value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
24290yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
24291@code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
24292before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
24293@value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
24294The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
24295or the full action has been completed.
24296
24297@node Console I/O
24298@subsection Console I/O
24299@cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
24300
24301By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
24302descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
24303on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
24304(@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
24305by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
243060 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
24307conditions is met:
24308
24309@itemize @bullet
24310@item
24311The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
24312@code{read}
24313system call is treated as finished.
24314
24315@item
24316The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
24317newline.
24318
24319@item
24320The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
24321character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
24322
24323@end itemize
24324
24325If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
24326the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
24327either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
24328is stopped at the user's request.
24329
24330
24331@node List of Supported Calls
24332@subsection List of Supported Calls
24333@cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
24334
24335@menu
24336* open::
24337* close::
24338* read::
24339* write::
24340* lseek::
24341* rename::
24342* unlink::
24343* stat/fstat::
24344* gettimeofday::
24345* isatty::
24346* system::
24347@end menu
24348
24349@node open
24350@unnumberedsubsubsec open
24351@cindex open, file-i/o system call
24352
24353@table @asis
24354@item Synopsis:
24355@smallexample
24356int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
24357int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
24358@end smallexample
24359
24360@item Request:
24361@samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
24362
24363@noindent
24364@var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24365
24366@table @code
24367@item O_CREAT
24368If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
24369rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
24370are concerned.
24371
24372@item O_EXCL
24373When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
24374an error and open() fails.
24375
24376@item O_TRUNC
24377If the file already exists and the open mode allows
24378writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
24379truncated to zero length.
24380
24381@item O_APPEND
24382The file is opened in append mode.
24383
24384@item O_RDONLY
24385The file is opened for reading only.
24386
24387@item O_WRONLY
24388The file is opened for writing only.
24389
24390@item O_RDWR
24391The file is opened for reading and writing.
24392@end table
24393
24394@noindent
24395Other bits are silently ignored.
24396
24397
24398@noindent
24399@var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24400
24401@table @code
24402@item S_IRUSR
24403User has read permission.
24404
24405@item S_IWUSR
24406User has write permission.
24407
24408@item S_IRGRP
24409Group has read permission.
24410
24411@item S_IWGRP
24412Group has write permission.
24413
24414@item S_IROTH
24415Others have read permission.
24416
24417@item S_IWOTH
24418Others have write permission.
24419@end table
24420
24421@noindent
24422Other bits are silently ignored.
24423
24424
24425@item Return value:
24426@code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
24427occurred.
24428
24429@item Errors:
24430
24431@table @code
24432@item EEXIST
24433@var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
24434
24435@item EISDIR
24436@var{pathname} refers to a directory.
24437
24438@item EACCES
24439The requested access is not allowed.
24440
24441@item ENAMETOOLONG
24442@var{pathname} was too long.
24443
24444@item ENOENT
24445A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24446
24447@item ENODEV
24448@var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
24449
24450@item EROFS
24451@var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
24452write access was requested.
24453
24454@item EFAULT
24455@var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
24456
24457@item ENOSPC
24458No space on device to create the file.
24459
24460@item EMFILE
24461The process already has the maximum number of files open.
24462
24463@item ENFILE
24464The limit on the total number of files open on the system
24465has been reached.
24466
24467@item EINTR
24468The call was interrupted by the user.
24469@end table
24470
24471@end table
24472
24473@node close
24474@unnumberedsubsubsec close
24475@cindex close, file-i/o system call
24476
24477@table @asis
24478@item Synopsis:
24479@smallexample
24480int close(int fd);
24481@end smallexample
24482
24483@item Request:
24484@samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
24485
24486@item Return value:
24487@code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
24488
24489@item Errors:
24490
24491@table @code
24492@item EBADF
24493@var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
24494
24495@item EINTR
24496The call was interrupted by the user.
24497@end table
24498
24499@end table
24500
24501@node read
24502@unnumberedsubsubsec read
24503@cindex read, file-i/o system call
24504
24505@table @asis
24506@item Synopsis:
24507@smallexample
24508int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
24509@end smallexample
24510
24511@item Request:
24512@samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24513
24514@item Return value:
24515On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
24516Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
24517returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
24518
24519@item Errors:
24520
24521@table @code
24522@item EBADF
24523@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24524reading.
24525
24526@item EFAULT
24527@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24528
24529@item EINTR
24530The call was interrupted by the user.
24531@end table
24532
24533@end table
24534
24535@node write
24536@unnumberedsubsubsec write
24537@cindex write, file-i/o system call
24538
24539@table @asis
24540@item Synopsis:
24541@smallexample
24542int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
24543@end smallexample
24544
24545@item Request:
24546@samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24547
24548@item Return value:
24549On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
24550Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
24551is returned.
24552
24553@item Errors:
24554
24555@table @code
24556@item EBADF
24557@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24558writing.
24559
24560@item EFAULT
24561@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24562
24563@item EFBIG
24564An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
24565host-specific maximum file size allowed.
24566
24567@item ENOSPC
24568No space on device to write the data.
24569
24570@item EINTR
24571The call was interrupted by the user.
24572@end table
24573
24574@end table
24575
24576@node lseek
24577@unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
24578@cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
24579
24580@table @asis
24581@item Synopsis:
24582@smallexample
24583long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
24584@end smallexample
24585
24586@item Request:
24587@samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
24588
24589@var{flag} is one of:
24590
24591@table @code
24592@item SEEK_SET
24593The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
24594
24595@item SEEK_CUR
24596The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
24597bytes.
24598
24599@item SEEK_END
24600The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
24601bytes.
24602@end table
24603
24604@item Return value:
24605On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
24606the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
24607value of -1 is returned.
24608
24609@item Errors:
24610
24611@table @code
24612@item EBADF
24613@var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
24614
24615@item ESPIPE
24616@var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
24617
24618@item EINVAL
24619@var{flag} is not a proper value.
24620
24621@item EINTR
24622The call was interrupted by the user.
24623@end table
24624
24625@end table
24626
24627@node rename
24628@unnumberedsubsubsec rename
24629@cindex rename, file-i/o system call
24630
24631@table @asis
24632@item Synopsis:
24633@smallexample
24634int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
24635@end smallexample
24636
24637@item Request:
24638@samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
24639
24640@item Return value:
24641On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24642
24643@item Errors:
24644
24645@table @code
24646@item EISDIR
24647@var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
24648directory.
24649
24650@item EEXIST
24651@var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
24652
24653@item EBUSY
24654@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
24655process.
24656
24657@item EINVAL
24658An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
24659of itself.
24660
24661@item ENOTDIR
24662A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
24663path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
24664and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
24665
24666@item EFAULT
24667@var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
24668
24669@item EACCES
24670No access to the file or the path of the file.
24671
24672@item ENAMETOOLONG
24673
24674@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
24675
24676@item ENOENT
24677A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
24678
24679@item EROFS
24680The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24681
24682@item ENOSPC
24683The device containing the file has no room for the new
24684directory entry.
24685
24686@item EINTR
24687The call was interrupted by the user.
24688@end table
24689
24690@end table
24691
24692@node unlink
24693@unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
24694@cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
24695
24696@table @asis
24697@item Synopsis:
24698@smallexample
24699int unlink(const char *pathname);
24700@end smallexample
24701
24702@item Request:
24703@samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
24704
24705@item Return value:
24706On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24707
24708@item Errors:
24709
24710@table @code
24711@item EACCES
24712No access to the file or the path of the file.
24713
24714@item EPERM
24715The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
24716
24717@item EBUSY
24718The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
24719being used by another process.
24720
24721@item EFAULT
24722@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24723
24724@item ENAMETOOLONG
24725@var{pathname} was too long.
24726
24727@item ENOENT
24728A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24729
24730@item ENOTDIR
24731A component of the path is not a directory.
24732
24733@item EROFS
24734The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24735
24736@item EINTR
24737The call was interrupted by the user.
24738@end table
24739
24740@end table
24741
24742@node stat/fstat
24743@unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
24744@cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
24745@cindex stat, file-i/o system call
24746
24747@table @asis
24748@item Synopsis:
24749@smallexample
24750int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
24751int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
24752@end smallexample
24753
24754@item Request:
24755@samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
24756@samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
24757
24758@item Return value:
24759On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24760
24761@item Errors:
24762
24763@table @code
24764@item EBADF
24765@var{fd} is not a valid open file.
24766
24767@item ENOENT
24768A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
24769path is an empty string.
24770
24771@item ENOTDIR
24772A component of the path is not a directory.
24773
24774@item EFAULT
24775@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24776
24777@item EACCES
24778No access to the file or the path of the file.
24779
24780@item ENAMETOOLONG
24781@var{pathname} was too long.
24782
24783@item EINTR
24784The call was interrupted by the user.
24785@end table
24786
24787@end table
24788
24789@node gettimeofday
24790@unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
24791@cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
24792
24793@table @asis
24794@item Synopsis:
24795@smallexample
24796int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
24797@end smallexample
24798
24799@item Request:
24800@samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
24801
24802@item Return value:
24803On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
24804
24805@item Errors:
24806
24807@table @code
24808@item EINVAL
24809@var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
24810
24811@item EFAULT
24812@var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24813@end table
24814
24815@end table
24816
24817@node isatty
24818@unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
24819@cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
24820
24821@table @asis
24822@item Synopsis:
24823@smallexample
24824int isatty(int fd);
24825@end smallexample
24826
24827@item Request:
24828@samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
24829
24830@item Return value:
24831Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
24832
24833@item Errors:
24834
24835@table @code
24836@item EINTR
24837The call was interrupted by the user.
24838@end table
24839
24840@end table
24841
24842Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
248431 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
24844to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
24845would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
24846needed.
24847
24848
24849@node system
24850@unnumberedsubsubsec system
24851@cindex system, file-i/o system call
24852
24853@table @asis
24854@item Synopsis:
24855@smallexample
24856int system(const char *command);
24857@end smallexample
24858
24859@item Request:
24860@samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
24861
24862@item Return value:
24863If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
24864available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
24865For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
24866return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
24867command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
24868return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
24869@file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
24870
24871@item Errors:
24872
24873@table @code
24874@item EINTR
24875The call was interrupted by the user.
24876@end table
24877
24878@end table
24879
24880@value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
24881to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
24882the host is simplified before it's returned
24883to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
24884is discarded, and the return value consists
24885entirely of the exit status of the called command.
24886
24887Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
24888by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
24889@code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
24890
24891@table @code
24892@item set remote system-call-allowed
24893@kindex set remote system-call-allowed
24894Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
24895protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
24896
24897@item show remote system-call-allowed
24898@kindex show remote system-call-allowed
24899Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
24900protocol.
24901@end table
24902
24903@node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
24904@subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
24905@cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
24906
24907@menu
24908* Integral Datatypes::
24909* Pointer Values::
24910* Memory Transfer::
24911* struct stat::
24912* struct timeval::
24913@end menu
24914
24915@node Integral Datatypes
24916@unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
24917@cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
24918
24919The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
24920@code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
24921@code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
24922
24923@code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
24924implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
24925
24926@code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
24927
24928@xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
24929in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
24930
24931@code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
24932
24933All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
24934structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
24935byte order.
24936
24937@node Pointer Values
24938@unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
24939@cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
24940
24941Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
24942is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
24943transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
24944are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
24945
24946@smallexample
24947@code{1aaf/12}
24948@end smallexample
24949
24950@noindent
24951which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
24952The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
24953the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
24954at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
24955
24956@smallexample
24957@code{123456/d}
24958@end smallexample
24959
24960@node Memory Transfer
24961@unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
24962@cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
24963
24964Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
24965example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
24966with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
24967this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
24968packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
24969it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
24970data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
24971
24972
24973@node struct stat
24974@unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
24975@cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
24976
24977The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
24978is defined as follows:
24979
24980@smallexample
24981struct stat @{
24982 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
24983 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
24984 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
24985 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
24986 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
24987 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
24988 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
24989 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
24990 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
24991 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
24992 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
24993 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
24994 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
24995@};
24996@end smallexample
24997
24998The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
24999appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25000structure is of size 64 bytes.
25001
25002The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
25003range of values.
25004
25005@table @code
25006
25007@item st_dev
25008A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
25009
25010@item st_ino
25011No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25012
25013@item st_mode
25014Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
25015bits have currently no meaning for the target.
25016
25017@item st_uid
25018@itemx st_gid
25019@itemx st_rdev
25020No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25021
25022@item st_atime
25023@itemx st_mtime
25024@itemx st_ctime
25025These values have a host and file system dependent
25026accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
25027support exact timing values.
25028@end table
25029
25030The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
25031responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
25032continuing.
25033
25034Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
25035representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
25036get truncated on the target.
25037
25038@node struct timeval
25039@unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
25040@cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
25041
25042The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
25043is defined as follows:
25044
25045@smallexample
25046struct timeval @{
25047 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
25048 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
25049@};
25050@end smallexample
25051
25052The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25053appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
25054structure is of size 8 bytes.
25055
25056@node Constants
25057@subsection Constants
25058@cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
25059
25060The following values are used for the constants inside of the
25061protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
25062values before and after the call as needed.
25063
25064@menu
25065* Open Flags::
25066* mode_t Values::
25067* Errno Values::
25068* Lseek Flags::
25069* Limits::
25070@end menu
25071
25072@node Open Flags
25073@unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
25074@cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
25075
25076All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
25077
25078@smallexample
25079 O_RDONLY 0x0
25080 O_WRONLY 0x1
25081 O_RDWR 0x2
25082 O_APPEND 0x8
25083 O_CREAT 0x200
25084 O_TRUNC 0x400
25085 O_EXCL 0x800
25086@end smallexample
25087
25088@node mode_t Values
25089@unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
25090@cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
25091
25092All values are given in octal representation.
25093
25094@smallexample
25095 S_IFREG 0100000
25096 S_IFDIR 040000
25097 S_IRUSR 0400
25098 S_IWUSR 0200
25099 S_IXUSR 0100
25100 S_IRGRP 040
25101 S_IWGRP 020
25102 S_IXGRP 010
25103 S_IROTH 04
25104 S_IWOTH 02
25105 S_IXOTH 01
25106@end smallexample
25107
25108@node Errno Values
25109@unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
25110@cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
25111
25112All values are given in decimal representation.
25113
25114@smallexample
25115 EPERM 1
25116 ENOENT 2
25117 EINTR 4
25118 EBADF 9
25119 EACCES 13
25120 EFAULT 14
25121 EBUSY 16
25122 EEXIST 17
25123 ENODEV 19
25124 ENOTDIR 20
25125 EISDIR 21
25126 EINVAL 22
25127 ENFILE 23
25128 EMFILE 24
25129 EFBIG 27
25130 ENOSPC 28
25131 ESPIPE 29
25132 EROFS 30
25133 ENAMETOOLONG 91
25134 EUNKNOWN 9999
25135@end smallexample
25136
25137 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
25138 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
25139
25140@node Lseek Flags
25141@unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
25142@cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
25143
25144@smallexample
25145 SEEK_SET 0
25146 SEEK_CUR 1
25147 SEEK_END 2
25148@end smallexample
25149
25150@node Limits
25151@unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
25152@cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
25153
25154All values are given in decimal representation.
25155
25156@smallexample
25157 INT_MIN -2147483648
25158 INT_MAX 2147483647
25159 UINT_MAX 4294967295
25160 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
25161 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
25162 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
25163@end smallexample
25164
25165@node File-I/O Examples
25166@subsection File-I/O Examples
25167@cindex file-i/o examples
25168
25169Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25170address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
25171
25172@smallexample
25173<- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
25174@emph{request memory read from target}
25175-> @code{m1234,6}
25176<- XXXXXX
25177@emph{return "6 bytes written"}
25178-> @code{F6}
25179@end smallexample
25180
25181Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25182address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
25183
25184@smallexample
25185<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25186@emph{request memory write to target}
25187-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25188@emph{return "6 bytes read"}
25189-> @code{F6}
25190@end smallexample
25191
25192Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
25193file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
25194
25195@smallexample
25196<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25197-> @code{F-1,9}
25198@end smallexample
25199
25200Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
25201host is called:
25202
25203@smallexample
25204<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25205-> @code{F-1,4,C}
25206<- @code{T02}
25207@end smallexample
25208
25209Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
25210host is called:
25211
25212@smallexample
25213<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25214-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25215<- @code{T02}
25216@end smallexample
25217
25218@node Memory Map Format
25219@section Memory Map Format
25220@cindex memory map format
25221
25222To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
25223memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
25224memory map.
25225
25226The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
25227(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
25228lists memory regions. The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
25229
25230@smallexample
25231<?xml version="1.0"?>
25232<!DOCTYPE memory-map
25233 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
25234 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
25235<memory-map>
25236 region...
25237</memory-map>
25238@end smallexample
25239
25240Each region can be either:
25241
25242@itemize
25243
25244@item
25245A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
25246bytes from there:
25247
25248@smallexample
25249<memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25250@end smallexample
25251
25252
25253@item
25254A region of read-only memory:
25255
25256@smallexample
25257<memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25258@end smallexample
25259
25260
25261@item
25262A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
25263bytes in length:
25264
25265@smallexample
25266<memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
25267 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
25268</memory>
25269@end smallexample
25270
25271@end itemize
25272
25273Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
25274by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
25275packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
25276
25277The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
25278
25279@smallexample
25280<!-- ................................................... -->
25281<!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
25282<!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
25283<!-- .................................... .............. -->
25284<!-- memory-map.dtd -->
25285<!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
25286<!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
25287<!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
25288<!ELEMENT memory (property)>
25289<!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
25290 and its type, or device. -->
25291<!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
25292 start CDATA #REQUIRED
25293 length CDATA #REQUIRED
25294 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
25295<!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
25296<!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
25297<!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
25298@end smallexample
25299
25300@include agentexpr.texi
25301
25302@node Target Descriptions
25303@appendix Target Descriptions
25304@cindex target descriptions
25305
25306@strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
25307and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
25308The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
25309
25310One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
25311is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
25312architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
25313a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
25314and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
25315architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
25316vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
25317
25318@itemize @bullet
25319@item
25320With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
25321the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
25322@item
25323Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
25324audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
25325variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
25326@item
25327When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
25328at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
25329@command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
25330@end itemize
25331
25332To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
25333target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
25334actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
25335processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
25336descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
25337
25338@value{GDBN} must be compiled with Expat support to support XML target
25339descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
25340
25341@menu
25342* Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
25343* Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
25344* Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
25345 descriptions.
25346* Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
25347@end menu
25348
25349@node Retrieving Descriptions
25350@section Retrieving Descriptions
25351
25352Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
25353specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
25354description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
25355protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
25356qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
25357@samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
25358XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
25359Format}.
25360
25361Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
25362If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
25363specify a file are:
25364
25365@table @code
25366@cindex set tdesc filename
25367@item set tdesc filename @var{path}
25368Read the target description from @var{path}.
25369
25370@cindex unset tdesc filename
25371@item unset tdesc filename
25372Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
25373will use the description supplied by the current target.
25374
25375@cindex show tdesc filename
25376@item show tdesc filename
25377Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
25378@end table
25379
25380
25381@node Target Description Format
25382@section Target Description Format
25383@cindex target descriptions, XML format
25384
25385A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
25386document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
25387the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
25388means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
25389check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
25390However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
25391their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
25392
25393Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
25394and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
25395sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
25396target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
25397
25398Here is a simple target description:
25399
25400@smallexample
25401<target>
25402 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
25403</target>
25404@end smallexample
25405
25406@noindent
25407This minimal description only says that the target uses
25408the x86-64 architecture.
25409
25410A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
25411optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
25412are explained further below.
25413
25414@smallexample
25415<?xml version="1.0"?>
25416<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
25417<target>
25418 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
25419 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
25420</target>
25421@end smallexample
25422
25423@noindent
25424The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
25425breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
25426declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
25427(@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
25428useful for XML validation tools.
25429
25430@subsection Inclusion
25431@cindex target descriptions, inclusion
25432@cindex XInclude
25433@ifnotinfo
25434@cindex <xi:include>
25435@end ifnotinfo
25436
25437It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
25438several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
25439share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
25440divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
25441the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
25442
25443@smallexample
25444<xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
25445@end smallexample
25446
25447@noindent
25448When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
25449the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
25450the contents of that document. If the current description was read
25451using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
25452@var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
25453current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
25454@var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
25455original description.
25456
25457@subsection Architecture
25458@cindex <architecture>
25459
25460An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
25461
25462@smallexample
25463 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
25464@end smallexample
25465
25466@var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
25467accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
25468Debugging Target}).
25469
25470@subsection Features
25471@cindex <feature>
25472
25473Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
25474system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
25475registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
25476has this form:
25477
25478@smallexample
25479<feature name="@var{name}">
25480 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
25481 @var{reg}@dots{}
25482</feature>
25483@end smallexample
25484
25485@noindent
25486Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
25487of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
25488knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
25489should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
25490
25491@subsection Types
25492
25493Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
25494interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
25495but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
25496Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
25497Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
25498
25499Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
25500a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
25501Types must be defined before they are used.
25502
25503@cindex <vector>
25504Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
25505of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
25506specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
25507@var{count}:
25508
25509@smallexample
25510<vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
25511@end smallexample
25512
25513@cindex <union>
25514If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
25515with a union type containing the useful representations. The
25516@samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
25517each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
25518
25519@smallexample
25520<union id="@var{id}">
25521 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
25522 @dots{}
25523</union>
25524@end smallexample
25525
25526@subsection Registers
25527@cindex <reg>
25528
25529Each register is represented as an element with this form:
25530
25531@smallexample
25532<reg name="@var{name}"
25533 bitsize="@var{size}"
25534 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
25535 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
25536 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
25537 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
25538@end smallexample
25539
25540@noindent
25541The components are as follows:
25542
25543@table @var
25544
25545@item name
25546The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
25547
25548@item bitsize
25549The register's size, in bits.
25550
25551@item regnum
25552The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
25553than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
25554a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
25555defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
25556the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
25557packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
25558in order of increasing register number.
25559
25560@item save-restore
25561Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
25562calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
25563@code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
25564some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
25565ABI.
25566
25567@item type
25568The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
25569defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
25570and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
25571for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
25572architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
25573@var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
25574
25575@item group
25576The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
25577be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
25578@var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
25579in @code{info registers}.
25580
25581@end table
25582
25583@node Predefined Target Types
25584@section Predefined Target Types
25585@cindex target descriptions, predefined types
25586
25587Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
25588from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
25589standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
25590types. The currently supported types are:
25591
25592@table @code
25593
25594@item int8
25595@itemx int16
25596@itemx int32
25597@itemx int64
25598Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
25599
25600@item uint8
25601@itemx uint16
25602@itemx uint32
25603@itemx uint64
25604Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
25605
25606@item code_ptr
25607@itemx data_ptr
25608Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
25609any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
25610pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
25611address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
25612may be marked as data pointers.
25613
25614@item arm_fpa_ext
25615The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
25616
25617@end table
25618
25619@node Standard Target Features
25620@section Standard Target Features
25621@cindex target descriptions, standard features
25622
25623A target description must contain either no registers or all the
25624target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
25625@value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
25626the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
25627default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
25628described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
25629can recognize them.
25630
25631This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
25632which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
25633with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
25634if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
25635feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
25636description. You can add additional registers to any of the
25637standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
25638they were added to an unrecognized feature.
25639
25640This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
25641Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
25642@value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
25643
25644Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
25645company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
25646architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
25647containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
25648
25649The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
25650of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
25651registers using the capitalization used in the description.
25652
25653@subsection ARM Features
25654@cindex target descriptions, ARM features
25655
25656The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
25657It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
25658@samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
25659
25660The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
25661should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
25662
25663The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
25664it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
25665@samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
25666@samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
25667
25668@include gpl.texi
25669
25670@raisesections
25671@include fdl.texi
25672@lowersections
25673
25674@node Index
25675@unnumbered Index
25676
25677@printindex cp
25678
25679@tex
25680% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
25681% meantime:
25682\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
25683\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
25684\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
25685\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
25686\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
25687\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
25688\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
25689\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
25690\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
25691\page\colophon
25692% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
25693@end tex
25694
25695@bye
This page took 0.117733 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.